United States         Office of         Publication 9240.1 -20
          Environmental Protection     Solid Waste and      In«^ft«*»W)87
          Agency           Emergency Response     !,  ,_ rL,
                             r      December 1994
          Superfund

vyEPA     SUPERFUND ANALYTICAL
           METHODS FOR LOW
           CONCENTRATION WATER FOR
           ORGANICS ANALYSIS

-------
                                          9240.1-20
                                          PB95-963522
                                          EPA54Q/R-94/087
        SUPERFUND ANALYTICAL METHODS


                    FOR


LOW CONCENTRATION WATER FOR ORGANICS ANALYSIS


                   10/92
                                                   10/92

-------
                              STATEMENT OF WORK
                              Table of Contents
EXHIBIT B:  REPORTING AND DELIVERABLES REQUIREMENTS

EXHIBIT C:  TARGET COMPOUND LIST (TCL) AND CONTRACT REQUIRED QUANTITATION
            LIMITS (CRQLs)

EXHIBIT D:  ANALYTICAL METHODS

            Volatiles

            Semlvolatiles

            Pesticides
                                                                      10/92

-------
               EXHIBIT B
REPORTING AND DELIVERABLES REQUIREMENTS
                  B-l                               10/92

-------
                              Table of Contents
SECTION I:    Contract Reports/Dellverables Distribution 	 B-3

SECTION II:   Report Descriptions and Order of Data
              Deliverables	B-6

SECTION III:   Forms Instruction Guide	B-24

SECTION IV:   Data Reporting Forms 	8-45
                                     B-2                              10/92

-------
                                   SECTION I

                  CONTRACT RZPORTS/DELTVERABLES DISTRIBUTION
The following Cable reiterates  the Contract: reporting and deliverables
requirements specified  in  the Contract  Schedule and specifies  the
distribution that is required for each  deliverable.  NOTE: Specific recipient
names and addresses are subject to change  during the term of the contract.
Th« Sample Management Office (SMO) will notify the Contractor  in writing  of
such changes when they occur.
I tea
No,
Copies
Delivery
Schedule
Distribution
(1) (2) (3)
   1.  Updated SOPs
      Submit as specified
      in the BOA.
  *2.  Sample Traffic
        Reports
***3.  Sample Data Summary
        Package
***4.  Sample Data Package
***5.  Complete SDG File
   6.  GC/MS Tapes
Lot
3 days after
receipt of last
sample in Sample
Delivery Group
(SDG),**

14 days after
receipt of last
sample in SDG.

14 days afte-
receipt of last
sample in SDG.

14 days after
receipt of last
sample in SDG.

Retain for 365 days
after data submis-
sion, or submit with-
in 7 days after
receipt of written
request.
                                 X     X
As Directed
Distribution:
(1)  Sample Management Office (SMO)
(2)  SMSL-LV
(3)  Region-Client (Technical Project Officer)
                                     B-3
                                         10/92

-------
                               No.        Delivery             Distribution
           Item              Copies       Schedule            (I)    (2)    (3)
   7.  Extracts               Lot   Retain for 365 days        As Directed
                                    after data submis-
                                    sion, or submit with-
                                    in 7 days after
                                    receipt of written
                                    request.

   8.  QA Plan                 3    Submit as specified
                                    in the BOA.
NOTE:  The Contractor shall be prepared to receive the full contract sample
       requirement at the tine of contract award.

*         Also  required  in the  Sample Data Summary Package.

**        Sample  Delivery Group (SDG) is a group of samples within a. Case,
          received over  a period of  7 days or less and not exceeding 20
          samples. Data  for all samples in the SDG are due concurrently.   The
          date  of delivery of the SDG or any  samples  within the SDG is  the
          date  that all  samples have been  delivered.

          Concurrent  delivery required.  Delivery shall be made such that all
          designated  recipients receive the item on the same calendar day.
          Hardcopy data  reporting forms shall be typewritten.

          Complete SDG file will contain the  original sample data package plus
          all of  the  original documents described under Complete SDG File
          paragraph 5.

NOTE:     As specified in the Contract Schedule,  unless otherwise instructed
          by SMO,  the Contractor shall dispose of unused  sample volume  and
          used  sample bottles/containers no earlier than  sixty  (60)  days
          following submission  of the reconciled complete SDG file.   Sample
          disposal and disposal of unused  sample bottles/containers  is  the
          responsibility of the Contractor and shall  be done in accordance
          with  all applicable laws and regulations governing disposal of  such
          materials.
                                     B-4                               10/92

-------
Distribution Addresses:

(1)  Sample Management Office (SMO)
     P. 0. Box 818
     Alexandria, VA  22313

     For overnight delivery service, use street address:
     300 North Lee Street, Suite 200
     Alexandria, VA  22314

(2)  USEPA Environmental Monitoring
     Systems Laboratory (EMSL-LV)
     P,  0. Box 15027
     Las Vegas,  NV  89114
     ATTN:  Data Audit Staff

     For overnight delivery service, use street address:

     944 I.  Harmon,  Executive Center
     Las Vegas,  NV  89109
     ATTN:  Data Audit Staff

(3)  USIPA REGIONS:

     The Sample  Management Office will  provide  the Contractor with  the  list
     of addressees for the ten EPA  Regions.   SMO will provide the Contractor
     with updated Regional address/name lists as necessary  throughout the
     period of the contract and  identify other  client recipients on a
     case-by-case basis.
                                    B-5                               10/92

-------
                                   SECTION II
              REPORT DESCRIPTIONS AND ORDER OF DATA DELIVERABLES
 The  Contractor  laboratory shall provide reports and other deliverables as
 specified in  the Basic  Ordering Agreement.   The required content and form of
 each deliverable is  described in this  Exhibit.

 All  reports and documentation SHALL BE:

 o   Legible
 o   Clearly labeled and completed in accordance with instructions in this
    Exhibit
 o   Arranged in the order specified in this Section

 o   Paginated consecutively in ascending order starting from the SDG Narrative
 o   All data reporting forms shall be typewritten

 If submitted documentation does not conform  to  the  above criteria, the
 Contractor will be required to resubmit  such documentation with  the
 deficiencies corrected, at no additional cost.

 Whenever the Contractor is required to submit or resubmit data as a result of
 an on-site laboratory evaluation, through a  SMO action, or through a Regional
 Data Reviewer's request, the data shall be clearly  marked as ADDITIONAL DATA
 and shall be sent to all three contractual data recipients (SMO, EMSL/LV, and
 Region),  A cover letter shall be included which describes what  data are
 being delivered, to which EPA Case(s)/SDGs it pertains, and who  requested the
 data.

 Whenever the Contractor is required to submit or resubmit data as a result of
 Contract Compliance Screening (CCS) review by SMO,  the data shall be sent to
 all three contractual data recipients (SMO, EMSL/LV, and Region), and  in all
 three instances shall be accompanied by a color-coded COVER SHEET (Laboratory
Response To Results of Contract Compliance Screening) provided by SMO.

Descriptions of the requirements for each deliverable item cited in the Basic
Ordering Agreement (BOA) are specified in this  Section.  Items submitted
concurrently SHALL BE arranged in the order listed.  The components of each
 item SHALL BE arranged in the order presented in this Section when the itea
 is submitted.

Section III contains the form instructions to assist the Contractor in
providing all the required data.  Section IV of this Exhibit contains copies
of the required data reporting forms.
                                     B-6                               10/92

-------
1.    QUALITY ASSURANCE PLAN AND STANDARD OPERATING PROCEDURES

      See the BOA for requirements.

2.    SAMPLE TRAFFIC REPORTS

2.1   Original Sample Traffic Report page marked "Lab Copy for Return to SMO"
      with lab receipt information and signed in original Contractor
      signature, for each sample in the Sample Delivery Group.

2.2   Traffic Reports (TRs) shall be submitted in Sample Delivery Group (SDG)
      sets (i.e., TRs for all samples in an SDG shall be clipped together),
      with an SDG Cover Sheet attached.

2.3   The SDG Cover Sheet shall contain the following items:

          o   Lab name

          o   Contract number

          o   Sample analysis price - full sample price from contract.

          o   Case number

          o   List of EPA Sample Numbers of all samples in the SDG,
             identifying the first and last samples received, and their dates
             of receipt (LRDs).

2.4   When more than one sample is received in the first or last SDG
      shipment,  the "first" sample received would be the lowest sample number
      (considering both alpha and numeric designations);  the "last" sample
      received would be the highest sample number (considering both alpha and
      numeric designations).

2.5   The EPA Sample Number of the first sample received in the SDG is the
      SDG number.  Each Traffic Report shall be clearly marked with the SDG
      Number.  This information shall be entered below the Lab Receipt Date
      on the TR.  The TR for the last sample received in the last SDG
      shipment shall be clearly marked "SDG - FINAL SAMPLE."

2.6   If samples are received at the laboratory with multi-sample Traffic
      Reports (TRs), all the samples on one multi-sample TR may not
      necessarily be in the same SDG.   In this instance,  the laboratory shall
      make the appropriate number of photocopies of the TR,  and submit one
      copy with each SDG cover sheet.

3.    SAMPLE DATA SUMMARY PACKAGE

3.1   As specified in the Delivery Schedule, one Sample Data Summary Package
      shall be delivered to SMO concurrently with delivery of other required
      sample data.  The Sample Data Summary Package shall be submitted
      separately (i.e., separated by rubber bands, clips or other means)
      directly preceding the Sample Data Package.

3.2   The Sample Data Summary Package consists of specified items from the
      Sample Data Package in the following order:


                                     B-7                               10/92

-------
          o  SDG Narrative

          o  Organics Analysis Data  Sheet  for  target compound results  (Form
             I) and for tentatively  identified compounds  (Form  I, TIG) by
             fraction (VOA, SV, PEST) and  by sample within each fraction.
             (No Fora I, TIC for PEST fraction.)
          o  Surrogate Recovery (Forn II)  by fraction  (VOA, SV,  PEST)

          o  Laboratory Control Sample Recovery  (Form  III) by fraction (VOA,
             SV, PEST)

          o  Method Blank Summary  (Forn IV), Organics Analysis  Data  Sheet  for
             target compound results' (Form I)  and for  tentatively identified
             compounds (Form I, TIC) by fraction (VOA, SV).

          o  Peak Area and Retention Time  Summary of Internal Standards  for
             initial calibration standards (Form VIII) and samples (Form
             VIII) by fraction (VOA, SV only).

3.3   Sample data forms shall be arranged  in increasing EPA Sample Number
      order.

4.    ffH?LS DATA PACKAGE

4.1   The Sample Data Package shall  include data for analyses of all samples
      in each Sample Delivery Group,  specifically including field samples,
      reanalyses,  dilutions,  blanks,  Laboratory Control Samples, and
      Performance Evaluation Samples.  The Sample Data Package  is divided
      into the five major units as follows:

          o  SDG Narrative

          o  Sample Traffic Reports

          o  Volatiles Data

          o  Semivolatiles Data

          o  Pesticides/Aroclors Data

4.2   The Volatiles, Semivolatiles,  and Pesticides/Aroclors data are each
      specific to an analytical fraction.  If  the analysis of that fraction
      is not required, then that fraction-specific unit is not a required
      deliverable.

      The Contractor shall retain a  copy of the sample data package for  365
      days after final acceptance of data.  After this time, the Contractor
      may dispose of the package.

4.3.  SDG Narrative

      4.3.1    This  document shall  be clearly labeled  "SDG Narrative."   The
               SDG Narrative shall  contain: laboratory name; Case number;  EPA
               Sample  Numbers in the  Sample Delivery Group (SDG),
               differentiating between initial  analyses, dilutions and
               reanalysis; SDG number; Contract number; and detailed
               documentation of any quality control sample, shipment  and/or


                                     B-8                               10/92

-------
               analytical problems  encountered in processing  the  samples
               reported In the data package.

      4.3.2    Whenever data from sample  reanalyzes  are  submitted,  the
               Contractor shall state In  the  SDG Narrative  for  each
               reanalysis,  whether  it considers the  reanalysis  to be  billahle,
               and  if  so,  why.   A copy of the narrative  shall be  sent to SMO
               for  their review.  The Contractor shall also include any
               problems encountered;  both technical  and  administrative,  the
               corrective actions taken,  and  resolution.

      4.3.3    The  Contractor shall also  list the pH determined for each water
               sample  submitted for volatiles analysis.  This information nay
               appear  as a simple list or table in the SDG  Narrative.   The
               purpose of this  pH determination is to ensure  that all
               volatiles samples  were acidified in the field.   No pH
               adjustment is to be  performed  by the  Contractor  on water
               samples for volatiles  analysis.

      4.3.4   .The  SDG Narrative  shall contain the following  statement
               verbatim:  "I certify that  this data package  is in  compliance
               with the terms and conditions  of the  contract, both  technically
               and  for completeness,  for  other than  the conditions  detailed
               above.   Release  of the data contained In this  data package has
               been authorized by the Laboratory Manager or his designee,  as
               verified by the  following  signature.*  This  statement  shall be
               directly followed  by the signature of the Laboratory Manager or
               his  designee with  a  typed  line below  It containing the  signer's
               name and title,  and  the date of signature.

      4.3.S    In the  event that  the  Laboratory Manager cannot verify  all data
               reported for each  sample,  the  Laboratory Manager shall  provide
               a detailed description of  the  problems associated  with  the
               samples in the SDG Narrative.

      4.3.6    The  SDG Narrative  itself shall be  signed with  original
               signature by the Laboratory Manager or his designee  and dated.

4.4   Sample Traffic Reports

      Copies of the Sample Traffic  Reports for all of  the  samples in the SDG
      are also Included in the Sample Data Summary Package.  The  Traffic
      Reports shall be arranged in  increasing EPA sample number order,
      considering both letters and  numbers in ordering samples.  Copies of
      the SDG cover sheet are to be included with the  copies  of the Traffic
      Reports.

      If samples  are received at the laboratory with multi-sample Traffic
      Reports (TRs),  not all samples on one multi-sample TR are necessarily
      in the same SDG.  In this instance, the Contractor shall make the
      appropriate number of photocopies of the TR so that  a copy  is submitted
      with each data package to which it applies.  In  addition, in any
      instance where samples from more than one multi-sample  TR are in the
                                     B-9                               10/92

-------
      same data package, the Contractor shall submit a copy of the SDG cover
      sheet with copies of the TRs.

4.5   Volatiles Data

      4.5.1   Volatiles QC Summary

              If more than a single  form  is necessary, each type of form
              shall be arranged  in chronological order by instrument.

              o   Surrogate Recovery (Fora II LCV)

              o   Laboratory Control Sample Recovery (Fora III LCV)

              o   Method Blank Summary (Fora IV LCV)

              o   GC/MS  Tuning and Mass Calibration - BFB (Fora V LCV)

              o   Internal Standard  Area and Retention Time  Summary (Form
                  VIII LCV)

      4.5.2   .Volatiles Sample Data

              Sample data, including FES, shall be arranged in packets with
              both of the Organic Analysis Data Sheets (Fora I LCV and Form I
              LCV-TIC),  followed by the raw data for volatile samples.  These
              sample packets shall then be placed in increasing EPA Sample
              Number order.

              4.5.2.1    Organics Analysis Data Sheet for target compound
                         results (Form I LCV).

              4.5.2.2    Organics Analysis Data Sheet for tentatively
                         identified  compounds (Fora I LCV-TIC).   This form
                         shall be included even if no TIC's  are found.

              4,5.2.3    Reconstructed total ion chromatograms (RIC)

                         The RIC for each sample,  extract,  standard,  and
                         blank shall be normalized to the largest nonsolvent
                         component,  and shall contain the following header
                         information:

                         o    EPA Sample Number

                         o    Date and time of analysis

                         o    GC/MS  instrument ID

                         o    Lab file ID

                         Internal standard and surrogate  spiking compounds
                         are to be labeled with the names of the compounds,
                         either directly out from the peak,  or on a print-out
                         of retention times if retention  times are printed
                         over the peak.

                                     B-10                              10/92

-------
4.5.2.4    Quantitation Report

           If automated data systems are used for quantitation
           of the target compounds, Che complete data system
           quantitation report shall be included in all sample
           data packages, in addition to the reconstructed ion
           chromatograa.  The complete data systen quantitation
           report shall include all of the information listed
           below.  For laboratories which do not use the
           automated data system procedures, a laboratory "raw
           data sheet" quantitation report containing the
           following information shall be included in the
           sample data package in addition to the chromatogram.

           o    EPA Sample Number

           o    Date and time of analysis

           o    RT or scan number of identified target
                compounds

           o    Ion used for quantitation with measured
                area

           o    Copy of the area table  from the data system

           o    GC/MS instrument ID

           o    Lab file ID

           In all instances where the data system report has
           been edited, or where manual integration or
           quantitation has been performed, the GC/MS operator
           shall identify such edits or manual procedures by
           initialing and dating the changes made to the report
           and Include the scan range integration.

4.5.2.5    Target Compound Mass Spectra

           For each sample, by each compound identified,  copies
           of raw spectra and copies of background-subtracted
           mass spectra of target compounds that are identified
           in the sample and corresponding background-
           subtracted target compound standard mass spectra are
           required.  The raw spectra and the background-
           subtracted spectra shall be  labeled with the EPA
           Sample Number, lab file ID,  date and time of
           analysis, and GC/MS instrument ID.  Compound names
           shall be clearly marked on all spectra.
                       B-ll                             10/92

-------
         4.5.2.6    Tentatively  Identified Compound Mass Spectra and
                   Library Matches

                   For each sample, by each compound identified, copies
                   of mass spectra of non-target and non-surrogate
                   organic compounds (Tentatively Identified Compounds)
                   with the associated spectra of the three best
                   library matches are labeled with EPA Sample Number,
                   lab file ID, date and time of analysis, and GC/MS
                   instrument ID.

4.5.3    Volatiles Standards Data

         4.5.3.1    Initial Calibration

                   All initial calibration data shall be included for
                   all analyses associated with the SDG.  When more
                   than one initial calibration is performed,  the
                   reconstructed ion chromatograms and quantitation
                   reports and each type of form shall be put in
                   chronological order, by instrument.

                   Initial Calibration Summary (Form VI LCV).

                   Internal Standard Area and Retention Time  Summary
                   (Form VIII LCV)

                   Volatile standard(s) reconstructed ion chromatograms
                   and quantitation reports for the initial (five
                   point)  calibration are labeled as in Paragraphs
                   4.5.2.3 and 4.5.2.4.   Spectra are not required.

        4.5.3.2    Continuing Calibration

                   When more than one continuing calibration  is
                   performed,  the reconstructed ion chromatogram and
                   quantitation reports and each type of form shall be
                   in chronological order,  and by instrument  if more
                   than one instrument is used.

                   Continuing Calibration Summary (Form VII LCV)

                   Internal Standard Area and Retention Time  Summary
                   (Form VIII LCV)

                   VGA standard(s)  reconstructed ion chromatograms and
                   quantitation reports  for all continuing (12 hour)
                   calibrations  are labeled as in Paragraph 4.5.2.3 and
                   4.5.2.4.   Spectra are  not required.
                              B-12                              10/92

-------
      4.5.4    Volatiles QC Data

               4.5.4.1   GC/MS  Tuning Data

                         GC/MS  Tuning - BFB data, for each 12-hour period,
                         shall  be arranged in chronological order by
                         instrument  for each GC/MS system utilized.

                         GC/MS  Tuning and Mass Calibration - BFB (Form V LCV)

                         Bar graph spectrum, labeled as in Paragraph 4.5.2.3.

                         Mass listing, labeled as in Paragraph 4.5.2.3.

               4.5.4.2   Blank  Data

                         Blank  data  (method, storage and instrument) shall be
                         arranged in chronological order by instrument.
                         NOTE:  This order is different from that used for
                         samples.

                         Blank  data  shall be arranged in packets with both of
                         the Organic Analysis Data Sheets (Form I LCV and
                         Form I LCV-TIC), followed by the raw data for
                         volatile saaples (see paragraphs 4.5.2.1 to
                         4.5.2.6).

               4.5.4.3   Laboratory  Control Sample Data

                         Organics Analysis Data Sheet for target compound
                         results (Form I LCV).  Form I LCV-TIC is not
                         required.

                         Reconstructed ion chromatogram(s) and quantitation
                         report(s),  labeled as in Paragraph 4.5.2.3 and
                         4.5.2.4.  Spectra are no^ required.

4.6   Semivolatlles Data

      4.6.1    Semivolatiles QC  Summary

               If more than a single  form is necessary, each type of form
               shall be  arranged in chronological order, by instrument.

                         o   Surrogate Recovery (Form II  LCSV)

                         o   Laboratory  Control Sample Recovery (Form III
                             LCSV)

                         o   Method Blank Summary (Fora IV LCSV)

                         o   GC/MS  Tuning and Mass  Calibration -  DFTPP (Form
                             V LCSV)

                         o   Internal Standard Area and Eetention Time
                             Summary  (Fora VIII LCSV-1,  LCSV-2)

                                     B-13                              10/92

-------
4.6.2   Semivolatiles Sample DaCa

        Sample data, including PES, shall be arranged, in packets with
        both of the Organic Analysis Data Sheets  (Form I LCSV and  Form
        I LCSV-TIC), followed by the raw data for semivolatile  samples.
        These sample packets shall then be placed in  increasing EPA
        Sample Number order.

        4.6.2.1    Organic Analysis Data Sheet for target compound
                   results (Form I LCSV-1,  LCSV-2).

        4.6.2.2    Tentatively Identified Compounds (Form I LCSV-TIC).
                   This form shall be included even if no TICs  are
                   found.

        4.6.2.3    Reconstructed total ion chromatograms (RICs)

                   The RIC for each sample,  extract,  standard,   and
                   blank shall be normalized to the largest nonsolvent
                   component,  and shall contain the following header
                   information:

                   o    EPA Sample  Number

                   o    Date and  time  of analysis

                   o    GC/MS  instrument ID

                   o    Lab file  ID

                   Internal standard and surrogate spiking compounds
                   are to be labeled with  the names  of the compounds,
                   either directly out from  the peak,  or on a print-out
                   of retention times if retention times are printed
                   over the peak.

        4.6.2.4    Quantitation Reports

                   If automated data system  procedures are used for
                   preliminary identification and/or quantitation of
                   the target  compounds, the complete data system
                   quantitation report shall be included in all sample
                   data packages, in addition to the  reconstructed ion
                   chromatogram.   The complete data system quantitation
                   report shall include all  of the information listed
                   below.  For laboratories  which do  not use the
                   automated data system procedures,  a laboratory  "raw
                   data sheet" quantitation  report containing the
                   following information shall be  included in the
                   sample data package in  addition to the chromatogram.

                   o    EPA Sample  Number

                   o    Date and  time  of analysis

                               B-14                             10/92

-------
                   o    RT or scan number  of identified target
                        compounds

                   o    Ion used for quantitation with measured
                        area

                   o    Copy of peak area  table from data system

                   o    GC/MS instrument ID

                   o    Lab file ID

                   In all Instances where  the data system report has
                   been edited, or where manual integration or
                   quantitation has been performed, the GC/MS operator
                   shall identify such edits or manual procedures by
                   initialing and dating the changes made to the report
                   and Include the scan range Integration.

        -4.6.2.5    Target Compound Mass Spectra

                   For each sample, by each compound identified, copies
                   of raw spectra and copies of background-subtracted
                   mass spectra of target  compounds that are identified
                   in the sample and corresponding background-
                   subtracted target compound standard mass spectra are
                   required.  The raw spectra and the background-
                   subtracted mass spectra shall be labeled with EPA
                   Sample Number, lab file ID, date and time of
                   analysis, and GC/MS instrument ID.  Compound names
                   shall be clearly marked on all spectra.

        4.6.2.6    Tentatively Identified  Compound Mass Spectra and
                   Library Matches

                   For each sample, by each compound identified, copies
                   of mass spectra of non-target and non-surrogate
                   organic compounds (Tentatively Identified Compounds)
                   with the associated spectra of the three best
                   library matches are labeled with EPA Sample Number,
                   lab file ID, date and time of analysis, and GC/MS
                   instrument ID.

4.6.3.  Semivolatiles  Standards  Data

        4.6.3.1    Initial Calibration

                   Data shall be included for all calibration analyses
                   pertaining to the SDG.   When more than one initial
                   calibration is performed, the reconstructed  ion
                   chromatogram and quantitation reports and each type
                   of  form shall be put in chronological order, by
                   instrument.
                               B-15                              10/92

-------
                    Initial  Calibration Data  (Form VI  LCSV-1,  LCSV-2).

                    Internal Standard Area  and RT Summary  (Form VIII
                    LCSV-1,  LCSV-2)

                    Semivolatile  standard(s)  reconstructed ion
                    chromatograns and quantitation reports for the
                    initial  (five point)  calibration are labeled as  in
                    Paragraphs 4.6.2.3  and  4.6.2.4.  Spectra are. not
                    required.

         4.6.3.2     Continuing Calibration

                    When more than one  continuing calibration  is
                    performed, the reconstructed ion chromatogram and
                    quantitation  reports  and  each type of  form shall be
                    in chronological  order, by instrument.

                    Continuing Calibration  Summary (Form VII LCSV-1,
                    LCSV-2).

                    Internal Standard Area  and Retention Time  Summary
                    (Form VIII LCSV-1,  LCSV-2).

                    Semivolatile  standard(s)  reconstructed ion
                    chromatograms  and quantitation reports  for all
                    continuing (12 hour)  calibrations are  labeled as in
                    Paragraphs 4.6.2.3  and  4.6.2.4.  Spectra are not
                    required.

4.6.4.   Semivolatiles QC Data

         4.6.4.1     GC/MS Tuning  Data

                    GC/MS Tuning-DFTPP  data,  for each 12-hour  period
                    shall be arranged in  chronological order by
                    instrument, for each  GC/MS  system utilized.

                    GC/MS Tuning  and  Mass Calibration-BFB  (Form V LCSV)

                    Bar graph spectrum, labeled as in Paragraph 4.6.2.3.

                    Mass listing,  labeled as  in Paragraph 4.6.2.3.

         4.6.4.2     Blank Data

                    Blank data shall  be arranged in chronological order
                    by instrument.  NOTE:   This order is different from
                    that used for  samples.

                    Blank data shall  be arranged in packets with both of
                    the Organic Analysis  Data Sheets (Form  I LCSV and
                    Form I LCSV-TIC), followed by the raw data for
                               B-16                              10/92

-------
                          semtvolatile  samples  (see paragraphs 4.6.2.1  to
                          4.6.2.6)

               4.6.4.3    Laboratory Control  Sample Data

                          Organic Analysis Data Sheet for target compounds
                          (Fora  I LCSV-1, LCSV-2).  Fora I LCSV-TIC  is  not
                          required.

                          Reconstructed ion chromatogram(s) and quantltation
                          report(s), are labeled as in Paragraphs 4.6.2.3 and
                          4.6.2.4.  Spectra are not required.

4.7   Pesticide/Aroclor Data

      4.7.1    Pesticide/Aroclor QC Summary

               If more than a  single fora is  necessary, forms shall  be
               arranged in chronological order  by instrument.

               o    Surrogate  Percent Recovery  Summary (Fora II LCP)

               o    Laboratory Control  Sample Recovery (Fora III LCP)

               o    Method Blank Summary (Fora  IV LCP)

                   If more than a single method blank summary fora  is
                   necessary, forms shall be arranged in chronological order
                   by type (method or  sulfur blank)  by instrument, and by
                   date of analyses.

      4.7.2    Pesticide/Aroclor Sample Data

               Sample  data, including PES, shall be arranged in packets with
               the Organic Analysis Data Sheet  (Form I LCP), followed by the
               rav data  for pesticide samples.  These sample packets shall
               then be placed  in increasing EPA Sample Number order.

               4.7.2.1    Organic Analysis Data Sheet for target compounds
                         (Fora I LCP).

               4.7.2.2    Pesticide Identification Summary for Single
                         Component Analytes (Form X LCP-1),  only required for
                         positively identified analytes.

               4.7.2.3    Pesticide Identification Summary for Multicomponent
                         Analytes (Form X LCP-2),  only required for
                         positively identified analytes.

              4.7.2.4    Pesticide chromatograns

                         All chromatograms  shall  be  labeled with the
                         following Information:
                                     B-17                              10/92

-------
           o    EPA Sample Number

           o    Volume injected (ul)

           o    Date and time of analyses

           o    GC column identification (by stationary
                phase and internal diameter)

           o    GC instrument identification

           o    Scaling Factor

           o    Positively identified compounds shall be
                labeled with the names of compounds,
                either directly out from the peak,  or
                on a print-out of retention times if
                retention times are printed over the
                peak.

4.7.2.5    Copies of pesticide chromatograms from the second GC
           column, labeled as in Paragraph 4.7.2.4.

4.7.2.6    Data System Printouts

           Data system printouts of retention time and
           corresponding peak areas or height shall accompany
           each chromatogram and are labeled with the following
           information:

           o    EPA Sample Number

           o    Volume injected (ul)

           o    Date and time of analyses

           o    GC column identification (by stationary
                phase and internal diameter)

           o    GC instrument identification

           o    Scaling Factor

           o    Positively identified compounds shall be
                labeled with the names of compounds,
                either directly out from the peak,  or
                on a print-out of retention times if
                retention times are printed over the
                peak.

           In all instances where the data system report has
           been edited, or where manual integration or
           quantitation has been performed, the GC/EC operator
           shall identify such edits or manual procedures by

                       B-18                              10/92

-------
                   initialing mad dating the changes made to the report
                   and include the integration tine range.

        4.7.2.7    Manual work sheets.

4.7.3   Pesticide/Aroclor Standards Data

        4.7.3.1    Initial Calibration

                   Data shall be included for all calibration analyses
                   pertaining to the SDG.  When more than one Initial
                   calibration is performed, the data and each type of
                   font shall be put in chronological order, by
                   instrument and GC column.

                   Initial Calibration for Single Component Analytes
                   (Form VI LCP-1, LCP-2).

                   Initial Calibration for Multlcomponent Analytes
                   (Form VI LCP-3).

                   Resolution Check Summary (Form VI LCP-4).

                   Analytical Sequence (Form VIII LCP),  containing
                   initia^ calibration standards.

        4.7.3.2    Calibration Verification

                   Calibration Verification Summary (Fora VII LCP) for
                   all GC columns.

                   When more than one calibration verification is
                   performed, ^'--TM shall U« in chr?«ological order, by
                   instrument and GC column.

        4.7.3.3    Chromatograms and data system printouts are required
                   for aJU standards and arranged in chronological
                   order by instrument and each GC column;

                   o    Resolution Check Mixture.

                   o    Performance Evaluation Mixtures,  each initial
                        calibration and all those that bracket samples
                        in the SDG.

                   o    Individual Standard Mixture A, at three
                        concentrations, each initial calibration,
                        plus all those that bracket samples in
                        the SDG.

                   o    Individual Standard Mixture B, at three
                        concentrations, each initial calibration,
                        plus all those that bracket samples in
                        the SDG.

                               B-19                              10/92

-------
                   a    All multicomponent analytes (Toxaphene
                        and Aroclors), each initial
                        calibration.

                   o    All multicomponent analyte standards
                        analyzed for confirmation.

         4.7.3.4    Data system printouts of retention  times and
                   corresponding peak areas or peak heights shall
                   accompany each chromatogran.  In addition, all
                   chromatograms and data system printouts are  required
                   to be labeled with the following:

                   o    EPA Sample Number for the standard,
                        i.e., INDAl, INDA2,  etc.  (See Forms
                        Instructions for details),

                   o    Label all standard peaks for all
                        individual compounds either directly
                        out from the peak or on the printout of
                        retention times if retention times are
                        printed over the peak.

                   o    Total nanograms injected for each
                        standard.

                   o    Date and time of injection.

                   o    GC column identification (by stationary
                        phase and internal diameter).

                   o    GC instrument identification.

                   o    Scaling factor

                   In all instance* where the data system report has
                   bees edited, or where manual integration or
                   quantitation has been performed, the GC/EC operator
                   shall identify such edits or manual procedures by
                   initialing and dating the changes made to the report
                   and include the integration time range.

4.7.4    Pesticide/Aroclor QC Data

         4.7.4.1    Blank Data

                   Blank data instrument - grouped by type of blank
                   (i.e., method and sulfur) and arranged in
                   chronological order.  NOTE:  This order is different
                   from that used for samples.

                   Organlcs Analysis Data Sheet for target compounds
                   (Form I LCP).
                               B-20                              10/92

-------
                          Blank data shall be arranged in packets  with the
                          Organics Analysis Data Sheet (Form I  LCP)  followed
                          by the raw data (paragraph 4.7.2.2, to 4.7.2.7).

               4.7.4.2    Laboratory Control Sample

                          Organics Analysis Data Sheet for target  compounds
                          (Form I LCP).

                          Chromatograms  and data system printouts  are labeled
                          as  in Paragraph 4.7.2,4 and 4,7.2.6.

               4.7.4.3    Florisil Cartridge Check

                          Florisil Cartridge Check (Fora IX LCP),  for  all  lots
                          of  cartridges  used to  process  samples in the SDG.

                          Each  Fora IX LCP shall be  followed by the
                          chroaatograms  and data system  printouts, labeled as
                          in  4.7.2.4 and 4.7.2.6.

5.    COMPLETE SPS FILE

      As specified in the Delivery Schedule, one Complete SDG File (CSF)
      Including the original sample data package shall be delivered to the
      Region concurrently with delivery of copies of the Sample Data Package
      to SMO and EMSL/LV.  The contents of the CSF shall be numbered
      according to the method described in Section III of Exhibit B.  The
      Document Inventory Sheet, Form DC-2, is contained in Section IV.  The
      CSF shall contain all original documents where possible.   No copies
      shall be placed in the CSF unless the originals are bound in a logbook
      which is maintained by the laboratory.  The CSF shall contain all
      original documents specified in Section III, and Form DC-2 of Exhibit B
      of this Superfund method.

      The CSF shall consist of the following original documents in the order
      listed in paragraph 5.1 through 5.6 below:

5.1   The original sample data package (see Exhibit B, Section  4).

5.2   A completed and signed Document Inventory Sheet (Form DC-2).

5.3   All original shipping documents,  including, but not limited to, the
      following documents:

         o   EPA Chain of Custody Record

         o   Airbills

         o   EPA Traffic Reports.

         o   Sample Tags (if present) sealed in plastic bags.

5.4   All original receiving documents,  including, but not limited to, the
      following documents:
                                     B-21                              10/92

-------
          o   Form DC-1
          o   Other receiving forms  or copies  of receiving  logbooks

          o   SOG  Cover  Sheet

5.5   All original  laboratory records, not already submitted in the Sample
      Data Package, of  sample transfer, preparation and analysis, including,
      but not limited to, the following documents:

          o   Original preparation and analysis  forms or copies of preparation
              and  analysis logbook pages.

          o   Internal sample and  sample extract transfer chain-of-custody
              records.

          o   Screening  records.

          o  All  instrument  output, including strip charts from screening
              activities.

5.6   All other original SDG-related documents  in the possession of the
      laboratory, including, but not limited to, the following documents:

          o  Telephone  contact logs

          o  Copies of  personal logbook pages

          o  All hand written SDG-specific notes

          o  Any other  SDG specific documents not covered by the above.

      NOTE:  All SDG-related documentation may be used or admitted as
      evidence in subsequent legal proceedings.   Any other SDG-specific
      documents generated after the CSF is sent to the Region,  as well as
      copies that are altered in any fashion,  are also deliverables to the
      Region.  (Original to the Region and copies to SMO and EMSL/LV).

      If the laboratory does submit SDG-specific documents  to the Region
      after submission of the CSF, the documents shall be numbered as an
      addendum to the CSF and a revised DC-2 fora shall be  submitted,  or the
      documents shall be numbered as a new CSF and a new DC-2 form shall be
      submitted.   The revised DC-2 form is sent to the Region only.

6.    GC/MS TAPES

      See the BOA, Attachment 3,  page 3 of 6.

7.    EXTRACTS

      The Contractor shall store  sample extracts at 4*C (+2*C)  in
      bottles/vials with Teflon-lined septa.   Extract bottles/vials shall be
      labeled with EPA Sample Number,  Case number and Sample Delivery Group
      (SDG) number.   A logbook of stored extracts shall be  maintained,
      listing EPA Sample Numbers  and associated Case and SDG numbers.
                                     B-22                             10/92

-------
The Contractor is required to retain extracts for 365 days following
data submission.  During that time, the Contractor shall submit
extracts and associated logbook pages within seven days following
receipt of a written request.
                               B-23                              10/92

-------
                                  SICflON III

                            FORM INSTRUCTION GUIDE


This section includes specific instructions  for the completion of all
required forms.  Each of the forms is specific to a given fraction  (volatile,
semivolatile, pesticide/Aroclor).  The Contractor shall submit only those
forms pertaining to the fractions analyzed for a given sample or samples.
For instance, if a sample is scheduled for volatile analysis only, submit
only VGA forms.  There are two pages relating to the semivolatile fraction
for Forms I, VI, VII, and VIII and four pages relating to the
pesticide/Aroclor fraction for Fora VI.  Whenever semivolatiles or
pesticides/Aroclors are analyzed and one of the above named forms is
required, all pages (LCSV-1, LCSV-2, etc.) shall be submitted.  These
instructions are arranged in the following order:

     1.   General Information  and Header Information

     2.   Organic Analysis Data  Sheet  (Form I, All  Fractions)

     3,   Surrogate Recovery (Form II, All Fractions)

     4.   Laboratory Control Sample Recovery (Form  III, All  Fractions)

     5.   Method Blank Summary (Form IV, All  Fractions)

     6.   GC/MS Tuning and Mass Calibration  (Form V  LCV, LCSV)

     7.   Initial Calibration Summary  (Form VI, All  Fractions)

     8.   Pesticide Resolution Check Summary  (Form VI LCP-4)

     9.   Continuing Calibration Summary  (Form VII LCV, LCSV)

     10.  Calibration Verification Summary  (Form VII LCP)

     11.  Internal Standard Area and Retention Time Summary  (Form VIII LCV,
         LCSV)

     12.  Pesticide/Aroclor Analytical Sequence (Form VIII LCP)

     13.  Pesticide/Aroclor Florisil Cartridge Check (Form IX LCP)

     14.  Pesticide/Aroclor Identification (Form X LCP)

     15.  Sample Log-In Sheet (Form DC-1)

     16.  Document Inventory Sheet (Form DC-2)
                                    B-24                              10/92

-------
1.    gSNERAL INFORMATION AND HEADEE INFORMATION

1.1   Values shall be reported on the hardcopy forms according to the
      individual form instructions in this Section.  For example, results for
      concentrations of VOA target compounds shall be reported to two
      significant figures if the value is greater than or equal to 10.

1.2   For rounding off numbers to the appropriate level of precision, observe
      the following common rules.  If the figure following those to be
      retained is less than 5, drop it (round down).  If the figure is
      greater than 5, drop it and increase the last digit to be retained by 1
      (round up).  If the figure following the last digit to be retained
      equals 5 exactly, round up if the digit to be retained is odd, and
      round down if that digit is even.

1.3   All characters which appear on the data reporting forms presented in
      the contract (Exhibit B, Section IV) shall be reproduced by the
      Contractor when submitting data, and the format of the forms submitted
      shall be identical to that shown in this Superfund method.  No
      information may be added, deleted, or moved from its specified position
      without prior written approval of SMO.  The names of the various fields
      and compounds (i.e., "Lab Code", "Chloromethane") on the uncompleted
      forms shall appear as they do in this Superfund method (Section IV of
      this exhibit), except that the use of uppercase and lowercase letters
      is optional.

1.4   Alphabetic entries made on the forms by the Contractor shall be in ALL,
      tffPERCASE letters.

1.5   Forma II,  IV, V, VIII, IX, and X contain a field labeled 'page _ of _"
      in the bottom left-hand corner.  If the number of entries required on
      any of these forms exceeds the available space, continue entries on
      another copy of the same fraction-specific form, duplicating all header
      information.  If a second page is required, number them consecutively,
      as "page 1 of 2* and "page 2 of 2."  If a second page is not required,
      number the page "page 1 of 1."  NOTE:  These forms are
      fraction-specific. . For example, Form II LCV, Form II LCSV, and Form II
      LCP are for different data.   Therefore, do not number the pages of all
      three versions of Form II as "1 of 3, 2 of 3, etc."  Only number pages
      within a fraction-specific form.

1.6   Six pieces of information are common to the header sections of each
      data reporting form.  They are: Lab Name, Contract, Lab Code, Case No.,
      SAS No., and SDG No.  This information, if it applies, shall be entered
      on every form and shall match on every form.

      1.6.1   The  "Lab Name" shall be the name  chosen by the Contractor to
              identify the  laboratory.   It may  not  exceed 25 characters.

      1.6.2   The  "Lab Code" is an alphabetical  abbreviation of up  to  6
              letters, assigned bySMO.  to identify the  laboratory and aid  in
              data processing.  This lab code shall be assigned by SMO at  the
              time a contract is awarded, and shall not  be  modified by the
              Contractor, except at the direction of  SMO.   If  a change of

                                     B-25                              10/92

-------
              name or ownership occurs at  the laboratory, the lab code will
              remain the sane until the Contractor  is directed by SMO to use
              another lab code assigned by SMO.

      1.6.3   The "Case No." is the assigned Case Number  (up to 5 digits)
              associated with the sample,  and reported on the Traffic Report.

      1.6.4   The "Contract" is the number of the contract under which the
              analyses were performed.

      1,6.5   When more than one sample is received In the first or last SDG
              shipment, the "first" sample received would be the lowest
              sample number (considering both alpha and numeric
              designations); the "last" sample received would be the highest
              sample number (considering both alpha and numeric
              designations).

      1.6.6   The "SAS No." is the assigned number for analyses performed
              under Special Analytical Services.  If samples are to be
              analyzed under SAS only, and reported on these forms, then
              enter SAS No., and leave Case No. blank.  If samples are
              analyzed according to the "Routine Analytical Services" (IFB)
              protocols and have additional "SAS" requirements, list both
              Case No. and SAS No. on all  forms.  If the  analyses have no SAS
              requirements, leave "SAS No." blank.  NOTE:  Some samples in an
              SDG may have a SAS No. while others do not.

1.7   EFA Sample Number

      1.7.1   EFA Sample Number shall be entered on several of the forms.
              This field appears either in the upper right-hand corner of the
              form, or as the left column of a table summarizing data from a
              number of samples. When "EFA Sample No." is entered into the
              triple-spaced box in the upper right-hand corner of the form,
              it should be entered on the middle line of  the three lines that
              comprise the box.

      1.7.2   All samples, including Laboratory Control Samples and
              Performance Evaluation Samples, blanks, and standards shall be
              identified with an EFA Sample Number.

      1.7.3   For samples, the EFA Sample Number is the unique Identifying
              number given in the Traffic Report that accompanied that
              sample.  In order to facilitate data assessment, the following
              identification scheme shall be used for samples:

              XXIXX    -  EFA Sample Number assigned by SMO
              XXXXXRE  -  re-analyzed sample
              XXXXXDL  -  sample analyzed  at a dilution
              XXXXXDL2 -  sample analyzed  at a secondary  dilution (for PEST
                          only)
                                     B-26                              10/92

-------
1.7.4    The EPA Sample Number shall  be  unique  for each Laboratory
         Control Sample within an SDG.   The  EPA Sample Number  for  a
         Laboratory Control Sample shall be  FLCS##, where:

         F  -  fraction (V for volatiles;  S for  semivolatiles;  P  for
         pesticides/Aroclors).

         LCS -  indicates a Laboratory Control  Sample.

         ** - suffix  consisting  of characters  or numbers or both  that
         makes the  EPA Sample  Number  for the LCS unique in  the SDG.

1.7.5    The EPA Sample Number shall  be  unique  for each blank  within  an
         SDG.  Within  a fraction,  a laboratory  shall replace the "##"
         terminator of the  identifier with one  or two characters or
         numbers, or a combination of both.  For example, possible
         identifiers for volatile  blanks  would  be VBLK1, VBLK2, VBLKA1,
         VBLKB2,  VBLK10,  VBLKAB,  etc.

         Volatile method blanks shall be  identified as VBLK#*.

         Volatile storage blank shall be .identified in VSBLK**.

        Volatile instrument blank shall  be identified as VIBLK##.

         Semivolatile method blanks shall be identified as SBLK##.

         Pesticide/Aroclor method blanks  shall be identified as PBLK##.

         Pesticide/Aroclor instrument blanks shall be identified as
         PIBLK8*.

         If  a  separate  sulfur cleanup blank is required (e.g., when not
         all Pesticide/Aroclor samples associated with a given method
         blank are  subjected to sulfur cleanup) the Pesticide/Aroclor
         sulfur cleanup blanks shall be identified as PCBLKff*.

1.7.6    The EPA  Sample Number shall be unique for each standard within
         an  SDG.

         The EPA  Sample Numbers for volatile and semivolatile standards
         shall be FSTD###, where:

         F -   fraction   (V for volatiles; S for semivolatiles).

         STD -  indicates a standard.

         *#* -  the  concentration  in ug/L of volatile standards  (i.e.,
         001,  002, 005, 010) or the amount  injected in ng for
         semivolatile standards (i.e., 005,  010, 020, 050, and 080).
         These designations will have to be concatenated with other
         information to uniquely identify each standard in the SDG.
                               B-27                              10/92

-------
               For pesCicide/Aroclor standards,  Che following scheme shall be
               used to enter EPA Sample Number.
            Name
                                  EPA  Samole Number
1.8
      Individual Mix A  (low poinC)        INDAL0*
      Individual Mix A  (mid poinC)        INDAM0*
      Individual Mix A  (high point)       INDAHtf*
      Individual Mix B  (low poinC)        INDBL##
      Individual Mix B  (aid point)        INDBMtf*
      Individual Mix B  (high point)       INDBH##
      Resolution Check                    RESCtf*
      Performance Evaluation Mixture      PEM##
      Toxaphene                           TOXAPH**
      Aroclor 1016                        AR1016**
      Aroclor 1221                        AR1221**
      Aroclor 1232                        AR1232##
      Aroclor 1242                        AR1242**
      Aroclor 1248                        AR1248*#
      Aroclor 1254                        AR1254**
      Aroclor 1260                        AR1260##
      Aroclor 1016/1260                   AR1660##

         The  Contractor  shall create  a unique  "EPA  Sample  No."  within an
         SDG  by replacing the Cwo-character "**" terminator of  the
         identifier with one or two characters or numbers,  or a
         combination of  both.

         If the standards are injected onto both GO columns on  the same
         instrument simultaneously, the same EPA Sample  Number  may be
         used for reporting data for  the standards  for both columns.   If
         simultaneous injections ere  not m~J~, then the  same number may
         not  be used.

Several other pieces of  information are common to  the header
information on some of the data reporting forms.   These include: Lab
Sample ID, Lab File ID,   Purge or Sample Volume,  GC Column  - ID,
Instrument ID,  Time Analyzed,  Date Received, Extracted,  and Date
Analyzed.

1.8.1    "Lab Sample ID"  is an  optional laboratory-generated internal
         identifier. Up  Co 12 alpha-numeric characters may be reported
         here.

1.8.2    "Lab File ID" is Che laboratory-generated  name  of Che  GC/MS
         data system file containing  information pertaining Co  a
         particular analysis.   Up to  14 alpha-numeric characters may  be
         used here.

1.8.3    "Purge Volume"  or "Sample Volume" is  the total  volume  of  water
         Chat was purged or extracted,  in milliliters.
                                     B-28
                                                                 10/92

-------
       1.8.4    There are two fields to be entered under "GO Column - ID."
               Inter the stationary phase of the GC column after "GC Column"
               and enter the internal diameter in millimeters after "ID."

       1.8.5    "Instrument ID" is the identifier that distinguishes each
               instrument used for analysis in the SDG.

       1.8.6    The "Time Analyzed" shall be in military time.

       1.8.7    "Date Received" is the date of sample receipt at the
               laboratory,  as noted on the Sample Traffic Report (i.e., the
               Validated Time of Sample Receipt).  "Date Received"  is entered
               as  MM/DD/YY.

       1.8.8    Enter the date on which the extraction procedure was started
               for "Date Extracted."  "Date Extracted" is entered as MM/DD/YY.

       1.8.9    For each  fraction,  the "Date Analyzed"  is the date of the
               sample analysis.   The date of sample receipt will be compared
               with the  extraction and analysis dates  of each fraction to
               ensure that contract holding times were not exceeded.   "Date
               Analyzed"  is  entered as MM/DD/YY,

1.9.   For pescicide/Aroclors, analyses on two GC columns are required.  The
      information on the two analyses is differentiated on some of the forms
      as "Date Analyzed (1)", "Date Analyzed (2)", etc.  The order of
      reporting is not important, but shall be consistent with the
      information reported on Form X.  When simultaneous injection is made on
      both GC columns,  the dates (and times) will be the same.  If
      simultaneous injections are not made, the (1) shall refer to the first
      analysis, and (2)  the second.  If only one analysis is required, leave
      the fields for the second analysis blank.

2.    ORGANIC ANALYSISDATA SHEET (?OHM I)

2.1   Target Compounds.   Fora I LCV, LCSV-1, LCSV-2, and LCP

      This font is used for reporting the detected concentrations of the
      target compounds  in the samples, Laboratory Control Samples,
      Performance  Evaluation Samples, and all blanks analyzed, including
      method blanks, instrument blanks, sulfur cleanup blanks, and storage
      blanks.

      Complete the header information on each Form I required, according to
      the instructions  in paragraph 1.

      Enter 1 for  the "Dilution Factor",  if a sample was not diluted or
      concentrated for  analysis.   If a sample has been diluted for  analysis,
      enter the "Dilution Factor" as a single number,  such as 100 when a
      sample is diluted by a factor of 100.   Enter 0.1 when a sample is
      concentrated by a  factor of 10.

      For volatlles, the "Purge Volume" is the total volume (in mL) purged
      for the analysis.

                                     B-29                              10/92

-------
For semivolatiles and pesticides, enter the "Concentrated Extract
Volume" and the "Injection Volume" in microliters.  The "Concentrated
Extract Volume" is the actual volume of the most concentrated sample
extract.  If a dilution of the sample extract is made in a subsequent
analysis, this volume will remain the same, but the dilution factor
will change.  Enter the "pH" of the sample before extraction, reported
to 0.1 pH units.  Enter "Y" or "N" for "Yes" or "No" under the "Sulfur
Cleanup" for the pesticides.

In the concentration column, for positively identified target
compounds, the Contractor shall report the concentrations as
uncorrected for blank contaminants.

For volatile and semivolatile results, report analytical results to one
significant figure if the value is less than 10, and to two significant
figures if greater than or equal to 10.

Report all pesticide/Aroclor results to two significant figures.

If the analytical result is greater than or equal to the quantitation
limit, report the result.

Under the column labeled "Q" for qualifier, flag each result with the
specific Data Reporting Qualifiers listed below.  The Contractor is
encouraged to use additional flags (however, see "X" below).  The
definition of such flags shall be explicit and shall be included in the
SDG Narrative.

For reporting results to the USEFA, the following contract specific
qualifiers are to be used.  The nine qualifiers defined below are not
subject to modification by the Contractor.  Up to five qualifiers may
be reported on Form I for each compound.

The nine defined qualifiers to be used are as follows:

U -      Indicates  compound was  analyzed for, but was  not detected.  The
         numerical  value  is the  sample  quantitation  limit and shall be
         corrected  for dilution.   For  example, 5 U for phenol in water
         if  the  sample final volume is  the protocol-specified final
         volume.  If a 1  to 10 dilution of the extract is necessary, the
         reported limit is  SO U.

J -      Indicates  an estimated  value.  This flag  is used under  the
         following  circumstances:  1) when  estimating a concentration for
         tentatively identified  compounds  where  a  1:1  response  is
         assumed, 2) when the mass  spectral and  retention  time  data
         indicate the presence of  a compound that  meets  the  volatile and
         semivolatile GC/HS identification criteria, and the result is
         less  than  the CRQL but  greater than zero, 3)  when  the  retention
         time  data  indicate the  presence of a compound that  meets  the
         pesticide/Aroclor identification  criteria and the result  is
         less  than  the CRQL but  greater than zero.   Note:   the  "J"  code
         is  not  used and  the compound  is not reported  as being
         identified for pesticide/Aroclor  results  less than  the  CRQL,  if

                               B-30                              10/92

-------
        the  technical judgement of the pesticide residue analysis
        expert determines that the peaks used for compound
        identification resulted from Instrument noise or other
        Interferences (column bleed, solvent contamination, etc.)-   For
        example, if the sample quantisation limit is 10 ug/L, but a
        concentration of 3 ug/L is calculated, report it as 3J.  the
        sample quantitation limit shall be adjusted for dilution as
        discussed for the U flag.

N -     Indicates presumptive evidence of a compound.  This flag is
        only used for tentatively identified compounds, where the
        Identification is based on a mass spectral library search.   It
        is applied to all TIC results.  For generic characterization of
        a TIC, such as chlorinated hydrocarbon, the N code is not used.

B -     This flag is used on the sample Form I when the analyte is
        found in the associated blank as well as in the sample.  It
        indicates possible/probable blank contamination and warns the
        data user to take appropriate action.  This flag shall be used
        for  a TIC as well as for a positively identified target
        compound.

        The  combination of flags "BU" or "UB" is expressly prohibited.
        Blank contaminants are flagged "B* only when they are detected
        in the sample.

E -     This flag Identifies compounds whose concentrations exceed the
        initial calibration range of the instrument for that specific
        analysis.  If one or more compounds have a response that exceed
        the  initial calibration range, the sample or extract shall be
        diluted and reanalyzed according to the specifications in
        Exhibit D. All such compounds should have the concentration
        flagged with an "E" on the Fora I for the original analysis.
        The  dilution of the extract may cause some compounds identified
        in the first analysis to be below the calibration range in the
        second analysis.  The results of both analyses shall be
        reported on separate Forms I.  The Form I for the diluted
        sample shall have the "DL" (or "DL2") (for pesticide samples
        only) suffix appended to the EPA Sample Number.  NOTE:  For
        total xylenes, where three isomers are quantified as two peaks,
        the  calibration range of each peak should be considered
        separately, e.g., a diluted analysis is nog required for total
        xylenes unless the concentration of the peak representing the
        single isomer exceeds 25 ug/L or the peak representing the two
        coeluting isomers on that GC column exceeds 50 ug/L.

D -     If a sample or extract is diluted and re-analyzed, as in the
        "I"  flag above, all concentration values reported on that Form
        I are flagged with the "D" flag.  The "DL" or "DL2" (for
        pesticide samples only) suffix is appended to the EPA Sample
        Number on the Form I for the diluted sample.

A -     This flag is not used under this contract, but is reserved for
        SMO  use.

                               B-31                             10/92

-------
      P -      This  flag  Is  used for a pestieide/Aroclor target analyte when
               there is a greater than 25.0%  difference  between the
               concentration calculated fron  the  two GC  columns (see Form X).
               The lower  of  the  two  values  is reported on Form I and flagged
               with  a "P."

      X -      Other specific flags  may be  required to properly define the
               results.   If  used,  they shall  be fully described and such
               description attached  to the  Sample Data Summary Package and the
               SDG Narrative.  Begin by using "X.*   If more  than one flag is
               required,  use "Y* and "Z", as  needed.   If more  than five
               qualifiers are required for  a  sample result,  use the "X" flag
               to combine several flags, as needed.   For instance,  the "X"
               flag  might combine the *A",  "B", and "D"  flags  for some sample.

2.2   Non-target Compounds.   Form I LCV-TIC and LCSV-TIC

      Form I LCV-TIC and LCSV-TIC are used for reporting the tentative
      identification and estimated concentration for up to 10 of the non-
      surrogate and  non-target organic compounds in the volatile fraction and
      up to 20'of the non-surrogate and non-target organic compounds in the
      semivolatile fraction.

      Include a Form I LCV-TIC or LCSV-TIC  for every volatile and
      semivolatile fraction  of every sample,  Performance Evaluation Sample,
      and blank analyzed. Form I LCV-TIC or  LCSV-TIC shall be provided for
      every analysis (except for the Laboratory Control  Samples) that
      requires a Form I for  target compounds, including required dilutions
      and reanalyses, even if no TICs are found.

      Fill in all header information as in  Section 2.1.

      Report tentatively identified compounds (TICs) including CAS number,
      compound name, retention time, and the  estitrated concentration
      (criteria for  reporting TICs are given  in Exhibit  D).   Retention time
      shall be reported in minutes and decimal minutes,  not seconds or
      minutes and seconds.

      If in the opinion of the mass spectral  interpretation specialist, no
      valid tentative identification can be made,  the compound shall be
      reported as unknown.

      Total the number of TICs found and enter this number in the "Number
      TICs found." If no  TICs were found, enter "0" (zero).

      If the name of a compound exceeds the 28 spaces in the TIC column,
      truncate the name to 28 characters.   If the compound is an unknown,
      restrict description to no more than  28 characters (i.e., unknown
      hydrocarbon, etc.).

      All  TIC results, except "generics" (See N flag)  are flagged "JN" in the
      "Q"  column to  emphasize the quantitative and  qualitative uncertainties
      associated with these  data.  This includes  "unknowns.*
                                     B-32                              10/92

-------
3.    S01B.OGAT1 RECOVERY.  FORM II LGV. LCSV. AND LCI

      Font II Is used to report the recovery of the surrogate compounds added
      to each sample, blank, Laboratory Control Sample, and Performance
      Evaluation Sample.

      Complete the header information on each Form II required, according  to
      the instructions in paragraph 1.

      In the table, enter EFA Sample Numbers for each analysis as described
      in paragraph 1.  For each sample, report the percent recovery for each
      surrogate to the nearest whole number,

      Flag each surrogate recovery outside the QC limits with an asterisk
      (*). The asterisk shall be placed in the last space in each appropriate
      column, under the "#" symbol.  In the far right-hand column, total the
      number of surrogate recoveries outside the QC limits for each sample.
      If no surrogates were outside the limits, enter "0."

      If a sample or extract is diluted and the surrogate recovery is below
      the recovery limits in any analysis, enter the calculated recovery or
      "O* (zero) if the surrogate is not detected.  Flag the surrogate
      recovery with a "D" in the column under the *#" symbol.   Do no^ include
      results flagged "D* in the total number of recoveries for each sample
      outside the QC limits.

      Pesticide/Aroclor samples are analyzed on two GC columns, and
      surrogates recoveries shall be reported for both analyses.  Enter the
      information on the stationary phases and internal diameters of the two
      GC columns, as described in paragraph 1.8.4, differentiating the GC
      columns as "(1)" and "(2).*  Enter the recoveries of the two surrogates
      for each column in a similar fashion.

      Number the Form II pages as described in paragraph 1.5.

4.    LABOIATORY CONTROL SAMPLE RECOVERY.   FORM III LCY.LCSV. AND LCP

      Form III is used to report the recovery of the spiked analytes in the
      Laboratory Control Sample (LCS).

      Complete the header information on each Form III required, according to
      the instructions in Sections 1 and 2.

      The "LCS Lot No." is an identification number assigned to the LCS
      spiking solution,  if the solution is provided under this contract.
      If the LCS solution is  purchased by the Contractor from a third party,
      report the identification number used by the laboratory under "LCS Lot
      No."

      The "LCS Aliquot" is the volume  in microliters of LCS spiking solution
      that was added to reagent water  before purging or extraction.

      For pesticides, the LCS is reported for both GC columns.  Enter the
      Instrument ID and GC Column - ID for analyses on both GC columns.  The

                                    B-33                               10/92

-------
      order of reporting is not important, but shall be consistent with  the
      information reported on Form X.  If simultaneous injections are not
      made, the "Date Analyzed" is the earlier date of the two LCS analyses.

      In the upper box in Form III, under "AMOUNT ADDED", enter the amount in
      nanograms of each analyte added to the sample.  Under "AMOUNT
      RECOVERED*, enter the amount in nanograms of each analyte in the sample
      calculated from analysis.  Calculate the percent recovery of each
      compound in the sample to Che nearest whole percent, according to
      Exhibit D, and enter under "% REG."  Enter the limits for each analyte
      in the column for "QC LIMITS."  The limits should be entered as two
      whole numbers (lower and upper limits) separated by a hyphen.  Flag all
      percent recoveries which do not meet the contract requirements with an
      asterisk (*).  The asterisk sh«*ll be placed in the last space of the
      percent recovery column, under the "#" symbol.

      Summarize the values outside the QC limits at the bottom of the page.

5.    METHOD BLANK SUMMARY.   FORM IV LCV. LCSV.  AND LCP

      Form IV lists the samples including LCS and PES associated with each
      method blank.   A copy of the appropriate Form IV is  required for each
      method blank.

      Complete the header information on each Form IV required,  according to
      the instructions in Sections 1.

      For semivolatile and pesticide/Aroclor method blanks,  enter the date of
      extraction of the blank.

      For pesticide/Arodors,  enter the "Date Analyzed" ,  "Time Analyzed" ,
      "Instrument ID",  and "GC Column - ID"  for  analyses on  both GC columns.

      For all three fractions,  as  appropriate,  summarize  the  samples,
      including LCS and PES  associated with  a given method blank in the table
      below the header,  entering EPA Sample  Number and Lab Sample ID.   For
      volatiles,  enter the Lab File ID and Time  Analyzed for each sample.
      For semivolatiles,  enter the Lab File  ID and Date Analyzed.  For
      pesticides/Aroclors,  enter the Date Analyzed on each GC column for  each
      sample.

      For pesticides/Aroclors,  enter "Y"  or  "N"  (for yes or  no)  under "Sulfur
      Cleanup.*  If a separate sulfur cleanup blank is prepared,  when not all
      samples associated with  a method blank are subjected to sulfur cleanup,
      then complete a separate Form IV for the sulfur cleanup blank,  listing
      the EPA Sample No.  of the blank,  as described in paragraph 1.9.6,  in
      the box in the upper right hand corner of  the form.  These samples
      associated with the sulfur cleanup  blank will be listed in the lower
      portion of the form,  as  well as on a copy  of Form IV for their
      associated method blank.   Whenever all the samples and their associated
      method blank are  subjected to sulfur cleanup,  no separate  sulfur blank
      is required,  and only one Form IV needs to be completed.

      Number the Form IV pages  as  described  in paragraph 1.5.

                                     B-34                             10/92

-------
6     GC/MS TUNING AND MASS CALIBRATION.  FORM V LCV AND LCSV

      This form is used to report the results of GC/MS tuning for volatiles
      and semivolatiles, and to summarize the date and time of analysis of
      samples, standards, and blanks associated with each GC/MS tune
      (including Laboratory Control and Performance Evaluation Samples).

      Complete the header information on each Form V required, according to
      the instructions in paragraph 1.

      Enter the "Lab File ID" for the injection containing the GC/MS tuning
      compound (BFB for volatiles, DFTPP for semivolatiles).  Enter the date
      and time of injection of the tuning compound.  Enter injection time as
      military time.

      In the upper table, for each ion listed on the form, enter the %
      Relative Abundance in the right-hand column.  Report relative
      abundances to the number of significant figures given for each ion in
      the ion abundance criteria column.

      Note that for both BFB and DFTPP,  one or more of the high mass ions may
      exceed the abundance of the ion listed on the form as the base peak
      (m/z 95 for BFB,  and m/z 198 for DFTPP).   Despite this possibility, all
      ion abundances are to be normalized to the nominal base peaks listed on
      Form V (see Exhibit D).
      All relative abundances shall be reported as a number.  If zero, enter
      "0",  not a dash or other non-numeric character.  Where parentheses
      appear,  compute the percentage of the ion abundance of the mass given
      in the appropriate footnote,  and enter that value in the parentheses.

      In the lower half of the form, list all samples,  standards, and blanks
      analyze'1 under that tune ir. rhronolofc..^.*! order .  by time of analysis
      (in military time).  Refer to paragraph 1 for specific instructions for
      identifying standards and blanks.  Enter "EPA Sample No.", "Lab Sample
      ID",  "Lab File ID", "Date Analyzed", and "Time Analyzed" for all
      standards,  samples including LCS and PES, and blanks.

      Number the Form V pages as described in paragraph 1.5.
7.     INITIAL CfU^frfflQN SUMMARY.   FORM VI LCV.  LCSV-1.  LCSV-2. LCP-1. LCP-2
      AND LCP-3

      For each fraction,  after a GC/MS or GC system has undergone an initial
      calibration,  and after all initial calibration technical criteria have
      been met, the Contractor shall complete and submit all Form Vis for
      initial calibrations performed relevant to the samples including LCS
      and PES and blanks  in the SDG, regardless of when that calibration was
      performed.

      Complete the header information on each Form VI required,  according to
      the instructions in paragraph 1.
                                     B-35                              10/92

-------
Enter the "Case No." and "SDG No." for the current data package,
regardless of the original Case for which the  initial calibration was
performed.  Enter "Instrument ID" and "Calibration Date(s)."   If the
calendar date changes during the calibration procedure, the inclusive
dates should be given on Font VI.

For the volatile and sealvolatile fractions, enter the "Lab File ID"
for each of the five calibration standards injected.  Complete the
response factor data for the five calibration points.  The relative
response factor (RRF) is reported for each target compound and
surrogate.  The Contractor shall report the average RRF and the percent
relative standard deviation (%RSD) for the RRFs for each target
compound and surrogate.

The initial calibration of pesticides and Aroclors involves the
determination of retention times, retention time windows, and
calibration factors.  For single component pesticide target compounds,
these data are calculated from the analyses of the Individual  Standard
Mixtures A and B at three different concentration levels.  For the
ntulticomponent target compounds, these data are calculated from a
single point calibration.

Complete header information on Form VI, LCP-1 and LCP-2 according to
the Instructions in paragraph 1.  For the three analyses of Individual
Standard Mixture A (low point,  mid point, and high point), and the
three analyses of Individual Standard Mixture B performed on each GC
column during an initial calibration, complete one copy of Form VI for
each GC column used.  Enter the Instrument ID, GC Column, and  ID as
described previously.  Enter the dates of analysis of the first and
last of the six standards on each form under "Date(s) Analyzed.*  Under
"Level (x low)*, enter the concentration of the low point, mid point,
and high point calibration stanr'Urds as £. ---Itiplier of the low point.
Therefore, for the low point, enter "1.0."  The concentration  of the
mid point standard is specified in Exhibit D as four times the  low
point, therefore, enter "4.0* for "mid.*  If the concentration is not
exactly 4.0 times the low point, enter the appropriate multiplier in a
similar format.  The high point standard shall be at least 16  times the
low point, but may be higher if that value lies within the linear range
of the instrument, as specified in Exhibit D.  Therefore, enter the
appropriate multiplier to the high point standard concentration to one
decimal place.

For the pesticides/Aroclors fraction, one Form VI (LCP-1 and LCP-2) is
required for each initial calibration performed on each GC column.  In
the table, on Form VI LCP-1, enter the retention time of each  analyte
in the low, mid, and high point Standard Mixtures A and B in the
columns labeled "RT of Standards."  Use the values from Standard
Mixture A for the surrogates.  Calculate and report in the appropriate
column the mean retention time and the retention time windows  for each
analyte.  Report the retention time window for each analyte as  a range
of two values, i.e., from 1.44 to 1.54.  Enter the lower value  of the
range in the column under "RT WINDOW" labeled "FROM."  Enter the upper
value of the range in the column under "TO."  Do not separate  the two
values with a hyphen, and do not enter the retention time window as a

                               B-36                              10/92

-------
      plus/minus value such as £0.05.  NOTE: By definition, the center of the
      retention time window shall be the mean retention time listed to the
      left of the retention time window.

      On Form VI LCP-2, calculate the calibration factor for each analyte in
      the low, mid, and high point Standard Mixtures A and B.  Use the values
      from Standard Mixture A for the surrogates.  Report the values under
      the columns labeled "CALIBRATION FACTORS."  Calculate the mean of the
      three calibration factors and the percent relative standard deviation
      (%RSD) for the calibration factor values for each analyte.  Report the
      calculated values under the "MEAN" and "%RSD" columns, respectively.

      On Form VI LCP-3, for the Initial calibration of multicomponent
      analytes,  enter the amount of standard injected in nanograms of each
      analyte, under the "AMOUNT" column.  The number of peaks with an
      asterisk under the "Peak* column indicates the minimum number of peaks
      calibrated for each analyte.   Enter the retention time of each peak
      used to quantitate under the "RT" column.  Data for two additional
      peaks may be reported for each multicomponent analyte.  Calculate and
      report the calibration factor for each peak used under "CALIBRATION
      FACTOR." "

8.     PESTICIDE RESOLUTION CHECK SUMMARY.  FORM VI LCP-4

      Pesticide  Resolution Check Summary Form VI is used to report the
      resolution of each analyte in the Resolution Check Mixture analyzed at
      the beginning of each initial calibration on each GC column.

      Complete the header information on each Form VI required according to
      the instructions in paragraph 1.

      For each GC column,  enter the "SPA Sample Number" of the Resolution
      Check Mixture, as described in paragraph 1.9.7, for the mixture
      injected on the first GC column.   Inter the Lab Sample ID, Date
      Analyzed (1), and Time Analyzed (1).

      In the table, under "ANALYTE",  enter the name of each analyte as It
      appears on Form I,  in elution order,  starting with the first target
      analyte or surrogate to elute.   Enter the retention time of each of the
      analytes listed under "RT."

      Calculate the percent resolution between each pair of consecutive peaks
      according to Exhibit D.   Enter the percent resolution of each pair in
      the "RESOLUTION" field of the analyte that elutes earlier (the analyte
      listed first).  The resolution shall be calculated for each adjacent
      peaks so that the resolution of peak 1 and peak 2 is calculated, as
      well as peak 2 vs.  peak 3, peak 3 vs. peak 4, etc.  The "RESOLUTION"
      field will be left blank for the last analyte in the table.  The
      percent resolution shall meet the QG limits listed at the bottom of the
      page.

      Complete the information for the second GC column in the same fashion.
                                     B-37                              10/92

-------
9.    CONTINUING CALIBRATION SUMMARY.  FOSK 711 LCV. LCSV-1 AND LCSV-2

      The Continuing Calibration Summary Form VII is used to verify the
      calibration of the GC/KS system by the analysis of specific calibration
      standards.  Form VII is required for each 12 hour time period for both
      volatile and semivolatile analysis.

      Couplete the header information on each Fora VII required, according to
      the instructions in paragraph 1.

      Enter date and time of continuing calibration standard analysis, the
      Lab File ID of the continuing calibration standard,  and date(s) of
      initial calibration.  Give inclusive dates if initial calibration is
      performed over more than one date.  Enter the average relative response
      factor (RRF) for each target compound that was calculated from the
      initial calibration data (referred to in the initial calibration
      date(s) analyzed field).  Report the relative response factor for each
      target compound and surrogate from the continuing calibration standard
      analysis.

10.   PSSTICIPt/AROCLQR CALIBRATION VERIFICATION

      Calibration Verification Summary.   Form VII LCP-1 and LCP-2

      The Calibration Verification Summary Fora VII is used to report the
      results of the Performance Evaluation Mixtures (PEM),  instrument
      blanks, and Individual Standard Mixtures A. and B analyzed at the
      beginning and end of a twelve hour sequence.   The Contractor shall
      submit this form for each twelve hour sequence analyzed.

      Complete the header information on each Form VII required according to
      the instructions in paragraph 1.

      Enter the initial calibration date(s) analyzed.   Give  inclusive dates
      if initial calibration is performed over more than one date.

      On Fora VII,  LCP-1,  enter the EPA Sample No.,  Lab Sample ID,  Date
      Analyzed, and Time Analyzed for the  instrument blank that preceded the
      twelve hour sequence (PIBLK).   For the PEM that initiated or terminated
      the twelve hour sequence (PEM),  enter the EPA Sample No.,  Lab Sample
      ID, Date Analyzed,  and Time Analyzed.

      When reporting data for the PEM at the beginning of  the initial
      calibration sequence,  leave blank the "EPA Sample No.",  "Lab Sample
      ID*,  and "Date* and "Time Analyzed*  fields for the instrument blank
      (PIBLK),  as no instrument blank is analyzed before this PEM.   When
      reporting all other PEM analyses,  the instrument blank fields shall be
      completed.

      In the table,  report the retention time for each analyte in the PEM as
      well  as the retention time windows.   For each analyte  in the PEM,  enter
      the amount of the analyte in nanograms,  to three decimal places,
      calculated to be in the PEM,  under "CALC AMOUNT." Enter the nominal
      amount of each analyte in the PEM under "NOM AMOUNT."   Calculate the

                                     B-38                              10/92

-------
      relative percent difference between the calculated amount and nominal
      amount for each analyte according to Exhibit D.  Report the values
      under "%D."

      Calculate the percent breakdown for endrin and 4,4'-DDT, and the
      combined percent breakdown in the FEM according to Exhibit D.  Enter
      the values for the breakdown of endrin and 4,4'-DDT In their respective
      fields immediately under the table.

      Form VII LCP-2 is used to report the dates and times of analysis of the
      instrument blanks and the results of the analyses of the midpoint
      concentrations of Individual Standard Mixtures A and B that, along with
      the FEM, bracket each 12-hour period of sample analyses.  One copy of
      Form VII LCP-2 shall be completed each time the Individual Standard
      Mixtures are analyzed, for each GC column used.   The form is completed
      in a similar fashion to Form VII LCP-1,  entering the EFA Sample No.,
      Lab Sample ID, Date Analyzed,  and Time Analyzed for the instrument
      blank immediately preceding the Individual Standard Mixtures A and B,
      and for the standards themselves.   The upper table on the form contains
      the retention time and amount data for Individual Standard Mixture A
      compounds.   The lower table contains the data for Mixture B.   Enter the
      data in these tables in a fashion similar to that for the FEM.
      Complete copies of Form VII LCP-1 and 2 for each standard reported in
      Fora VIII LCF.

11.    INTERNAL STANDARD AREA AND RETENTION TIME SUMMARY FORM VIII LCV.  LCSV-1
      AND LCSV-2

      Form VIII is used to summarize  the  peak areas  and retention times of
      the internal standards added to all  volatile and semivolatile samples
      and blanks.   Form VIII is  also  used to  check the internal standards in
      the initial calibration sequences.   The  data are used to determine when
      changes in internal standard responses will adversely affect
      quantitation of target compounds.   This  form shall be completed each
      time an initial calibration or  a continuing calibration is  performed,
      or when samples are analyzed under  the  same GC/MS  tune as an initial
      calibration.

      Complete the header information on  each Form VIII  required,  according
      to the  instructions In paragraph 1.

      Enter the Lab File ID,  Date Analyzed,  and Time Analyzed for the
      continuing  calibration standard.  If samples are analyzed Immediately
      following an initial calibration, before another GC/MS tune and a
      continuing  calibration,  Form VIII shall  be completed for the  initial
      calibration standard that  is the same  concentration as the  continuing
      calibration standard.   Enter the Lab  File  ID,  the  date and time of
      analysis,  the areas and retention times  of this  initial calibration
      standard in place of those  of a continuing calibration standard.

      From the results  of the analysis of  the  continuing calibration
      standard,  enter the area measured for each internal  standard  and  its
      retention time under the appropriate column in the  row labeled  "12  HOUR
      STD."  For  each volatile internal standard,  calculate  the area upper

                                     B-39                              10/92

-------
       limit  as  the  area  of  Che  particular  internal  standard  plus  40  percent
       of  its area,  and the  area lower  limit  as  the  area  of the  internal
       standard  minus 40  percent of  its area.  For each semivolatile  internal
       standard, calculate the area  upper limit  as the area of the particular
       standard  plus 100% of its area (i.e.,  two times the area  in the  12  HOUR
       STD box), and the  area lower  limit as  the area of  the  internal standard
       minus  50% of  its area (i.e.,  one half  the area in  the  12  HOUR  STD box).
       Report these values in the boxes labeled  "UPPER LIMIT" and  "LOWER
       LIMIT" respectively.

       For each volatile  and semivolatile internal standard, calculate  the
       retention time (RT) upper limit  as the RT of  the particular internal
       standard plus 0.33 minutes.   The lower limit  is the RT of the  internal
       standard minus 0.33 minutes.  Report these values  in the  boxes labeled
       "UPPER LIMIT" and  "LOWER  LIMIT"  respectively.

       For each sample including LCS and PES and blank analyzed  under a given
       continuing calibration, enter the EPA Sample  Number and the  area
      measured for each  internal standard and its retention time.  If the
       internal.standard area or  retention time  is outside the upper or lower
       limits calculated above,   flag that value with an asterisk (*).  The
      asterisk shall be placed  in the  far right hand space of the box for
      each internal standard area or retention  time, directly under the "#"
      symbol.

      If samples are analyzed immediately following an initial  calibration as
      described above,  enter the EPA Sample Number,  internal standard areas,
      and retention times for all five of the initial calibration standards.

      Number the Form VIII pages as described in paragraph 1.5.

12.    PESTICIDE/AROCLOR AHALYTICAL SEQUENCE.   FORM VIII LCP

      Form VIII  LCP is  required for each analytical sequence for each GC
      system and for each GC column used to analyze pesticide/Aroclors in an
      SDG.

      Complete  the header information on each Form VIII  required,  according
      to the instructions in paragraph 1.

      Enter the  initial  calibration date(s).   Give inclusive  dates if initial
      calibration is performed  over more than one date.

      At the top of the  table,  report the mean retention time for surrogates
      tetrachloro-m-xylene and  decachlorobiphenyl calculated from the initial
      calibration sequence under "TCX"  and  "DCB", respectively.   For every
      analysis associated with  a particular analytical sequence  starting with
      the  initial calibration,  enter the EPA Sample  Number,  Lab  Sample ID,
      Date Analyzed,  and Time Analyzed.  Each sample analyzed as part of the
      sequence shall be  reported on Form VIII LCP even if it  is  not
      associated with the SDG.   The Contractor may use the  EPA Sample No.  of
      "ZZZZZ" to distinguish all samples that are not part  of the  SDG being
      reported.   Report  the  retention time  of the surrogates  for each
      analysis under "TCX RT" and "DCB  RT."  All sample  analyses shall  be

                                     B-40                              10/92

-------
      bracketed by acceptable analyses of instrument blanks, a PEM, and
      Individual Standard Mixtures A and B.  Given the fact that the initial
      calibration may remain valid for some tine (see Exhibit D) ,  it is not
      necessary to report the data from 12 -hour periods when no samples in an
      SDG were run.  The Contractor shall deliver the Form VIII for the
      initial calibration sequence, and Forms that include the PEMs and
      Individual Standard Mixtures that bracket any and all samples in the
      SDG.  While the data for time periods between the initial calibration
      and samples in the SDG is not a routine deliverable, it shall be made
      available on request during on-site evaluations, etc.  Here again, non-
      EPA samples may be indicated with "ZZZZZ."

      Flag all those values which do not meet the contract requirements by
      entering an asterisk (#) in the last column, under the "*."   If the
      retention time cannot be calculated due to interfering peaks, leave the
      RT column blank for that surrogate, enter an asterisk in the last
      (i.e. ,  under "DCB") column, and document the problem in the SDG
      Narrative .

      Number the Form VIII pages as described in paragraph 1.5.

13,    PESTICIPB/AROCLOR FLORISIL CARTRIDGE cm^cy,  FORM 1
      Fora IX is required for each lot of Florisil cartridges that is used
      with samples associated with the SDG.

      Complete the header information on each Form IX required, according to
      the instructions in paragraph 1.

      Enter the "Case No." and "SDG No," for the current data package,
      regardless of the original Case for which the cartridge check was
      performed.  Enter the "Florisil Cartridge Lot Number."  Enter under the
      "Date Analyzed" , the date the Florisil cartridge check solution was
      analyzed.

      In the upper table, enter the amount of spike added and spike recovered
      in nanograms for each analyte.

      Calculate to the nearest whole percent, and enter the percent recovery
      in the "% REC" field.  Flag each spike recovery outside the QC limits
      with an asterisk (*) .  The asterisk shall be placed in the last space
      in the "% Rec* column, under the "#" symbol.

      In the lower table, enter the "EPA Sample No.", the "Lab Sample ID",
      and "Date Analyzed" for each sample and blank that was cleaned up using
      this lot of Florisil cartridges.

      Number the Form IX pages as described in paragraph 1.5.

14.   PESTICIPE/AROCLOR IDENTIFICATION.  FORM X LCP-1. LCF-2

      Form X summarizes the data used to identify and quantify all
      pesticide /Aroclor target analytes detected in a. given sample.  Form X
      LCP-1 is required for each sample (including PSS and LCS) or blank in

                                     B-41                              10/92

-------
      which any single component analytes is detected.  Fora X LCP-2 is
      required for each sample (including FES and LCS) or blank in which any
      multicomponent analyte is detected.  If no single component analyte or
      multicomponent analyte is detected in a sample, no copy of the
      applicable Form X is required for that sample.

      Complete the header information on each Form X required, according to
      the instructions in paragraph 1.

      For each target pesticide or Aroclor detected, enter the name of the
      analyte on Form X in the column labeled "Analyte", spelling the name as
      Is appears on Form I.  For the multicomponent analytes, there are
      spaces (fields) for up to 5 peaks for each analyte.  The asterisks
      indicate the number of peaks that are required, and data for additional
      peaks may be reported.  The retention time, retention time window, and
      concentration are calculated separately for each peak used for a
      multicomponent analyte.  For each GC column,  enter the retention times
      of the analytes detected In the sample next to the appropriate column
      designation (1 or 2).  Enter the retention time windows on each column
      of the appropriate standard.   The lower value is entered under the
      "FROM" column, the upper value under the "TO" column.  Do not use a
      hyphen.  These data shall correspond with those on Fora VI,  and are
      entered in a similar manner.  Calculate the concentration of the analyte
      using the calibration factors derived from the initial calibration
      sequence.  For the multicomponent analytes, calculate and report the
      mean concentration by averaging the concentration values from the peaks
      used for quantitation.  Calculate and report the percent difference to
      a tenth of a percent between the concentration values (or mean
      concentration values for multicomponent analytes) on the two GC columns
      under *%0* as described in Exhibit D.

      Number the Form X pages as described in paragraph 1.5.

                   THE FOLLOWING ARE DOCUMENT CONTROL FORMS

                      (To be submitted as hardcopy only)

15.    SAMfLI LOG-IN SHEET (FORMPC-11

      This form is used to document the receipt and inspection of samples and
      containers.  One original of Form DC-1 is required for each sample
      shipping container.  If the samples in a single sample shipping
      container (e.g., coolers) shall be assigned to more than one Sample
      Delivery Group, the original Form DC-1 shall be placed with the
      dellverables for the Sample Delivery Group with the lowest sample
      number and a copy of Form DC-1 shall be placed with the de live rabies
      for the other Sample Delivery Group(s).  The copies should be
      identified as "copy(ies)," and the location of the original should be
      noted on the copies.

      Sign and date the airbill (if present).  Examine the shipping container
      and record the presence/absence of custody seals and their condition
      (i.e., intact, broken) in item 1 on Form DC-1.  Record the custody seal
      numbers in item 2.
                                     B-42                              10/92

-------
      Open Che container, remove the enclosed sample documentation, and
      record the presence/absence of chain-of-eustody recqrd(s), SMO forms
      (i.e., Traffic Reports, Packing Lists), and airbills or airbill
      stickers in items 3-5 on Form DC-1.  Specify if there is an airbill
      present or an airbill sticker in item 5 on Form DC-1.  Record the
      airbill or sticker number in item 6.

      Remove the samples from the shipping container(s), examine the samples
      and the sample tags (if present), and record the condition of the
      sample bottles (i.e.,  intact, broken, leaking) and presence of absence
      of saaple tags in items 7 and 8 on Form DC-1.

      Review the sample shipping documents and complete the header
      information described in Part A.  Compare the Information recorded on
      all the documents and samples and mark the appropriate answer in item 9
      on Form DC-1.

      If there are no problems observed during receipt, sign and date
      (include time) Form DC-1,  the chain-of-custody record,  and Traffic
      Report,  and write the  sample numbers on Form DC-1.   Record the
      appropriate sample tags and assigned laboratory numbers if applicable.
      The log-in date should be recorded at the top of Form DC-1 and the date
      and time  of cooler receipt at the laboratory should be recorded in
      items 10  and 11.   Cross out unused columns and spaces.

      If there  are problems  observed during receipt or an answer marked with
      an asterisk (i.e.,  "absent*") was marked,  contact SMO and document the
      contact  as well as resolution of the problem on a CLP Communication
      Log.   Following resolution,  sign and date the forms as specified in the
      preceding paragraph and note,  where appropriate,  the resolution of the
      problem.

      Record the fraction designation (if appropriate)  and the specific area
      designation (e.g.,  refrigerator number)  in the Sample Transfer block
      located in the bottom  left corner of Form I.   Sign and date the Sample
      Transfer block.

16.    DQCTMENT INVENTORY SHEET (FORM DC-2^

      This  form is used to record the inventory of the  Complete SDG File
      documents and  count of documents in the  original  Sample Data Package
      which is  sent  to the Region.

      Organize  all complete  SDG file documents as described in Exhibit B,
      Section  II,  paragraph  5.   Assemble  the documents  in the order specified
      on Form  DC-2,  and stamp each page with a consecutive number.   (Do not
      number the DC-2 form).   Inventory the CSF by reviewing the document
      numbers  and recording  page number ranges in the columns provided in the
      Form  DC-2.   If there are no documents for a specific document type,
      enter an "NA"  in the empty space.
                                     B-43                              10/92

-------
Certain laboratory specific documents related to the CSF nay not fit
into a clearly defined category.  The laboratory should review DC-2 to
determine if it is most appropriate to place them under No. 7, 8, 9, or
10,  Category 10 should be used only if there is no appropriate
previous category.  These types of documents should be described or
listed in the blanks under each appropriate category.
                               B-44                             10/92

-------
     SECTION IV
DATA, REPORTING FORMS
         B-45                               10/92

-------

-------
                             1LCA
   LOW CONG. WATER VOLATILE ORGANICS ANALYSIS DATA SHEET
                                         EPA SAMPLE NO,
Lab Name:.

Lab Code:
Lab Sample ID:

Lab File ID:

Purge Volume:


       CAS NO.
Case No.:
Contract:.

 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
                          Date Received:

                          Date Analyzed:
   (ML)
   COMPOUND
         Dilution Factor:
               CONCENTRATION
                  (ug/L)        Q
       74-87-3	——Chloromethane	
       74-83-9	Bromome thane	
       75-01-4	Vinyl chloride	
       75-00-3	Chloroethane	
       75-09-2	Methylene chloride	
       67-64-1—-—.—Acetone	
       75-15-0	Carbon disulfide	
       75-35-4	1,1-Dichloroethene	
       75-34-3	1,1-Dichloroe thane	
       156-59-4	cis-l,2-Dichloroethene	
       156-60-5	—•	trans-1,2-Dichloroethene	
       67-66-3	Chloroform	
       107-06-2—	—1,2-Dichloroethane	
       78-93-3	2-Butanone	
       7 4 _9 7 -5 —.——,—Bromochl orome thane	
       71-55-6	1,1,1-Triehloroethane	
       56-23-5	—Carbon tetrachloride	
       75-27-4——-.	Bromodichloromethane	
       78-87-5	—1,2-Dichloropropane	
       10061-01-5	cis-1,3-Dichloropropene	
       79-01-6—'	—Trichloroethene	
       124-4 8-1	Dibromochloromethane	
       79-00-5	1,1,2-Trichloroethane	
       71-43-2	Benzene	
       10061-02-6	—-trans-1,3-Dichloropropene	
       75-25-2	•	Bromoform	
       108-10-1	—4-Methyl-2-pentanone	
       591-78-6-	2-Hexanone	,
       127-18-4	Tetrachloroethene	
       79-34-5	1,1,2,2-Tetrachloroethane	
       106-93-4—•	1,2-Dibromoethane	
       108-88-3	Toluene	
       108-90-7	-Chlorobenzene	
       100-41-4	Ethylbenzene	
       100-42-5	Styrene	
       1330-20-7'	Xylenes (total)	
       541-73-1	1,3-Dichlorobenzene	
       106-46-7	1,4-Dichlorobenzene	
       95-50-1	•—1,2-Dichlorobenzene	
       96-12-8	l,2-Dibromo-3-chloropropane_
                                FORM I LCV
                                                  10/92

-------
                            1LCB
LOW CONC. WATER SEMIVOLATILE ORGANICS ANALYSIS DATA SHEET
                                         EPA SAMPLE NO.
ab Name:,

ab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:

 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
ab Sample ID:

ab File ID:

ample Volume:
   (mL)
         Date Received:

         Date Extracted:

         Date Analyzed:
oncentrated Extract Volume:

njaction Volume:  	
                          Dilution Factor:

                          pH:  	 '
      CAS NO.
   COMPOUND
               CONCENTRATION
                  (ug/L)
      108-95-2	»	Phenol	
      111-44-4	•	bis(2-Chloroethyl) ether	
      95-57-8——	2-Chlorophenol	
      95-43-7	2-Methylphenol	
      108-60-1-	—2,2' -oxybis (1-Chloropropane)
      106-44-5	4-Methylphenol	
      621-64-7—-—-—N-Nitroso-di-n-propy1amine	
      67 -72-1-	Hexachloroethane	
      98-95-3	Nitrobenzene	
      78-59-1	——Isophorone	
      88-75-5——	2-Nitrophenol	
      105-67-9	—2,4-Dimethylphenol	
      111-91-1	bis (2-Chloroethoxy) methaneirii
      120-83-2	2,4-Dichlorophenol	
      120-82-1——	1,2,4-Trichlorobenzene	
      91-20-3	Naphthal ene	
      106-47-8-	4-Chloroaniline	
      87-68-3—•	—Hexachlorobutadiene	
      59-50-7	4-Chloro-3-niethylphenol	
      91-57-6	2-Methylnaphthalene	
      77-47-4	Hexachlorocyclopentadiene	
      88-06-2	2,4,6-Trichlorophenol	
      95-95-4-	2,4,5-Trichlorophenol	
      91-58-7-	2-Chloronaphthalene	
      88-74-4	2-Nitroaniline	
      131-11-3	DiBethylphthalate	
      208-96-8	Acenaphthylene	
      606-20-2	—2,6-Dinitrotoluene	
      99-09-2	3-Nitroaniline	
      8 3-32-9	—Acenaphthene	
                               FORM I LCSV-1
                                                  10/92

-------
                             1LCC
 LOW CONG.  WATER SEMIVOLATILE ORGANICS ANALYSIS DATA SHEET
                                         EPA SAMPLE  NO,
Lab Name:,

Lab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:

 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
Lab Sample ID:

Lab File ID:

Sample Volume:
   (mL)
         Date Received:

         Date Extracted:

         Date Analyzed:
Concentrated Extract Volume:

Injection Volume:  	 (uL)
                          Dilution Factor:

                          pH:  	
       CAS NO.
   COMPOUND
               CONCENTRATION
                  (ug/L)
       51-28-5	.	2,4-Dinitrophenol	
       100-02-7	"-•	4-Nitrophenol	
       132-64-9—	Dibenzofuran	
       121-14-2	2,4-Dinitrotoluene	
       84-66-2	Diethylphthalate	
       7005-72-3—	4-Chlorophenyl-phenylether_
       86-73-7	Fluorene	~
       100-01-6	4-Nitroaniline	
       534-52-1	4,6-Dinitro-2-methylphenol_
       86-30-6	N-Nitrosodiphenylamine (1) ~
       101-55-3	—4-Bromophenyl-phenylether_]
       118-74-1—	Hexaehlorobenzene	
       87-86-5	Pentachlorophenol	
       85-01-8	Phenanthrene	
       120-12-7	Anthracene	
       84-74-2 —	Di-n-buty Iphthal at e	
       206-44-0	Fluoranthene	
       129-00-0-	Pyrene	
       85-68-7	Butylbenzylphthalate	
       91-94-1	~3,3' -Dichlorobenzidine	
       56-55-3	Ben 20 (a) anthracene	
       218-01-9	Chrysene	
       117-81-7	bis (2-Ethylhexyl) phthalate_
       117-84-0	Di-n-octylphthalate	~
       205-99-2	Behzo(b) f luoranthene	
       207-08-9	Benzo (k) f luoranthene	
       50-32-8	Benzo(a)pyrene	
       193-39-5	Indeno(l, 2,3-cd) pyrene	
       53-70-3	Dibenz (a,h) anthracene	
       191-24-2	Benzo (g,h,i)perylene	
     (1) - Cannot be separated from Diphenylamine
                                FORM I LCSV-2
                                                   10/92

-------
                            1LCD
  LOW CONG. WATER PESTICIDE ORGAN!CS ANALYSIS DATA SHEET
                                         EPA SAMPLE NO.
,ab Name:,

,ab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:

 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
,ab Sample ID:

ample Volume:
   (mL)
oncentrated Extract Volume:

njaction Volumes 	 (uL>

ulfur Cleanup: (Y/N) 	
                .(uL)
         Date Received:

         Date Extracted:

         Date Analyzed:
                          Dilution Factor:

                          pH:   	
      CAS NO.
    COMPOUND
               CONCENTRATION
                  (ug/L)
      319-84-6	alpha-BHC	
      319-85-7	beta-BHC	
      319-86-8	del ta-BHC	
      58-89-9—	gamma-BHC (Lindane)
      76-44-8————Heptachlor	[
      309-00-2—	Aldrin	
      1024-57-3 ———Heptachlor epoxide_
      959-98-8	Endosulfan I	
      60-57-1	Dieldrin	
      72-55-9	4,4 '-DDE	
      72-2 0-8	Endr in	
      33213-65-9	Endosulfan II	
      72-54-8-—•—•	4,4 ' -ODD	
      1031-07-8-	Endosulfan sulfate_
      50-29-3	•	4,4 '-DDT	
      72-43 -5	Methoxychlor	
      53494-70-5	Endrin ketone	
      7421-36-3	Endrin aldehyde	
      5103-71-9	alpha-Chlordane	
      5103-74-2	gamma-Chlordane	
      8001-35-2	Toxaphene	
      12674-11-2	Aroclor-1016	
      11104-28-2-	•—Aroclor-1221	
      11141-16-5	•	Aroclor-1232	
      53469-21-9	——Aroclor-1242	
      12672-29-6	Aroclor-1248	
      11097-69-1	Aroclor-1254	
      11096-82-5	Aroclor-1260	
                               FORM I LCP
                                                  10/92

-------
                             1LCE
   LOW CONG.  WATER VOLATILE ORGANICS ANALYSIS DATA SHEET
                                      EPA SAMPLE  NO.
TENTATIVELY IDENTIFIED COMPOUNDS
Name : Contract :

Code: Case No.: SAS No.: SDG No.:
jab Sample ID:

l,ab File ID:

?urge Volume:

-------
                             1LCF
 LOW CONG. WATER SEMIVOLATILE ORGANICS ANALYSIS DATA SHEET
               TENTATIVELY IDENTIFIED COMPOUNDS
                                         EPA SAMPLE NO,
Lab Name:,
Lab Code:
Case No.:
Lab Sample ID:
Lab File ID:
Sample Volume:
   (mL)
Concentrated Extract Volume:
Injection Volume:  	 (uL)
Contract:
 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
         Date Received:
         Date Extracted:
         Date Analyzed:
                          Dilution Factor:
                          pH:  	
Number TICs found:
CAS NUMBER
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.

COMPOUND NAME































RT































EST. CONG.
(ug/L)































Q






























                                FORM I LCSV-TIC
                                                  10/92

-------
                             2LCA
           LOW CONC.  WATER VOLATILE SURROGATE RECOVERY
Lab Name:.

Lab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:

 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10-
11-
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
EPA
SAMPLE NO.





























BFB
%REC |





























OTHER





























TOT
OUT





























                   BFB
     Br onto f luorobenz ene
         QC LIMITS
           %REC
         (80-120)
                   I Column to be used to flag recovery values.
                   * Values outside of contract required QC limits.
                   D Surrogate diluted out.
3age  	 of 	
                                FORM II LCV
                                                   10/92

-------
                             2LCB
          LOW CONG.  WATER SEMIVOLATILE SURROGATE RECOVERY
Lab Name:,

Lab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:

 SAS No.;
SDG No.:
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
EPA
SAMPLE NO.









.
•


















NBZ
%REC 1





























FBP
%REC f





























TPH
%REC *





























PHL
%R£C f





























2FP
%REC #





























TBP
%REC I





























OTHER





























TOT
OUT





























      NBZ - Nitrobenzene-d5
      FBP » 2-Fluorobiphenyl
      TPH - Terphenyl-dl4
      PHL - Phenol-d5
      2FP * 2-Fluorophenol
      TBP » 2,4,6-Tribromophenol
                QC LIMITS
                  %REC
                (40-112)
                (42-110)
                (24-140)
                (17-113)
                (16-108)
                (18-126)
      I Column to be used to flag recovery values.
      * Values outside of contract required QC  limits,
      D Surrogate diluted out.
 age 	 of
                               FORM II LCSV
                                                  10/92

-------
                              2LCC
            LOW CONG.  WATER PESTICIDE SURROGATE RECOVERY
 Lab  Name:.

 Lab  Code:
   Column(1):
Case No.:

     ID:
   Contract:

    SAS No.:
(mm)   GC Column(2):
(mm)
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
EPA
SAMPLE NO.








.




















TCX(l)
%REC #





























TCX{2)
%REC |





























DCB(l)
%REC f





























DCB(2)
%REC f





























OTHER
CD





























OTHER
(2)





























TOT
OUT






















	



          TCX = Tetrachloro-n-xylene
          DCS = Decachlorobiphenyl
                  QC  LIMITS
                    %REC
                   (60-150)
                   (60-150)
          I Column to be used to flag recovery values.
          * Values outside of contract required QC limits.
          D Surrogate diluted out.
page 	 of 	
                                FORM II LCP
                                                  10/92

-------
                             3LCA
   LOW CONG,  WATER VOLATILE LAB CONTROL SAMPLE RECOVERY
                                          EPA SAMPLE NO.
Lab Name:.
Lab Code:
Lab Sample ID:
l,ab File ID:
'urge Volume:
jCS Aliquot: 	
Case No.:
   (mL)
 (uL)
Contract:.
 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
                          LCS  Lot No.:
                          Date  Analyzed:
         Dilution Factor:
COMPOUND
Vinyl chloride
1, 2-Dichloroethane
Carbon tetrachloride
1 , 2 -Dichloropropane
Trichloroethene
1,1, 2-Trichloroethane
Benzene
cis-1 » 3-Dichloropropene
Bromoform
Tetr achl oroethene
1, 2-Dibromoethane
1 , 4-Dichlorobenzene

AMOUNT
ADDED
(ng)












AMOUNT
RECOVERED
(ng)













%REC #












QC
LIMITS












   # Column  to  be used to flag LCS recovery with an asterisk.
   * Values  outside of QC limits.
  LCS Recovery:.
   outside limits out of
               total.
 DMMENTS:
                                FORM III LCV
                                                   10/92

-------
                             3LCB
 LOW CONG.  WATER SEMIVOLATILE LAB CONTROL SAMPLE RECOVERY
                                          EPA SAMPLE NO.
Lab Name:
Lab Code:
Lab Sample ID:
Lab File ID:
LCS Aliquot:
Case No.:
  (UL)
Concentrated Extract Volume:
Injection Volume:   	 (uL)
Contract:
 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
                          LCS  Lot  No. :
         Date Extracted:,
         Date Analyzed:
                          Dilution  Factor:
                          pH:  	
COMPOUND
Phenol
bis ( 2-Chloroethyl) ether
2 -Chi orophenol
N-Nitroso-di-n-propylamine
Hexachloroethane
Isophorone
1,2, 4-Trichlorobenzene
Naphthalene
4-Chloroaniline
2,4, 6-Trichlorophenol
2 , 4-Dinitrotoluene
Diethylphthalate
N-Nitrosodiphenylamine
Hexachlorobenzene
Benz o ( a ) pyrene

AMOUNT
ADDED
(ng)
















AMOUNT
RECOVERED
(ng)
















%REC |















QC
LIMITS
















    #  Column to be used to flag LCS recovery with an asterisk.
    *  Values outside of QC limits.
    LCS Recovery:
     outside limits out of
                 total.
:OMMENTS:
                                FORM III LCSV
                                                   10/92

-------
                             3LCC
   LOW CONG. WATER PESTICIDE LAB CONTROL SAMPLE RECOVERY
                                         EPA  SAMPLE NO.
Lab Name:
Lab Code:
Case No.:
Lab Sample ID:
^CS Aliquot:
  (uL)
:oneentrated Extract Volume:
Injection Volume:  	 (uL)
>ulfur Cleanup:  (Y/N)  	
Contract:
 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
                          LCS Lot No. :
         Date Extracted:
         Date Analyzed:
                          Dilution Factor:
                          pH:  	
Instrument ID{1)
                 GC Column(l):
                         ID:
               .(mm)
COMPOUND "
gamma -BHC (Lindane)
Heptachlor epoxide
Dieldrin
4.4'-DDE
Endrin
Endosulfan sulfate
gamma-Chlordane

AMOUNT
ADDED









AMOUNT
RECOVERED
C*g)







%REC f







QC
LIMITS







nstrument ID(2)  :
                 GC Column(2):
                         ID:
               .(mm)
COMPOUND
gamma-BHC (Lindane)
Heptachlor epoxide
Dieldrin
4.4' -DDE
Endrin
Endosulfan sulfate
qamma-Chlordane

AMOUNT
ADDED
(ng)







AMOUNT
RECOVERED
(ng)







%REC |







QC
LIMITS







 # Column to be used to  flag recovery values with an asterisk.
 * Values outside of QC  limits.
 LCS Recovery:	 outside limits out of 	 total.
3MMENTS:
                                FORM III LCP
                                                  10/92

-------
                             4LCA
       LOW CONG. WATER VOLATILE METHOD  BLANK  SUMMARY
                                          EPA SAMPLE NO.
Lab Name:.

Lab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:

 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
Lab Sample ID:

Lab File ID:

Instrument ID:
                          Date  Analyzed:

                          Time  Analyzed:
         THIS METHOD BLANK APPLIES TO THE FOLLOWING SAMPLES AND LCS:
COMMENTS:
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
EPA
SAMPLE NO.



.


























LAB
SAMPLE ID






























LAB
FILE ID






























TIME
ANALYZED





























page 	 of 	
                                FORM IV LCV
                                                    10/92

-------
                             4LCB
     LOW  CONG.  WATER SEMIVOLATILE METHOD BLANK SUMMARY
                                          EPA SAMPLE NO,
jab Name:_
,ab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:
 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
,ab Sample ID:
,ab File ID:
;nstrument ID:
                          Date Extracted:
                          Date Analyzed:
                          Time Analyzed:
        THIS METHOD  BLANK APPLIES TO THE FOLLOWING SAMPLES AND LCS:
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
23
29
30
EPA
SAMPLE NO.



.


























LAB
SAMPLE ID





























«
LAB
FILE ID






























DATE
ANALYZED





























OMMENTS:
age
       of
                               FORM IV LCSV
                                                   10/92

-------
                              4LCC
       LOW CONG.  WATER PESTICIDE METHOD BLANK SUMMARY
                                          EPA SAMPLE NO,
 Lab  Name:
 Lab  Code:
Case No.:
   Contract:_
    SAS No.:
SDG No.:
 Date Extracted:
                          Lab Sample ID:
 Date Analyzed (1):
 Dime Analyzed (1):
 Enstrument  ID (1):
 3C Column  (1): 	
      ID:
            Date Analyzed  (2): 	
            Time Analyzed  (2): 	
            Instrument ID  (2): 	
(mm)   GC Column (2) : 	.    ID:
                   (nun)
 Sulfur Cleanup:  (Y/N)  	
            THIS METHOD BLANK APPLIES TO THE FOLLOWING SAMPLES AND LCS;
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
EPA
SAMPLE NO.


























LAB
SAMPLE ID


























DATE
ANALYZED 1


























DATE
ANALYZED 2

























    COMMENTS:
page
        of
                                FORM  IV LCP
                                                   10/92

-------
                             SLCA
       LOW CONG.  WATER VOLATILE ORGANIC GC/MS TUNING AND MASS
               CALIBRATION - BROMOFLUOROBENZENE  (BFB)
l,ab Name:

l,ab Code:
             Case No.:
       Contract:.

        SAS  No,:
SDG No.:
.ab  File ID:

instrument ID:

JC Column:
                                    BFB Injection Date:

                                    BFB Injection Time:
               ID:
_(mm)
m/e
50
75
95
96
173
174
175
176
177
ION ABUNDANCE CRITERIA
3.0 - 40.0% Of mass 95
30.0 - 66.0% of mass 95
Base peak, 100% relative abundance
5.0 - 9.0% of mass 95
Less than 2.0% of mass 174
50.0 - 120.0% of mass 95
4.0 - 9.0 % of mass 174
93.0 - 101.0% of mass 174
5.0 - 9.0% of mass 176

% RELATIVE
ABUNDANCE




( )1

( )1
( )1
( )2

       1-Value is % mass  174
                                       2-Value is % mass 176
     THIS TUNE APPLIES TO THE  FOLLOWING SAMPLES, LCS, BLANKS, AND STANDARDS:
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
OS
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
EPA
SAMPLE NO.






















LAB
SAMPLE ID






















LAB
FILE ID






















DATE
ANALYZED






















TIME
ANALYZED





















age
of
                                FORM V LCV
                                                               10/92

-------
                             5LCB
    LOW CONG.  WATER SEMIVOLATILE ORGANIC GC/MS TUNING AND MASS
        CALIBRATION - DECAFLUOROTRIPHENYLPHOSPHINE  (DFTPP)
jab Name:

.jab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:,

 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
^ab  File ID:

[nstrument ID:
                     DFTPP  Injection Date:

                     DFTPP  Injection Time:.
m/e
51
68
69
70
127
197
198
199
275
365
441
442
443

ION ABUNDANCE CRITERIA
30.0 - 80.0% of mass 198
Less than 2.0% of mass 69
Mass 69 relative abundance
Less than 2.0% of mass 69
25.0 - 75.0% of mass 198
Less than 1.0% of mass 198
Base Peak, 100% relative abundance
5.0 to 9.0%-. of mass 198
10.0 - 30.0% of mass 198
Greater than 0.75% of mass 198
Present, but less than mass 443
40.0 - 110.0% of mass 198
15.0 - 24.0% of mass 442

% RELATIVE
ABUNDANCE

( )1

( )1








( )2

        1-Value  is  %  mass 69
                          2-Value  is  %  mass 442
     THIS TUNE APPLIES  TO THE FOLLOWING SAMPLES, LCS, BLANKS, AND STANDARDS;

01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
EPA
SAMPLE NO.






















LAB
SAMPLE ID






















LAB
FILE ID






















DATE
ANALYZED






















TIME
ANALYZED



*


















jage 	 of
            FORM V LCSV
                                 10/92

-------
                             6LCA
   LOW CONG.  WATER VOLATILE ORGANICS INITIAL CALIBRATION SUMMARY
Lab Name:

Lab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:_

 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
Instrument ID:
       Calibration Date(s) :_
IAB FILE ID: RRF1 =
RRF5 - RRF10-

COMPOUND RRF1
Chi or omethane
Bromomethane *
Vinyl chloride *
Chloroethane
Methylene chloride
Acetone
Carbon disulfide
1 , 1-Dichloroethene *
1 . 1-Dichloroethane.- *
cis-1 . 2-Dichloroethene
trans-1 . 2-Dichloroethene
Chloroform *
1 r 2 -Dichloroethane *
2-Butanone
Bromochl or omethane *
1,1, l-Trichloroethane *
Carbon tetrachloride *
Bromodichloromethane *
l , 2-Dichloropropane
cis-1 , 3-Dichloropropene
Trichloroethene
Dibromochloromethane
1,1, 2-Trichloroethane
Benzene
trans-1. 3-Dichloropropene
Bromoform
4 -Methvl -2 -pentanone
2-Hexanone
Tetrachloroethene *
1,1,2,2 -Tetr achl or oe thane *
1 , 2-Dibromoethane *
Toluene *
Chlorobenzene *
Ethylbenzene *
Styrene *
Xylenes (total! *
1,3-Dichlorobenzene *
1 , 4 -Dichlorobenzene *
1 , 2 -Dichlorobenzene *
1 . 2-Dibromo-3-chloropropane
Bromofluorobenzene *




RRF2










































RRF:
RRF:

RRF5










































i =
25=

RRF10













































RRF25













































RRF













































%
RSD

*
4




*
it


*
*

*
*
*
*

it
*
*
*
*
*
*


*
it
*
*
it
it
*
*
4
4
4

4

  Compounds  with required minimum RRF and maximum %RSD values.
  All  other  compounds must meet a minimum RRF of 0.010.
                              FORM VI LCV
                                                 10/92

-------
                             6LCB
 LOW CONC.  WATER S1MIVOLATILE ORGANICS INITIAL CALIBRATION SUMMARY
    Name:_

ab  Code:
Case No.:
Contract:

 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
Instrument  ID:
       Calibration Date(s):,

       Calibration Times:
LAB FILE ID: RRF5 =

KKr2U— KKT J>Um


COMPOUND
Phenol '
bis (2-Chloroethyl) ether '
2-Chlorophenol '
2-Methylphenol >
2,2' -oxybis ( 1-ehloropropane)
4-Methylphenol '
N-Nitroso-di-n-propylamine *
Hexachloroethane *
Nitrobenzene *
Isophorone "
2-Nitrophenol *
2 , 4-Dimethylphenol *
bis ( 2-Chloroethoxy ) methane *
2,4-Dichlorophenol *
1,2, 4-Trichlorobenzene *
Naphthalene *
4-Chloroaniline
Hexachl or obutadi ene
4-Chloro-3-methylphenol <
2-Methylnaphthalene <
Hexachl orocycl open tadiene
2,4, 6-Trichlorophenol *
2,4, 5-Trichlorophenol <
2-Chloronaphthalene
2-Nitroaniline
D ime thy Iph thai ate
Acenaphthylene *
2 , 6-Dinitrotoluene ^
3 -Nitroaniline
Acenaphthene J
2 , 4-Dinitrophenol
4 -Nitrophenol
Dibenzofuran *
2 , 4 -Dinitrotoluene *






RRF5
i
k
k
k

k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k
k


k
k

k
k



k
k

k


r
»






RRF1G



































RRF:
T3DTT1
rCrCr <


RRF20



































10=
2 A"—
SU53


RRF50








































RRF80








































RRF







































%
RSD
j
4
4
4

it
*
*
*
*
A
A
4
4
4
4


*
A

4
4



*
*

*


4
A

 Compounds with required minimum RRF and maximum %RSD values.
 All other compounds must meet a minimum RRF  of  0.010.
                                FORM VI  LCSV-1
                                                  10/92

-------
                             6LCC
 LOW CONC.  WATER SEMIVOLATILE ORGANICS INITIAL CALIBRATION SUMMARY
lab Name:

jab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:

 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
Instrument ID:
       Calibration Date(s):

       Calibration Times:
ILAB FILE ID: RRFS -
I RRF20- RRF50-



COMPODND
Diethvlohthalate
4 -Chlorophenyl-phenylether 	 '
Fluorene •
4 -Nitroanil ine
4 » 6-Dinitro-2-methylphenol
N-Ni t r osodipheny lamine ( 1 ) 	
4-Bromophenyl-phenyl ether 	
Hexachlorobenzene
RRFS
»
it





Pentachlorophenol
Phenanthrene
Anthracene
Di-n-butylphthalate
F luo ran then e
Pvrene
Butylbenzylphthalate
3,3' -Dichlorobenzidine


Benz o ( a ) anthracene *
Chrysene *
bis (2-Ethylhexyl) phthalate 	
Di-n-octylphthalate


Benzo(b) fluoranthene *
Benzo(k) fluoranthene *
Benzo (a) pyrene
Indeno (1,2,3 -cd) pyrene
Dibenz (a,h) anthracene
Benzo (g,h,i)perylene
RRF10

























RRF10-
RRF80-

RRF20


























RRF50

























RRF80

























RRF


























%
RSD

n
4
	

*
*
*
*
*

*
*

^
*


*
*
*
*
*
*

Nitrobenzene-dS
2-Fluorobiphenyl
Terphenyl-dl4
Phenol -d5
2 -Fluoroohenol
2,4, 6-Tribromophenol







































*
*
*
*


1) Cannot be separated from Diphenylamine
 Compounds with required minimum RRF  and maximum %RSD values.
 All other compounds must meet a minimum RRF  of  0.010.
                               FORM VI  LCSV-2
                                                  10/92

-------
                             6 LCD
    CONG. WATER PESTICIDE INITIAL CALIBRATION OF SINGLE COMPONENT ANALYTES
..ab Name:_
,ab Code:
Case No.:
                Contract:
                 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
Instrument  ID:
JC Column:  	
                                mid
	  Level (x low):  low 	
 ID: 	(mm)    Date(s)  Analyzed:
      high
COMPOUND
alpha-BHC
beta-BHC
delta-BHC
gamma-BHC (Lindane)
Heptachlor
Aldrin
Heptachlor epoxide
Endosulfan I
Dieldrin
4.4' -DDE
Endrin
Endosulfan II
4.4' -ODD
Endosulfan sulfate
4.4' -DDT
Methoxychl or
Endrin Ice tone
Endrin aldehyde
alpha-Chlordane
qamma-Chlordane

Tetrachloro-m-xylene
Decachlorobiphenyl

RT Ol
LOW



















	


f STANDS
MID



















• 	 '


\RDS
HIGH



















	 cm


MEAN
RT



















anssaes


RT w:
FROM



















=a«=>


ENDOW
TO




















^~rBSTrrT=


    * Surrogate retention times are measured  from Ind.  Mix A analyses.
    Retention time windows are ±0.05 minutes for all  compounds that
    elute before Heptachlor epoxide, ±0.07 minutes for all other
    compounds, except ±0.10 minutes for  Decachlorobiphenyl.
                                FORM VI  LCP-1
                                                  10/92

-------
                             6LCE
LOW CONG.  WATER PESTICIDE INITIAL CALIBRATION OF SINGLE COMPONENT ANALYTES
Lab Name:

Lab Code:
Case No.:
                Contract:

                 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
Cnstruxaent ID:

3C Column:  	
                                mid
	  Level  (x low):  low 	

 ID: 	(mm)    Date(s)  Analyzed:
      high
COMPOUND
alpha-BHC
beta-BBC
delta-BHC
gamma-BHC (Lindane)
Heptachlor
Aldrin
Heptachlor epoxida
Endosulfan I
Dieldrin
4. 4 '-DDE
Endrin
Endosulfan II
4, 4 '-ODD
Endosulfan sulfate
4,4' -DDT
Me thoxy chl or
Indrin Jcetone
Endrin aldehyde
alpha-chlordane
gamma -Chlordane 	
Tetrachloro-m-xylene
Decachl orob ipheny 1

LOW



















: 	 -"=™ 	 ••—— -^


CALIBRATK
MID



















,^rtJH* 	 - - -'i


3N FACTORS
HIGH



















™:":1 	 "T "• ~ j-'-™-*


MEAN




















" "•"" ~ " ~ T"*


%RSD






















 Surrogate calibration factors  are measured from Ind.  Mix A analyses.

 RSD must be less than or equal  to 20.0%  for all  compounds, except the
 arrogates, where %RSD must be less than  or equal to 30.0%.  Up to two
 arget compounds, but not surrogates, may have %RSD greater than 20.0%,
 it less than or equal to 30.0%.
                                FORM  VI  LCP-2
                                                  10/92

-------
                             6LCF
LOW CONG. WATER PESTICIDE INITIAL CALIBRATION OF MULTICOMPONENT ANALYTES
Lab Name:
Lab Code:
Instrument ID:
3C Column:
Contract:
Case No.: SAS No.: SDG No.:
Date(s) Analyzed:
ID: (mm)
COMPOUND
Toxaphene
Aroclor 1016
Aroclor 1221
Aroclor 1232
Aroclor 1242
Aroclor 1248
Aroclor 1254
Aroclor 1260
AMOUNT
(ng)















PEAK
*1
*2
*3
4
5
*1
*2
*3
4
5
*1
*2
*3
4
5
*1
*2
*3
4
5
*1
*2
*3
4
5
*1
*2
*3
4
5
*1
*2
*3
4
5
*1
*2
*3
4
5
RT








































RT w:
FROM








































ENDOW
TO








































CALIBRATION
FACTOR









































      * Denotes required peaks
                                FORM VI LCP-3
10/92

-------
                             6LCG
         LOW CONG,  WATER PESTICIDE RESOLUTION CHECK SUMMARY
-*ab  Name:,
    Code:
Case No.:
    Contract:
     SAS  No.:
SDG No.
;c Column  (1) :
      ID:
:PA Sample No.  (Standard 1):
 (mm)   Instrument ID (1):
       Lab sample ID (1):
rzed (1) : Time Analyzed (1) :
01
02
03
04
OS
06
07
08
09

ANALYTE



.






RT








RESOLUTION
(%)








C Column  (2):
      ID:
PA Sample No.  (Standard 2):
ate Analyzed  (2): 	
 (mm)  Instrument ID  (2):
	 Lab Sample ID  (2):
      Time Analyzed  (2):
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
ANALYTE









RT








RESOLUTION
(%)








 Resolution of two adjacent peaks must be  calculated as a percentage of the
 height of the smaller peak, and must be greater than or equal to 60.0%.
                               FORM VI  LCP-4
                                                 10/92

-------
                             7LCA
 LOW CONG.  WATER VOLATILE ORGANICS CONTINUING CALIBRATION SUMMARY
Lab Name;
Lab Code:
Instrument ID:

Case No. :
Contract :
SAS No.:
Calibration Date:

SDG No . ;
Time:
Lab File ID;
Init. Calib. Date(s) :_
     All  other compounds must meet a minimum RSF of 0.010.

                                FORM VII LCV
COMPOUND
Chloromethane
Bromomethane
Vinyl chloride
Chloroethane
Methylene chloride
Acetone
Carbon disulfide
1 , 1-Dichloroethene
1 f 1-Dichloroethane
cis-:l, 2-Dichloroethene
trans-1 , 2-Dichloroethene
Chloroform
1, 2-Dichloroethane
2-lutanone
Br omochl o rome thane
1,1, 1-Trichloroethane
Carbon tetrachloride
Bromodichlorome thane
1 f 2-Dichloropropane
cis-1 , 3-Dichloropropene
Trichloroethene
Dibromochloromethane
1 r 1 . 2-Trichloroe thane
Benzene
trans-1 , 3-Dichloropropene
Br onto fora
4 -Me thvl - 2 -pentanone
2-Hexanone
Tetrachloroethene
1 f 1 , 2 f 2-Tetrachloroethane
1 . 2-Dibromoethane
Toluene
Ch 1 or obenz ene
Ethylbenzene
Styrene
Xylenes (total)
1 , 3-Dichlorobenzene
1, 4-Dichlorobenzene
1 , 2-Dichlorobenzene
1, 2-Dibromo-3-chloropropane
Bromofluorobenzene

RRF










































RRF5










































MIN
RRF

0.100
0.100




0.100
0.200
0.100

0.200
0.100

0.050
0.100
0.100
0.200

0.200
0.300
0.100
*.100
0.500
0.100
0.050


0.200
0.100
0.100
0.400
0.500
0.100
0.300
0.300
0.600
0.500
0.400

0.200

%D










































MAX
%D

30.0
30.0




30.0
30.0


30.0
30.0

30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0

30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0


30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0

30.0

                                          10/92

-------
                             7LCB
1X3W CONG.  WATER SEMIVOLATILE ORGANICS CONTINUING CALIBRATION SUMMARY
.ab Name:
.,ab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:.
 SAS No.:
Instrument ID:
jab  File ID:
        Calibration Date:
        Init. Calib. Date(s):.
        Init. Calib. Times:
SDG No.:
 Time:
COMPOUND
Phenol
bis f 2-Chloroethvl) ether
2-Chlorophenol
2 -Methvlphenol
2,2' -oxybis ( 1-Chloropropane)
4 -Methylphenol-
N-Nitroso-di-n-propylaiiine
Hexachl oroethane
Nitrobenzene
Isophorone
2-Nitrophenol
2 . 4-Dimethylphenol
bis { 2-Chloroethoxy ) methane
2 , 4-Dichlorophenol
1.2. 4-Trichlorobenzene
Naphthalene
4 -Chloroanil ine
Hexachlorobuta* i ane
4 -Chloro-3 -methvlphenol
2 -Me thy Inaphthal ene
Hexachlorocyclopentadiene
2.4. 6-Trichlorophenol
2 . 4 f 5-Trichlorophenol
2 -Chi or onaphtha 1 ene
2-Nitroaniline
Dimethvlphthalate
Ac enaph thyl ene
2 , 6-Dinitrotoluene
3 -Ni troanil ine
Acenaphthene
2 . 4-Dinitrophenol
4-Nitrophenol
Dibenz o f ur an
2 . 4-Dinitrotoluene

RRF



































RRF20



































MIN
RRF
0.800
0.700
0.700
0.700

0.600
0.500
0.300
0.200
0.400
0.100
0.200
0.300
0.200
0.200
0.700


0.200
0.400

0.200
0.200
0.800


1.300
0.200

0.800


0.800
0.200

%D






















*












MAX
%D
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0

25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0


25.0
25.0

25.0
25.0
25.0


25.0
25.0

25.0


25.0
25.0

     All other compounds must  meet a minumum RRF of 0.010.
                                FORM VII  LCSV-1
                                                  10/92

-------
                            7LCC
,OW CONG. WATER SEMIVOIATILE ORGANICS CONTINUING  CALIBRATION SUMMARY
,ab Name:
ab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:
 SAS No.:
nstrument ID:
ab File ID:
        Calibration Date:
        Init. Calib. Date(s):.
        Init. Calib. Times:
SDG No.:
 Time:
COMPOUND
Diethylphthalate
4 -Chloropheny 1-phenylether
Fluorene
4-Nitroaniline
4 , 6-Dinitro-2-methylphenol
N-Nitrosodiphenylamine (1)
4 -Br omopheny 1 -pheny 1 ether
Hexachl or oben z ene
Pentachlorophenol
Phenanthrene
Anthracene
Di-n-butylphthalate
Fluoranthene
Pyrene
Butylbenzylphthalate
3,3' -Dichlorobenzidine
Benzo (a) anthracene
Chrysene
bis ( 2-Ethylhexyl ) phthalate
Di-n-octylphthalate
Benzo (b) fluoranthene
Benzo (k) fluoranthene
Benzo ( a ) pyrene
Indeno (1,2, 3-cd) pyrene
Dibenz (a , h) anthracene
Benzo(q,h, i)perylene

Nitrobenzene-d5
2 -Fluor ob ipheny 1
Terpheny 1 -dl 4
Phenol-d5
Fluorophenol
2,4, 6-Tribromophenol

RRF


































RRF20


































MIN
RRF

0.400
0.900



0.100
0.100
0.050
0.700
0.700

0.600
0.600


0.800
0.700


0.700
0.700
0.700
0.500
0.400
0.500

0.010
0.700
0.500
0.800
0.600


%D


































MAX
%D

25.0
25.0



25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0

25.0
25.0


25.0
25.0


25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
b>
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0
25.0


   (1)  Cannot be separated from Diphenylamine
     All other compounds must meet a minimum RRF of 0.010.
                               FORM VII LCSV-2
                                                  10/92

-------
                             7 LCD
  LOW CONG.  WATER PESTICIDE CALIBRATION VERIFICATION SUMMARY
Lab Name:_
Lab Code:
3C Column:
	:   Contract:i	
 Case  No. :  	  SAS No. :  	  SDG No,
   ID:       (nm)  Init. Calib.  Date(s):	
SPA Sample No.(PIBLK):
Lab Sample ID (PIBLK) :.
2PA Sample No.(PEM): _
jab Sample ID (PEM):	
                           Date Analyzed
                           Time Analyzed
                           Date Analyzed
                           Time Analyzed
1 PEM
! COMPOUND
alpha-BHC
beta-BHC
gamma - BHC ( Lindane )
Endrin
4, 4 '-DDT
Methoxychlor

RT






RT w:
FROM






ENDOW
TO






CALC
AMOUNT
(«g)






NOM
AMOUNT
(ng)






%D






 ,4'-DDT % breakdown (1):
Combined % breakdown (1):
                      Endrin  %  breakdown (1):
>C LIMITS:
     %D of amounts in PEM must be greater than or equal to -25% and less
     than or equal to 25.0%
     4,4'-DDT breakdown must be less than or equal to 20.0%
     Endrin breakdown must be less than or equal to 20.0%
     Combined breakdown must be less than or equal to 30.0%
                                FORM VII LCP-1
                                                   10/92

-------
                             7LCE
 LOW CONG. WATER PESTICIDE CALIBRATION VERIFICATION SUMMARY
,ab Name:_
,ab Code:
;c Column:
Contract:,
 SAS No.:
 Case No.:  	  SAS No.: 	  SDG No.:
	  ID:  	(nun)  Init. Calib. Date(s) :
;PA Sample No.(PIBLK):
^b Sample ID  (PIBLK):
:PA Sample No.(INDA):
,ab Sample ID  (INDA) :
         Date Analyzed  :
         Time Analyzed  :
         Date Analyzed  :.
         Time Analyzed  :_
:PA Sample No.(INDB):
,ab Sample ID  (INDB) :
INDIVIDUAL MIX A
COMPOUND
alpha-BHC
qamma-BHC ( Lindane )
Heptachlor
Endosulfan I
Dieldrin
Endrin
4.4' -ODD
4.4' -DDT
Methoxychlor
Tetrachloro-m-xvlene
Decachlorobiohenvl

RT











RT W]
FROM











ENDOW
TO











CALC
AMOUNT
(ng)











NOM
AMOUNT
(ng)











%D



	
	





         Date Analyzed  :.
         Time Analyzed  :_
INDIVIDUAL MIX B
COMPOUND
beta-BHC
delta-BHC
Aldrin
Heptachlor eooxide
4.4' -DDE
Endosulfan II
Endosulfan sulfate
Endrin ketone
Enrin aldehyde
alpha-Chlordane
gamma-Chlorodane
Tetrachloro-m-xylene
Decachl or ob ipheny 1

RT













RT W]
FROM













:NDOW
TO













CALC
AMOUNT
(ng)













NOM
AMOUNT
(ng)













%D







	




 QC LIMITS:   %D of amounts in the Individual Mixes must be greater than or
              equal to -25% and less than or equal to 25.0%.
                                FORM VII LCP-2
                                  10/92

-------
                             SLCA
   LOW CONC. WATER VOLATILE INTERNAL STANDARD AREA AND kT SUMMARY
Lab Name:

Lab Codes
             Case No.:
Contract:

 SAS No.:
SD6 No.:
Lab File ID (Standard):

Instrument ID:  __________

3C Column: 	 ID:
                                         Date Analyzed:,

                                         Tine Analyzed:.
 01
 02
 03
 04
 05
 06
 07
 08
 09
 10
 11
 12
 13
 14
 15
 16
 17
 18
 19
 20
 21
 22

12 HOUR STD
UPPER LIMIT
LOWER LIMIT

EPA SAMPLE
NO.






















ISl(CBZ)
AREA f




-






















RT #



	
















•






IS2 (DFB)
AREA #



	























RT #



	























IS3(DCB)
AREA #



-,-„--„_,-„_ _ iu.m ,- -,.._.























RT f



_T_^W_ 	 .___ 	























   IS1  (CBZ)  » Chlorobenzene-d5
   IS2  (DFB)  «• 1,4-Difluorobenzene
   IS3  (DCS)  - 1,4-Dichlorobenzene-d4

   AREA UPPER LIMIT » +40% of internal standard area.
   AREA LOWER LIMIT = -40% of internal standard area.
   RT UPPER  LIMIT = -t-0.33 minutes of internal standard RT.
   RT LOWER  LIMIT = -0.33 minutes of internal standard RT.

   I Column  used to flag internal standard area and RT values with an  asterisk.
   * Values  outside of QC limits.
 age
of
                                 FORM VIII LCV
                                                                10/92

-------
                             8LCB
 X3W CONC. WATER SEMIVOLATILE INTERNAL STANDARD AREA AND RT  SUMMARY
 ,ab Name:

 ,ab Code:
Case No.:
Contract;.

 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
 ab File ID (Standard):

 nstrument ID:
                            Date Analyzed:

                            Time Analyzed:,
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22

12 HOUR STD
UPPER LIMIT
LOWER LIMIT
EPA SAMPLE
NO.





















ISl(DCB)
AREA |


-.., .„.••...—





















RT #


	





















IS2 (NPT)
AREA f



— — —





















RT |


=*,=,





















IS3(ANT)
AREA *


, 	 •„ 	 ..,.-





















RT #

























  IS1  (DCB) »  1,4-Dichlorobenzene-d4
  IS2  (NPT) »  Naphthalene-d8
  IS3  (ANT) =  Acenaphthene-dlO

  AREA UPPER LIMIT -  +100%  of internal standard area.
  AREA LOWER LIMIT *  -50% of  internal standard area.
  RT UPPER LIMIT - 4-0.33 minutes of internal standard RT.
  RT LOWER LIMIT = -0.33 minutes of internal standard RT.

  # Column used  to flag  internal standard area and RT values with an asterisk.
  * Values outside of QC limits.

-------
                             8LCC
LOW CONC. WATER SEMIVOLATILE INTERNAL STANDARD AREA AND RT SUMMARY
lab Name:

lab Code:
            Case  No
Contract:

 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
Lab File ID (Standard):

instrument ID:
                                         Date Analyzed:,

                                         Time Analyzed:.






01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22

12 HOUR STD
UPPER LIMIT
LOWER LIMIT

EPA SAMPLE
NO.






















IS4 (PHN)
AREA |



























RT f



























ISS(CRY)
AREA |
















,










RT |



























IS6(PRY)
AREA 1



_ __ 	 TTT,-, 	 »























RT 1



























   IS4  (PHN)  »  Phenanthrene-dlQ
   IS5  (CRY)  -  Chrysene-dl2
   IS6  (PRY)  -  Perylene-dl2

   AREA UPPER LIMIT  -  +100%  of internal standard area.
   AREA LOWER LIMIT  »  -50% of internal standard area.
   RT UPPER  LIMIT »  +0.33  minutes of internal standard RT.
   RT LOWER  LIMIT -  -0.33  minutes of internal standard RT.

   # Column  used  to  flag internal standard area and RT values with an asterisk.
   * Values  outisde  of QC  limits.
sage
of
                                FORM VIII LCSV-2
                                                               10/92

-------
Lab Name:_

Lab Code:

3C Column:
                             8 LCD
            LOW CONC. WATER PESTICIDE ANALYTICAL SEQUENCE
Contract:,

 SAS No.:
Case No.: 	  SAS No.: 	  SDG No.:

  ID: 	(mm) Init. Calib. Date(s):	
Instrument ID:
  THE ANALYTICAL SEQUENCE OF PERFORMANCE EVALUATION MIXTURES,  BLANKS,
               SAMPLES, AND STANDARDS IS GIVEN BELOW:
      01
      02
      03
      04
      05
      06
      07
      08
      09
      10
      11
      12
      13
      14
      15
      16
      17
      18
      19
      20
      21
      22
      23
      24
      25
      26
      27
      28
      29
      30
      31
      32
MEAN SURROC
TCX:

EPA
SAMPLE NO.



.




























3ATE RT FROM :
DCB:

LAB
SAMPLE ID
































CNITIAL CAL:

DATE
ANALYZED
































CBRATION

TIME
ANALYZED


































TCX
RT #


































DCB
RT *
































        TCX » Tetrachloro-m-xylene
        DCB = Decachlorobiphenyl
   QC LIMITS
(± 0.05 MINUTES)
(± 0.10 MINUTES)
        # Column used to flag retention time values with an asterisk.
        * Values outside of QC limits.
page 	 of 	
                                FORM VIII LCP
                                 10/92

-------
                             9LCA
       LOW CONC. WATER PESTICIDE FLORISIL CARTRIDGE CHECK
,ab Name:.
,ab Code:
Case No.:
Contract:
 SAS No.:
SDG No.:
'lorisil Cartridge  Lot  Number:
;c Column(1): 	 ID:
                      Date Analyzed:
              .(mm)  GC Column(2):
         ID:
                                      (mm)
COMPOUND
alDha-BHC
gamma -BHC
Hectachlor
Endosulfan I
Dieldrin
Endrin
4.4' -ODD
4.4' -DDT
Methoxvchl or,.
Tetrachl oro-m-xy 1 ene
Decachl or ob ipheny 1

SPIKE
ADDED
(ng)












SPIKE
RECOVERED
(«g)











%
REC 1











QC
LIMITS
80-120
80-120
80-120
80-120
80-120
80-120
80-120
80-120
80-120
80-120
80-120
    i Column to be used to  flag recovery with an asterisk
    * Values outside of QC  limits
 THIS CARTRIDGE LOT APPLIES TO THE  FOLLOWING  SAMPLES,  BLANKS, AND LCS;
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
EPA
SAMPLE NO.























LAB
SAMPLE ID






















DATE
ANALYZED 1























DATE
ANALYZED 2






















age 	 of 	
                               FORM  IX  LCP
                                                   10/92

-------
                              10LCA
      LOW CONG. WATER PESTICIDE  IDENTIFICATION SUMMARY
                FOR SINGLE COMPONENT ANALYTES
                                                      EPA SAMPLE NO.
,ab Name:.
,ab Code:
            Case  No.:
    Contract:.
     SAS  No.:
SDG No.:
    Sample ID :
Instrument ID (1) :
;c Column (1): 	
                 ID:
       Date(s)  Analyzed:
       Instrument ID (2):
.(mm)   GC  Column(2): 	
         ID:
.(mm)
ANALYTE

..







COL
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
RT
















RT W
FROM
















INDOW
TO








•







CONCENTRATION

















%D








>age
of
                                FORM X LCP-1
                                                               10/92

-------
                             10LCB
      LOW CONC.  WATER PESTICIDE IDENTIFICATION SUMMARY
                 FOR MULTICOMPONENT ANALYTES
                                         EPA SAMPLE  HO.
Lab Name:,
    Code:
Case No.:
   Contract:
    SAS No.:
SDG No.:
Lab Sample ID :
Instrument ID (1):
;c Column (1): 	
     ID:
      Date(s)  Analyzed:
      Instrument ID (2):
(mm)   GC Column(2): 	
         ID:
ANALYTE

COLUMN 1
COLUMN 2

COLUMN 1
COLUMN 2

COLUMN 1
COLUMN 2
PEAK
*1
*2
*3
4
5
s
*1
*2
*3
4
5
*1
*2
*3
4
5
*1
*2
*3
4
5
*1
*2
*3
4
5
*1
*2
*3
4
5
RT









-.,..-....









ai.a-i-.JlB










RT w:
FROM









	 ""*• ••'""









" •"••"' '










LNDOW
TO









• ""' "









"' '"•'=










CONCENTRATION

































MEAN
CONCENTRATION









%D




 \t  least  3  peaks  are  required for identification of multicomponent analytes
 age 	 of 	
                                FORM X LCP-2
                                                  10/92

-------
SAMPLE LOG-IN SHEET
Lab Name: Page of

Received By (Print Name): 	 	 _ 	 LOB in Date'
Received By (Signature):

Cue Number:
Sample Delivery
Group No.:
SAS Number:
REMARKS:
1. Cujttxly Seal(j) Presern/Arwem*
Intact/Broken
1 rWndy Se«l Mnt-

3- Quio-of-Ciutody Present/Absent*
fuBCQCtUl
4. Traffic Reports or Present/ Ab«nt"
Packiaf LiM
5. Airbill Airbill/Sticket
Preseni/Afaceat*
6- AifWI| M« -

7 ^Bt««nljk T*a* rVeseot/Ahsent*
Simple Tag Luted/Not Listed
Numbers ' onQmn-of-
Ciutody
8. Sample Condiuon: Inud/Brokea*/
LealBBx
9- Does infonnatioB on
custody records, traffic
reports, uid sample tags
agree? Yes/No*
10. Dale Received at Lab: 	 	 - 	
' ' - Time R«ri"<*l: 	 	 	 ,, . „.



Sample Transfer

AT-* »•
Bv: 	
On:

EPA
SAMPLE
f


























CORRESPONDING
SAMPLE
TAG
•

























ASSIGNED
LAB
f


























REMARKS:
CONDITION
OF SAMPLE
SHIPMENT, ETC.

























* Contact SMO and anach record of resolution
Reviewed By: 	__
Date:	
       Logbook No.:
       Logbook Page No:

FORM DC-i

-------
      LOW CONCENTRATION WATER FOR ORGANICS COMPLETE SDG FILE (CSF) INVENTORY SHEET
  UBOWTORT N«« 	 CITY/STATI
  CASE HO. 	 SBC NO. 	 SOG MOS. TO FOLLOW	SAS
  NO. 	.


  COMTWCT MO. 	METHOD HO.
 All documents  delivered in  the complete  SDG  file  must  be original  documents
 where  possible.  (REFERENCE EXHIBIT B, SECTION  II, PARAGRAPH 5,  and SECTION III,
 PARAGRAPH 16.)

                                                             PAGE NOs         CHECK
                                                            FROM   TO      LAB     EPA

 Inventory Sheet (Form DC-2) (Do not number)
 SDG Case
Traffic Report
Volatile* Data
a.  QC Summary
     Surrogate Percent Recovery  Summary (Form II LCV)
     Lab Control Sample Recovery (From III LCV)
     Method Blank Summary  (Form  IV LCV)
     Tuning and Mass Calibration (Form V LCV)

b.  Sample Data
     TCL Results - (Form I LCV)
     Tentatively Identified Compounds  (Form I  LCV-TIC)
     Reconstructed total ion chromatograms (RIC)
       and Quantitation Reports  for each sample
     For each sample:
       Raw spectra and background-subtracted
         mass spectra of target  compounds identified
       Mass spectra of all reported TICs with  three
         best library matches

e.  Standards Data (All Instruments)
     Initial Calibration Summary (Form VI LCV)
     RICs and Quan Reports for all Standards
     Continuing Calibration (Form VII  LCV)
     RICs and Quant Reports for  all Standards
     Internal Standard Area and  RT Summary
       (Form VIII LCV)

d.  QC Data
     BFB
     Blank Data
     LCS Data
     PES Data

Semivolatiles Data
a.  QC Summary
     Surrogate Percent Recovery  Summary (Form  II  LCSV)
     Lab Control Sample Recovery (Form III  LCSV)
     Method Blank Summary  (Form  IV LCSV)
     Tuning and Mass Calibration (Form V LCSV)
                                      FORM DC-2-1

                                                                                       10/92

-------
 LOW CONCENTRATION WATER FOR ORGANICS COMPLETE SDG FILE (CSF) INVENTORY SHEET  (Cont.)
  CASE MO.
                 SOG MO.
                                SOC MOS. TO FOLLOW
                                                                      SAS NO.
                                                             PAGE NOs
                                                            FROM  TO
    CHECK
LAB    EPA
 Semlvolatiles Data (conC.)
 b.  Sample Data
     TCL Results  (Fora I  LCSV)
     Tentatively  Identified Compounds (Fora I LCSV-TIC)
     Reconstructed  total  ion chromatograms (RIC)
       and Quantisation Reports for each sample
     For each sample:
       Raw spectra  and background-subtracted
         mass spectra  of  TCL compounds
       Mass spectra of TICs with three best library matches
         GPC chromatograms  (if  GPC  performed)

 c.  Standards Data "'(All Instruments)
     Initial Calibration  Summary (Fora VI LCSV)
     RICs and Quan  Reports  for  all  Standards
     Continuing Calibration (Fora VII LCSV)                 ~
     RICs and Quan Reports  for  all  Standards               ~
     Internal Standard Area and RT  Summary
       (Fora VIII LCSV)

 d.  QC  Data
     DFTPP
     Blank Data
     LCS Data
     FES Data
Pesticides

a.  QC Summary
     Surrogate Percent Recovery Summary (Form II LCP)
     Lab Control Sample Recovery (Form III LCP)
     Method Blank Summary (Fora IV LCP)

b.  Sample  Data                                            	
     TCL Results - Organic Analysis Data Sheet
       (Fora I LCP)
     Chromatograms (Primary Column)
     Chromatograms from second GC column confirmation
     GC Integration report or data system printout and
       calibration plots
     Manual work sheets
     For pesticides/Arodors confirmed by GC/MS, copies
       of raw spectra and copies of background-subtracted mass
       spectra of target compounds (samples & standards)
                                      FORM DC-2-2
                                                                                       10/92

-------
 LOW CONCENTRATION WATER FOR ORGANICS COMPLETE SDG FILE (CSF) INVENTORY SHEET  (Cone.)
  CASE MO. 	  SOC MO. 	 SOC MOS. TO FOLLOW 	  	      -    SAS MO.
                                                              PAGE NOs        CHECK
                                                            FROM   TO      LAB    EPA
 PaaticIdas (cont.)

 c.  Standards Data
      Initial  Calibration Data (Fora VI LCP)
      Calibration Verification (Fora VII LCP)
      Pesticides Analytical Sequence (Form VIII,
        LCP-1  and -2)
      PesticideFlorisil Cartridge Check (Fora IX, LCP)
      Pesticide Identification (Fora X LCP)
      Standard chromatograms and data system printout
        for  all Standards
      For pesticides/Aroclors confirmed by GC/MS, copies
        of spectra for standards used
 d.  QC Data
      Blank Data
      LCS  Data
      PES  Data

 Miscellaneous Data

  Original preparation and analysis forms or copies of
    preparation and analysis logbook pages
  Internal sample and sample extract transfer
    chain-of-custody records
  Screening records
  All instrument output, including strip charts
    from screening activities (describe or list)
              deceiving
  Airbills (No. of shipments _ )
  Chain-of-Custody Records
  Sample Tags
  Sample Log- In Sheet (Lab & DC1)
  SDG Cover Sheet
  Miscellaneous Shipping/Receiving Records
    (describe or list)
 Internal  Lab Sample Transfer Records and Tracking Sheets
(describe  or list)
                                       FORM DC-2-3

                                                                                        10/92

-------
    LOW GONCENTRATIOH WATER FOR ORGANICS COMFLETE SDG FILE  (CSf)  INVENTORY SHEET  (Gont.)
      CASE NO.
                     SOG MO.
                                    SOS NOS, TO FOLLOW
 0.   Other Records (describe or list)

      Telephone Communication Log
 1.  Comments!
                                                                           SAS MO.
                                                                  PAGE  NOs         CHECK
                                                                 FIIOM   TO      LAB    EPA
Completed by:
  (CLP  Lab)
(Signature)
(Printed Name/Title)
(Date)
Audited by:
  (EPA)
(Signature)
(Printed Name/Title)
(Date)
                                           FORM DC-2-4
                                                                                             10/92

-------
                                   EXHIBIT C
                        TARGET COMPOUND LIST (TCL) AND
                 CONTRACT  REQUIRED QUANTITATION LTKTTS (CRQLs)
NOTE:   The values  in these  tables are quantisation limits,  not absolute
        detection limits.  The amount of material necessary  to produce a
        detector response  that can be identified and reliably quantified is
        greater than  that  needed to simply be detected above the background
        noise.  Zr.cept as  noted,  the -uantitatxuu limits in  these tables are
        set at the  concentrations in the sample equivalent to the
        concentration of the lowest calibration standard analyzed for each
        analyte.
                                     C-l                               10/92

-------
       TARGET COMPOUND LIST (TCL) AND
CONTRACT REQUIRED QUANTITATION LIMITS (GRQL)
                                      Quant i tat ion Limits

1.
2.
3.
4.
' 5.
6.
7,
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29,
Volatiles
Chlorome thane
Br omome thane
Vinyl chloride
Chloroe thane
Methylene chloride
Acetone
Carbon disulf ide
1 , 1- Dichloroe thene
1 , 1- Dichloroe thane
cis-1, 2 -Dichloroe thene
trans -1,2- Dichloroe thene
Chloroform
1 , 2 -Dichloroe thane
2-Butanone
Bromochlorome thane
1,1, 1 -Trichloroe thane
Carbon Tetrachloride
Bromodichlorome thane
1,2- Dichloropropane
c is - 1 , 3 - Dichloropropene
Trichloroe thene
Dib romochlo rorae thane
1,1, 2 -Trichloroe thane
Benzene
trans -1,3- Dichloropropene
Bromoform
4 - Me thy 1 - 2 - pentanone
2-Hexanone
Tetrachloroe thene
CAS Number
74-87-3
74-83-9
75-01-4
75-00-3
75-09-2
67-64-1
75-15-0
75-35-4
75-34-3
156-59-4
156-60-5
67-66-3
107-06-2
78-93-3
74-97-5
71-55-6
56-23-5
75-27-4
78-87-5
10061-01-5
79-01-6
124-48-1
79-00-5
71-43-2
10061-02-6
75-25-2
108-10-1
591-78-6
127-18-4
Water
1
1
1
1
2
5
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
5
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
5
5
1
                    C-2
10/92

-------
                        TARGET COMPOUND LIST (TCL) AND
                 CONTRACT REQUIRED QUANTITATION LIMITS (CRQL)
                                   (CONT'D.)
                                                       Quantitation Limits
                                                                Water
            Volatiles                   CAS Number              ug/L
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
1,1,2, 2-Tetrachloroethane
1 , 2 - Dibromoe thane
Toluene
Chlorobenzene
Ethylbenzene
Styrene
Xylenes (total)
1,3- Dichlorobenzene
1 , 4-Dichlorobenzene
1 , 2 -Dichlorobenzene
79-34-5
106-93-4
108-88-3
108-90-7
100-41-4
100-42-5
1330-20-7
541-73-1
106-46-7
95-50-1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
   40.  l,2-Dibromo-3-chloropropane
96-12-8
NOTE:   Except for Methylene chloride,  the  quantitation  limits in this  table
        are set at the concentrations  in  the  sample equivalent to the
        concentration of the lowest calibration  standard analyzed for each
        analyte.

        In the case of Methylene chloride,  the CRQL value in this table is
        based on the lowest level of detection in samples contaminated  with
        this common laboratory solvent  that can  be achieved by reasonable
        means in a production laboratory.
                                     C-3
                              10/92

-------
       TARGET GOMfOOND LIST (TCL) AND
CONTRACT REQUIRED QOANTITATIOM LIHITg(CROP
                  (CONT'D.)
                                      Quantitation Limits

I.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10,
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
Semivolatiles
Phenol
bis-(2-Chloroethyl)ether
2-Chlorophenol
2 -Me thy Iphenol
2,2' -oxybis(l-Chloropropane)
4-Methylphenol
N-Nitroso-di-n-propylamine
Hexachlor oe thane
Nitrobenzene
Isophorone
2-Nitrophenol
2 , 4 'Dine thy Iphenol
bis- (2-Chloroethoxy)me thane
2 ,4-Dichlorophenol
1,2 ,4-Trichlorobenzene
Naphthalene
4-Chloroaniline
Hexachlorobutadiene
4-Chloro- 3 -me thy Iphenol
2 -Me thylnaphthalene
Hexachlor ocyclopentadiene
2,4, 6-Trichlorophenol
2,4,5 -Trichlorophenol
2 -Chloronaphthalene
2-Nitroaniline
Dime thy Iph thala te
Acenaphthylene
2 , 6-Dinitrotoluene
3-Nitroaniline
Acenaphthene
2 , 4-Dinitrophenol
4-Nitrophenol
Dibenzofuran
CAS Number
108-95-2
111-44-4
95-57-8
95-48-7
108-60-1
106-44-5
621-64-7
67-72-1
98-95-3
78-59-1
88-75-5
105-67-9
11-91-1
120-83-2
120-82-1
91-20-3
106-47-8
87-68-3
59-50-7
91-57-6
77-47-4
88-06-2
95-95-4
91-58-7
88-74-4
131-11-3
208-96-8
606-20-2
99-09-2
83-32-9
51-28-5
100-02-7
132-64-9
Hater
ug/L
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
20
5
20
5
5
5
20
5
20
20
5
                    C-4
10/92

-------
       TARGET COMPOUND LIST (TCL) AND
CONTRACT REQUIRED QUANTITATION LIMITS (CRQL)
                  (CONT'D.)
                                      QuantICatIon Limits

34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
46.
47.
48.
49.
50.
51.
52.
53.
54.
55.
56.
57.
58.
59.
60.
Semivolatiles
2 , 4-Dinitro toluene
Diethylphthalate
4 - Chloropheny 1 - pheny le ther
Fluorene
4-Nitroanlllne
4 , 6 - D ini tro - 2 - me thy Ipheno 1
N - Ni t r o s odipheny lamine
4 - Broiaopheny 1 - pheny le ther
Hexachlorobenzene
Pentachloropheno 1
Phenanthrene
Anthracene
Dl - n-buty Iphthalate
Fluoranthene
Pyrene
Butylbenzy Iphthalate
3,3' -Dlchlorobenzidine
Benzo ( a ) anthrac ene
Chrysene
bis- (2-Sthylhexyl)phthalate
Di -n-octy Iphthalate
Benzo ( b ) f luor anthene
Benzo (k) f luor anthene
Benzo (a) pyr ene
Indeno < 1 , 2 , 3 - cd) pyr ene
Dibenz ( a , h ) anthracene
Benzo ( g, h, i)perylene
CAS Number
121-14-2
84-66-2
7005-72-3
86-73-7
100-01-6
534-52-1
86-30-6
101-55-3
118-74-1
87-86-5
85-01-8
120-12-7
84-74-2
206-44-0
129-00-0
85-68-7
91-94-1
56-55-3
218-01-9
117-81-7
117-84-0
205-99-2
207-08-9
50-32-8
193-39-5
53-70-3
191-24-2
Water
ug/L
5
5
5
5
20
20
5
5
5
20
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
                    C-5
10/92

-------
       TARGET COMPOUND LIST (TCL) AND
CONTRACT REQUIRED QUANTITATION LIMITS (CRQL)
                  (CONT'D.)
Quantitation Limits
Festlcides/FCBs
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
, 10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
alpha -BHC
beta-BHC
delta- BHC
gamma- BHC (Lindane)
Heptachlor
Aldrin
Heptachlor epoxide
Endosulfan I
Dieldrin
4,4'-DDE
Endrin
Endosulfan II
4, 4' -ODD
Endosulfan sulfate
4, 4' -DDT
Methoxychlor
Endrin ketone
Endrin aldehyde
alpha- Chi ordane
gamma - Chlordane
Toxaphene
Aroclor-1016
Aroclor-1221
Aroclor-1232
Aroc lor -1242
Aroclor-1248
Aroclor-1254
Aroclor-1260
CAS Number
319-84-6
319-85-7
319-36-8
58-89-9
76-44-8
309-00-2
1024-57-3
959-98-8
60-57-1
72-55-9
72-20-8
33213-65-9
72-54-8
1031r07-8
50-29-3
72-43-5
53494-70-5
7421-93-4
5103-71-9
5103-74-2
8001-35-2
12674-11-2
11104-28-2
11141-16-5
53469-21-9
12672-29-6
11097-69-1
11096-82-5
Water
ug/L
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.02
0.02
0.02
0.02
0.02
0.02
0.02
0.10
0.02
0.02
0.01
0.01
1.0
0.20
0.40
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
                    C-6
10/92

-------
                       EXHIBIT 0
METHOD FOR THE ANALYSIS 0? LOW CONCENTRATION WATER FOR
        VOLATILE (PURGEABLE) ORGANIC COMPOUNDS
                         VGA D-l                           10/92

-------
                               Table  of Contents
                                                                      Page
SECTION I:

SECTION II:



SECTION III:
SECTION TV:
SECTION V:
Introduction  	VOA D- 3
Part A - Sample Storage and Holding Tines 	VOA D-4
Fart B -  	VOA D-5

Instrument Quality Control Procedures
  and Requirements
Part A - Instrument Operating Conditions 	 VOA D-16
Part B - Tuning the Mass Spectrometer 	VOA D-18
Part C - Calibration of the GC/MS System	VOA D-20

Sample Analysis and Compound Identification
  and Quantitation	VOA D- 27

Sample Quality Control Procedures and
  Requirements	VOA D-38
                                    VOA D-2
                                                        10/92

-------
                                   SECTION I

                                 INTRODUCTION
The analytical method that follows is designed to analyze samples containing
low concentrations of the volatile compounds listed in  the Target Compound
List (TCL) in Exhibit C.  The majority of the samples are expected  to be  from
drinking water and well/ground water sources around Superfund sites.  The
method is based on EPA Method 524.2 and the volatile method contained in  the
CLP Statement of Work, "Organic Analysis, Hulti Media,  Multi Concentrations
by GC/MS and GC/EC Techniques."  Specific quality control requirements are
incorporated in the method in order to minimize contamination of the samples
from laboratory sources.

Problems have been associated with the following compounds analyzed by this
method.

o   Chloromethane,  vinyl chloride,  bromomethane,  and chloroethane may display
    peak broadening if the compounds  are  not delivered to the  GC column in a
    tight  band;

o   Acetone, hexanone,  2-butanone,  and A-methyl-2-pentanone have poor purge
    efficiencies.

o   1,1,1-Trichloroethane  and all  of  the  dichloroethanes may dehydrohalogenate
    during storage  or  analysis.
o   Tetrachloroethane  and  1,1-dichloroethane may  be  degraded by contaminated
    transfer lines  in  purge and  trap  systems and/or  active  sites in trapping
    materials.

o   Chloromethane may  be lost if the  purge flow is too fast.

o   Bromo form  is or*- of the compounds «"~«t likel>  _« be  ad>«>rsely affected by
    cold spots and/or  active  sites  in the transfer lines.  Response  of its
    quantitation ion (m/z  173) is  directly affected by the  tuning of BFB  at
    ions m/z 174/176.   Increasing  the m/z 174/176 ratio  within the  specified
    QC  limits may Improve  bromoform response.

o   Due  to the lower quantitation  limits  required by  this method,  extra
    caution shall be exercised when identifying compounds.
                                     VOA D-3                           10/92

-------
                                  SECTION II


PART A - SAMPLE STORAGE AND HOLDING TIMES

1.    PROCEDURES FOR SAflPLJ STORAGE

      The samples shall be protected from light and refrigerated at 4*0
      (±2*C) from the time of receipt until 60 days after delivery of a
      complete reconciled sample data package to the Region.  After 60 days,
      the samples may be disposed of in a manner that complies with all
      applicable regulations.

      The samples shall be stored in an atmosphere demonstrated to be free of
      all potential contaminants and in a refrigerator used only for storage
      of purgeable samples received under this contract.

      Samples, sample extracts,  and standards shall be stored separately.

      Volatiles standards shall  be stored separately from semivolatile and
      pesticide/Aroclor standards.

2.    CONTRACT REQUIRED HOLDING  TIMES

      Analysis of samples shall  be completed within 10 days of the validated
      time of sample receipt (VTSR).
                                     VGA D-4                          10/92

-------
 PAET  B

 3.    SUMMARY OF METHOD

 3.1   An inert gas  is bubbled  through a 25 mL sample contained in a  specially
      designed purging chamber at ambient temperature causing the purgeables
      to be transferred from the aqueous phase to the vapor phase.   The vapor
      is swept through a sorbent column where the purgeables are trapped.
      After purging is completed, the sorbent column is heated and
      backflushed with the inert gas to desorb the purgeables onto a gas
      chromatograph (GC) wide-bore capillary column.  The gas chromatograph
      is temperature programmed to separate the purgeables, which are then
      detected with a mass spectrometer (MS).

 3.2   Target and surrogate compounds are identified in the samples by
      analyzing standards under the same conditions used for samples and
      comparing resultant mass spectra and GC retention times.  Internal
      standards are added to all samples and standards.  A response  factor is
      established for each target and surrogate compound during the  initial
      and continuing calibrations by comparing the MS response from  the
      extracted ion current profile (EICP) for the primary ion produced by
      the target and surrogate compound to the MS response for the primary
      ion produced by an internal standard compound.  Each identified target
      and surrogate compound in a sample is quantified by comparing the
      responses for the target compound and the internal standard,  while
      taking into account the response factor from the most recent
      calibration,  the sample volume, and any sample dilutions.

3.3   Non-target compounds are identified by comparing the resultant mass
      spectra from the non-target compounds to mass spectra contained in the
      National Institute of Standards and Technology Mass Spectral Library.
      Non-target compounds are quantified by comparing the MS response from
      the reconstructed ion chromatogram (RIC) for the non-target compound
      peaks to the MS response for a peak produced by the nearest internal
      standard compound.   A response factor of 1 is assumed.

4.    iMfiMStlHCHS

4.1   Impurities in the purge gas or methanol,  organic compounds out-gassing
      from the plumbing ahead of the trap,  and solvent vapors in the
      laboratory account for the majority of contamination problems.   Gas
      lines from the gas tanks to the instrument shall be either stainless
      steel or copper tubing.   Non-polytetrafluoroethylene (PTFE) thread
      sealants,  or flow controllers with rubber components are not to be
      used.  When potential interfering peaks are noted in laboratory method
      blanks,  it may be necessary to reduce solvent contamination in the
      laboratory,  purge the methanol used to prepare standard solutions,
      purge the reagent water with helium or nitrogen,  change the purge gas
      source,  or regenerate the molecular sieve purge gas filter.

4.2   Samples can be contaminated by diffusion of purgeable organics
      (particularly methylene chloride,  fluorocarbons,  and other common
      laboratory solvents)  through the septum seal Into the sample during
      storage and handling.   Therefore,  these samples shall be stored

                                     VGA D-5                           10/92

-------
      separately from other laboratory samples and standards and shall be
      analyzed in a room whose atmosphere is demonstrated to be free of all
      potential contaminants which will interfere with the analysis.  Since
      •ethylene chloride will permeate through PTFE tubing, all gas
      chromatography carrier gas lines and purge gas plumbing lines are to be
      constructed from stainless steel or copper tubing,
      Kon-polytetrafluoroethylene (PTFE) thread sealants, or flow controllers
      with rubber components are not to be used. Laboratory clothing worn by
      the analyst shall be clean of solvents since clothing previously
      exposed to methylene chloride and other laboratory solvent fumes during
      common liquid/liquid extraction procedures can contribute to sample
      contamination.

4.3   Contamination by carryover can occur whenever a sample is analyzed
      after a high level sample which contain high levels of organic
      compounds.  To reduce carryover, the sample purger and sampling syringe
      shall be rinsed with reagent water between sample analyses.  Whenever
      an unusually concentrated sample is encountered, it shall either be
      followed by analysis of an instrument blank or the next sample shall be
      closely monitored to check for cross contamination.  For samples
      containing large amounts of water soluble materials,  suspended solids,
      high boiling compounds,  or high purgeable levels,  it is necessary to
      wash out the sample purger with a detergent solution between analyses,
      rinse it with distilled water,  and then dry it in a 1Q5*C oven.  The
      trap and other parts of the system are also subject to contamination;
      therefore, frequent bakeout and purging of the entire system may be
      required.

5.     APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      Brand names,  suppliers and part numbers are for illustrative purposes
      only.  No endorsement is implied.   Equivalent performance may be
      achieved using apparatus and materials other than those specified here,
      but demonstration of equivalent performance meeting the requirements of
      the method is the responsibility of the Contractor.

S.I   Purge and Trap Device -  The purge and trap device consists of three
      separate pieces of equipment;  the sample purger, the  trap, and the trap
      heater.   Purge gas plumbing lines are to be constructed from stainless
      steel or copper tubing.   Non-polytetrafluoroethylene  (PTFE) thread
      sealants, or  flow controllers with rubber components  are not to be
      used.

      5.1.1   Sample Purger - The sample purger shall be designed to accept
              25 mL samples with a water column at least 10 cm deep.  The
              gaseous head space between the water column and the trap shall
              have a total volume of less than 15 mL.  The purge gas shall
              pass through the water column as finely divided bubbles, each
              with a diameter of less than 3 am at the origin.  The purge gas
              shall be introduced no more than 5 mm from the base of the
              water column.  Alternate sample purge devices may be utilized
              provided equivalent performance is demonstrated.  A set of
              sample purgers sufficient to meet contract requirements shall
              be reserved for exclusive use in this contract.

                                     VGA D-6                          10/92

-------
      5.1.2    Trap Packing

               5.1.2.1    2,6-Dtphenylene  oxide polymer,  60/80 mesh,
                          chromatographic  grade (Tenax GC or equivalent).

               5.1.2.2    Methyl  silicone  packing,  3 percent OV-1 on
                          Chromosorb tf,  60/80 aesh  (or equivalent).

               5.1.2.3.    Silica  gel (35/60 aesh, Davison, grade 15 or
                          equivalent).

      5.1.3    Trap -  The  trap  shall be  at least  25 en long and have -an inside
               diaaeter of at least 0.105  inch  (0.2667 cm).  Starting  from the
               inlet,  pack the  column  in the following order: 0.5 cm silanized
               glass wool,  1 cm aethyl silicone coated packing, IS cm
               2,6-diphenylene  oxide polymer, 8 cm  silica gel, and 0.5  cm
               silanized glass  wool.

      5.1.4    Trap Heater

               5.1.4.1   The trap heater shall be capable of rapidly heating
                         the trap to  180*C.   The polymer section of the trap
                         should not be heated to greater than 180*C and the
                         temperature of the remaining sections should not
                         exceed 220*C during bakeout mode.

               5.1.4.2    The purge and trap device may be assembled as a
                         separate unit or be coupled to a gas chromatograph.

5.2   Gas Chromatograph/Mass  Spectrometer

      5.2.1   Gas Chromatograph  - The gas chromatograph  (GC) system shall be
              capable of temperature programming and have a flow controller
               that maintains a constant column flow rate throughout
              desorption and temperature program operations.  The system
              shall include or be interfaced to a purge and trap system as
              specified in Section 5.1 and have all required accessories
              including syringes, analytical columns,  and gases.   All GC
              carrier gas lines shall be constructed from stainless steel or
              copper  tubing.  Non-polytetrafluoroethylene (PTFE)  thread
              sealants, or flow controllers with rubber components are not to
              be used. The column oven shall be cooled to 10*C;  therefore, a
              subambient oven controller is required.

              5.2.1.1  Gas Chromatography Columns

                         Column 1-30 a long  x  0.53  aa  ID VOCOL (Supelco,
                         Inc.)  or equivalent fused  silica wide-bore  capillary
                         column with 3 ua  film thickness.

                         Column 2-30 a long  x  0.53  ma  ID DB-624  fused  silica
                        wide-bore (J&W Scientific, Inc.) or equivalent
                         column with 3 um  fila thickness.
                                    VGA D-7                           10/92

-------
      5.2.2    Mass  Spectrometer -  The mass spectrometer shall  be capable of
               scanning from 35  to  300 amu every 2 seconds or less,  utilizing
               70 volts (nominal) electron energy in the electron impact
               ionization mode and  producing a mass spectrum which meets all
               the tuning acceptance criteria when 50 ng of
               p-bromofluorobenzene (BFB)  are injected through  the gas
               chromatograph inlet.  To ensure sufficient precision of mass
               spectral data, the MS scan  rate shall allow acquisition of at
               least five spectra while a  sample compound elutes  from the GC.
               The purge and trap GC/MS system shall be in a room whose
               atmosphere is demonstrated  to be free of all potential
               contaminants  which will interfere with the analysis.   The
               instrument shall  be  vented  to outside the facility or to a
               trapping system which prevents the release of contaminants into
               the instrument room.

      5.2.3    GC/MS Interface - Any gas chromatograph to mass  spectrometer
               interface may be  used that  gives acceptable calibration points
               at 25 ng or less  per injection for each of the purgeable target
              .and surrogate compounds and achieves all acceptable performance
               criteria.   Gas chromatograph to mass spectrometer  interfaces
               constructed of all-glass or glass-lined materials  are
               recommended.  Glass can be deactivated by silanizing with
               dichlorodimethylsilane.

      5.2.4    Data  System - A computer system shall  be  interfaced to the mass
               spectrometer  that allows the  continuous  acquisition and storage
               on machine readable  media of  all mass  spectra  obtained
               throughout the duration of  the  chromatographic program.   The
               computer shall have  software  that  allows  searching any GC/MS
               data  file for ions of a specified  mass and plotting such ion
               abundances versus time or scan number.  This type  of  plot is
               defined  as an Extracted Ion Current  Profile  (EICP).   Software
               shall also be available that  allows  integrating  the abundance
               in any EICP between  specified time or  scan number  limits.
              Also,  for the non-target compounds,  software shall be available
               that  allows comparing sample  spectra against reference library
               spectra.   The most recent release  of the  National  Institute of
               Standards  and Technology Mass Spectral Library shall  be used as
               the reference library.

5.3   Magnetic Tape  Storage  Device  - The magnetic tape storage  device shall
      be capable of recording data  and shall be suitable for long-term, off-
      line storage.

5.4   pH paper - wide range.

5.5   Glassware - A set of glassware sufficient to meet the contract
      requirements shall be reserved for exclusive use in this  contract.

      5.5.1    Bottles  -  15  mL,  screw-cap, with Teflon  cap liner.

      5.5.2    Volumetric flasks -  class A with ground-glass  stoppers.
                                     VGA D-8                           10/92

-------
 5.6   Micro syringes - 10 uL and larger,  0.006 inch ID needle.

 5.7   Syringe valve -  two-way,  with Luer  ends  (three each),  if  applicable to
       the  purging device.

 5.8   Syringe -  25 mL,  gas  tight with  shut-off valve.

 5.9   Analytical  Balance  -  capable  of  accurately weighing ±0.0001 g.  The
       balance shall be  calibrated with class S weights  once per each  12-hour
       workshift.   The balance shall  also be annually checked by a certified
       technician.

 5.10   Gases  - Heliua, Nitrogen.   Ultra-pure grade.

 5.11   Gas  line tubing - polytetrafluoroethylene, stainless steel, or  copper
       tubing.

 6.    REAGENTS

 6.1   Reagent water - Reagent water is defined as water in which no purgeable
      target compound is observed at or above the CRQL listed in Exhibit C
      for that compound and in which no non-target compound is observed at or
      above 2.0 ug/L.

      6.1.1   Reagent water may  be  generated by passing tap water through a
              carbon filter bed  containing about 453 g  (1 Ib.) of activated
              carbon (Calgon Corp.,  Filtrasorb-300,  or  equivalent).

      6.1.2   Reagent water may  be  generated using  a water purification
              system (Millipore  Super-Q, or equivalent).

      6.1.3   Reagent water may  be prepared by boiling'water for 15 minutes.
              Subsequently, while maintaining  the temperature at 90*C, bubble
              a contaminant-free inert gas through  the water for one  hour.
              While still hot, transfer the water to a narrow-mouth screw-cap
              bottle, seal with  a Teflon-lined septum, and cap.

6.2   Hethanol -  HPLC quality or equivalent--Each lot of methanol used for
      analysis under this contract shall be purged with nitrogen and shall be
      demonstrated to be free of contaminants  that interfere  with the
      measurement of purgeable compounds  listed in the Exhibit C.

7.    STANDARDS

7.1   The Contractor shall provide all  standards to be used with this
      contract.  These standards may be used only after they  have been
      certified.   The Contractor shall  be  able  to verify that the standards
      are certified.  Manufacturer's certificates of analysis shall  be
      retained by the Contractor and presented  upon request.

7.2   Stock Standard Solutions

      Stock standard solutions may be purchased or may be prepared in
      methanol from pure standard materials.

                                     VOA D-9                           10/92

-------
       7.2.1   Prepare stock standard solutions by placing about 9.8 mL of
               methanol into a 10.0 mL ground-glass stoppered volumetric
               flask.  Allow the flask to stand, unstoppered, for about 10
               minutes or until all alcohol wetted surfaces have dried.  Weigh
               the flask to the nearest 0.1 mg.

       7.2.2   Add the assayed reference material as described below.

               7.2.2.1    If the  compound is a liquid,  using a 100 uL syringe,
                          immediately add two or more drops  of assayed
                          reference material to  the  flask, then reweigh.   The
                          liquid  shall fall  directly into  the  alcohol without
                          contacting the  neck of the flask.

               7.2.2.2    If the  compound is a gas at room temperature,  fill a
                          5  mL valved gas-tight  syringe with the reference
                          standard  to the 5.0  mL mark.  Lower  the needle to  5
                          mm above  the methanol  meniscus.  Slowly introduce
                          the reference standard above  the surface of the
                          liquid.   The gas will  rapidly dissolve in  the
                         methanol.   This may  also be accomplished by using  a
                          lecture bottle  equipped with  a Hamilton Lecture
                         Bottle Septum (#86600).  Attach Teflon tubing to the
                         side-arm  relief valve  and direct a gentle  stream of
                         the reference standard into the methanol meniscus.

      7.2.3   Reweigh, dilute to volume, stopper, then mix by inverting the
              flask  several times.   For  non-gaseous compounds, calculate the
              concentration in micrograms per microliter  from the net gain  in
              weight.  When compound purity is  assayed to be  97 percent or
              greater, the  weight  may be used without  correction to calculate
              the concentration of the stock  standard.  If the compound
              purity is assayed to be less  than 97 percent, the weight shall
              be corrected  when calculating the concentration of the stock
              solution.   For gaseous compounds, calculate the concentration
              in micrograms per microliter, using the  Ideal Gas Law, taking
              into account  the temperature  and pressure conditions  within the
              laboratory.

      7.2.4   Prepare fresh stock  standards every two  months  for gases or for
              reactive compounds such as styrene.  All other  stock  standards
              for non-gases/non-reactive purgeable compounds  shall  be
              replaced after six months, or sooner, if standards have
              degraded or evaporated.

7.3   Secondary Dilution Standards

      7.3.1   Using  stock standard solutions, prepare  secondary dilution
              standards in  methanol  that contain the compounds of interest,
              either singly or mixed together.  Secondary dilution  standard
              solutions should be  prepared at concentrations that can be
              easily diluted to prepare working standard solutions.
                                     VOA D-10                         10/92

-------
      7.3.2    Prepare  fresh  secondary dilution standards for gases and  for
               reactlv* compounds, such as styrene, every month or sooner. If
               standard has degraded or evaporated.  Secondary dilution
               standards for  the other purgeable compounds shall be replaced
               after sIx months. or sooner, if standard has degraded or
               evaporated.
7,4   Working Standards

      7.4.1   Tuning Solution - p-Bromofluorobenzene (BFB)
              Prepare a 25 ng/uL solution of BFB in methanol.  Prepare fresh
              BFB solution every six monthf. or sooner, if the solution has
              degraded or evaporated.  Note:  The 25 ng/uL concentration is
              used with a 2 uL injection volume.  The laboratory may prepare
              a 50 ng/uL solution of BFB if a 1 uL injection volume is used.

      7.4.2    Calibration Standard Solution

              .Prepare the working calibration standard solution containing
              all of the purgeable target compounds in methanol.   The
              concentration of the non-ketone target compounds and the
              surrogate shall be 5.0 ug/mL in the standard (i.e.,  final
              concentration).  The concentration of the ketones (acetone,
              butanone,  2-hexanone,  4-methyl-2-pentanone)  shall be 25.0 ug/mL
              in the standard (i.e., final concentration).  Prepare fresh
              working calibration standard solutions weejfly.  or sooner, if
              solutions have degraded or evaporated.

      7.4.3    Internal Standard Spiking Solution

              Prepare an internal standard spiking solution containing 1,4-
              dichiorobenzene-dA,  chlotobenzene-dS,  and 1,4-difluorobenzene
              in methanol at the concentration of 12.5 ug/mL for each
              internal standard.   Add 10 uL of this spiking solution into
              25.0 mL of sample or calibration standard for a concentration
              of 5.0 ug/L.   Prepare fresh spiking solution everythree
              months. or sooner,  if the solution has degraded or evaporated.

      7.4.4    Surrogate Compound Spiking Solution

              Prepare 12.5 ng/uL solution of p-bromofluorobenzene  in
              methanol.   For samples and blanks,  add 10 uL of the  surrogate
              compound solution to 25 mL of sample or reagent water for a
              final concentration of 5 ug/L.   The surrogate compound is added
              to the working calibration standards so it is not to be added
              again when aqueous calibration standards are prepared.   Prepare
              fresh surrogate compound solution every six  months,  or sooner,
              If the solution has degraded or evaporated.
                                    VOA D-ll                          10/92

-------
       7.4.5    Laboratory Control Sample (LCS) Spiking Solution

               Prepare the laboratory control sample spiking solution
               containing all of the analytes listed below at 12.5 ng/uL in
               •ethanol.   The laboratory control sample is prepared by adding
               10 uL of this solution into  25.0 oL of reagent water for a
               concentration of 5.0  ug/L.   Prepare fresh LCS spiking solution
               every six months.  or  sooner,  if the solution has degraded or
               evaporated.   The LCS  shall contain the following compounds;
               1,2-Dib romoethane
               Benzene
               1,2-Dichloroethane
               1,2-Dichloropropane
               Tetraehoroethene
               Carbon tetrachloride
1,4-Dichlorobenzene
cis-1,3-Dichloropropene
1,1,2-Trichloroethane
Vinyl chloride
Broaofom
Trichloroethene
7.5   Aqueous Calibration Standard Solutions

      7.5.1   JPrepare five aqueous initial calibration standard solutions
              containing all of the purgeable target compounds and the
              surrogate compound at the 1.0, 2.0, 5.0, 10, and 25 ug/L
              levels, except the -ketones which are at the 5.0, 10, 25, 50,
              and 125 ug/L levels.  It is required that all three xylene
              isomers (o-,p- and m-xylene) be present in the calibration
              standards at concentrations of each isomer equal to that of the
              other target compounds (i.e., 1.0, 2.0, 5.0, 10.0 and 25 ug/L).
              The preparation procedure for the aqueous calibration standard
              solutions is listed in Table D-l.   The internal standards are
              added to each calibration standard according to the procedures
              in Section 14.3.5.

                               TABLE D-l

VOL OF
WORKING
STANDARD
(uL added
to 25 mL)
5
10
25
50
125
FINAL
eo»c. OF
AQUEOUS
STANDARD FOR
NON-KETONES
(ug/L)
1
2
5
10
25
FINAL
CONG. OF
AQUEOUS
STANDARD FOR
KETONES
(ug/L>
5
10
25
50
125
                                    VGA D-12
                                10/92

-------
      7.5,2    Aqueous calibration standards  may be  prepared  in a volumetric
               flask or in the syringe used to inject the  standard  into  the
               purging device.

               7.S.2.1    Volumeeric  flask  -  Add an  appropriate volume of
                          working  calibration standard solution to  an aliquot
                          of reagent  water  in a  volumetric flask.   Use a
                          aicrosyringe  and  rapidly inject  the alcohol standard
                          into the expanded area of  the filled volumetric
                          flask.   Remove the  needle  as quickly  as possible
                          after injection.  Bring to volume.  Mix by inverting
                          the flask three tines  only.  Discard  the  contents
                          contained in  the head  of the flask.

               7.5.2.2    Syringe  - Remove  the plunger from a 25 mL syringe
                          and close the syringe valve.  Pour reagent water
                          into the syringe barrel to  just short of
                          overflowing.  Replace  the  syringe plunger and
                          compress the water.  Invert  the syringe,  open the
                          syringe  valve and vent any  residual air.   Adjust the
                         water volume  to 25.0 mL minus the amount of
                         calibration standard to be  added.  Withdraw the
                         plunger  slightly and add an  appropriate volume of
                         working  calibration standard through the valve bore
                         of the syringe.  Close the valve and invert three
                         times.

      7.5.3   The 5 ug/L  (25 ug/L for  ketones)  aqueous calibration standard
              solution is the continuing calibration standard.

      7.5.4   A smaller sample or standard volume (5  to 25 mL) may be purged
              but the CRQL and all QC  criteria  shall be met.  The  same purge
              volume  shall be used for all samples,  standards, and blanks in
              a single SDG.

      7.5.5   The methanol contained in each of the  aqueous calibration
              standards shall not exceed It by volume.

7.6   Storage of Standards

      7.6.1   Store the stock standards in Teflon sealed screw-cap bottles
              with zero headspace at -10*C to -20*0.  Protect the standards
              from light.  Once one of the bottles  containing the stock
              standard solution has been opened, it may be used for no longer
              than one week.

      7.6.2   Store secondary dilution standards in Teflon sealed  screw-cap
              bottles with minimal headspace at  -10'C to  -20*C.  Protect the
              standards from light.  The secondary  dilution standards shall
              be checked  frequently for signs of degradation or evaporation,
              especially  just prior to preparing the  working calibration
              standards from them.
                                     VGA D-13                           10/92

-------
7.6.3   Aqueous standards may be  stored up  to  24 hours  if held in
        Teflon sealed  screw-cap vials with  zero headspace at  4*C
        (±2*C).  Protect the standards fron light.  If not so  stored,
        they shall be  discarded after one hour unless they  are set up
        to be purged by an autosaopler.  When  using an  autosantpler,  the
        standards aay  be kept up  to 12 hours In purge tubas connected
        via the autosampler to the purge and trap device.

7.6,4   Purgeable standards shall be stored separately  from other
        standards.
                               VGA D-14                         10/92

-------
                     SECTIOH III
INSTRUMENT QUALITY CONTROL PROCEDURES AND REQUIREMENTS
                         TOA D-15                          10/92

-------
FART A - INSTRUMENT OPERATING CONDITIONS

Purge and Trap

      The following are the recommended purge and trap analytical conditions
      except as stated below:
     Purge Conditions:
     Purge Gas:
     Purge Tine:
     Purge Flow Rate:
     Purge Temperature:

     Pesorb Conditions:

     Desorb Temperature:
     Desorb Flow Rate:
     Desorb Time:

     Trap Reconditioning  Conditions:

     .Reconditioning Temperature:
     Reconditioning Time:
                                            Helium or  Nitrogen
                                            11.0 ±0.1  «in
                                            25-40  mL/ain
                                            Ambient
                                            180 *C
                                            15 mL/ain
                                            4.0 ±0.1 min
                                            180*C
                                            7.0 min ±0.1 min  (minimum).  A
                                            longer time may be required  to
                                            bake contamination or water  froa
                                            the system.

Before initial use, condition the trap overnight at 180*C by backflushing
with at least 20 mL/min flow of inert gas.  Vent the trap effluent to the
hood and not to the analytical column.  Prior to daily use, condition the
trap by heating at 180*C for 10 minutes while backflushing.  The trap may be
vented to the analytical column during daily conditioning; however, the
column shall be run through the temperature program prior to analysis of
samples.

Optimize purge and trap conditions for sensitivity and to minimize cross
contamination between samples.  Once optimized, the same purge and trap
conditions shall be used for the analysis of all standard, samples, blanks,
Performance Evaluation Samples and Laboratory Control Samples

GasChromatograph

     The following are the recommended gas chromatographic analytical
     conditions:
    Carrier Gas:
    Flow Rate:
    Initial Temperature:
    Initial Hold Time:

    Ramp Rate:
    Final Temperature:
    Final Hold Time:
                                           Helium
                                           15 mL/min
                                           10'C
                                           1.0 - 5.0 min (±0.1 min
                                           precision)
                                           6*C/min
                                           160*C
                                           Until all target compounds elute
                                    VOA D-16
                                                                       10/92

-------
Optimize GC conditions for compound separation and sensitivity.  Once
optimized, the same GC conditions shall be used for the analysis of all
standards, samples, blanks, performance evaluation samples, and laboratory
control samples.

Mass Spectrometer

     The following are the required mass spectrometer conditions:

     Electron Energy:                      70 Volts (nominal)
     lonization Mode:                      El
     Mass Range:                           35-300 amu
     Scan Time:                            To give at least 5 scans per
                                           peak, not to exceed 2 seconds
                                           per scan.
                                    VGA D-17                          10/92

-------
PART B - TUNING THE MASS SPECTROMETER

8.    SUMMARY

      It is necessary to establish that a given GC/MS meets the standard mass
      spectral abundance criteria prior to initiating any on-going data
      collection.  This is accomplished through the analysis of
      p-bromofluorobenzene (BFB).

9.    FREQUENCY

      Each GC/MS used for volatile analysis shall be hardware tuned once per
      twelve (12) hour time period of operation.  Also, whenever the
      Contractor takes corrective action which could change or affect the
      tuning for BFB (e.g., ion source cleaning or repair, column
      replacement, etc.),  the tune shall be verified before continuing
      analysis irrespective of the twelve-hour daily tuning requirement.  The
      twelve (12) hour time period for GC/MS system tuning and standards
      calibration (initial or continuing calibration criteria) begins at the
      moment of injection of the BFB analysis that the Contractor submits as
      documentation of a compliant tune.  The time period ends after twelve
      (12) hours have elapsed.  In order to meet the tuning requirements, a
      sample,  LCS, PES,  standard,  or blank shall be injected within twelve
      hours of the BFB injection.

10.    PROCEDURE

10.1  Inject 50 ng BFB into the GC/MS system.  Alternatively,  add 50 ng of
      BFB solution to 25.0 mL of reagent water and analyze according to
      Section 17.  All instrument conditions shall be identical to those
      listed in Section III,  Part A,  except that a different temperature
      program may be used.

10.2  For the tune, BFB may not be analyzed simultaneously with any
      calibration standards or blanks.

11.    TECHNICAL ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA FOR BFB ANALYSIS

11.1  The GC/MS system shall be tuned at the frequency described in Section
      9.

11.2  The abundance criteria listed in Table D-2 shall be met for a 50 ng
      injection of BFB.   The mass spectrum of BFB shall be acquired in the
      following manner.   Three scans (the peak apex scan and the scans
      immediately preceding and following the apex) are acquired and
      averaged.  Background subtraction is required, and shall be
      accomplished using a single scan prior to the elution of BFB.  Note:
      All subsequent standards and samples, including LCS, PES and blanks
      associated with BFB analyses shall use identical mass spectrometer
      instrument conditions.

11.3  The criteria listed in Table D-2 are based on adherence to the
      acquisition specifications identified in Section 11.2 and were
      developed for the specific target compound list associated with this

                                     VOA D-18                          10/92

-------
      method.  The criteria are based on performance characteristics of
      instruments currently utilized in routine support of Program
      activities.  These specifications, in conjunction with relative
      response factor criteria for 28 target compounds (see Table D-3), are
      designed to control and monitor instrument performance associated with
      the requirements of this method.  As they are performance based
      criteria for these specific analytical requirements, they may not be
      optimal for additional target compounds.
TABLE D-2
Mass
50
75
95
96
173
174
175
176
177
BFB KEY IONS AND ABUNDANCE CRITERIA
Ion Abundance Criteria
8.0 - 40.0 percent of mass 95
30.0 - 66.0 percent of mass 95
base peak, 100 percent relative abundance
5.0 - 9.0 percent of mass 95 (see note)
less than 2.0 percent of mass 174
50.0 - 120.0 percent of mass 95
4.0 - 9.0 percent of mass 174
93.0 - 101.0 percent of mass 174
5.0 - 9.0 percent of mass 176
      Note:   All ion abundances shall be normalized to m/z 95,  the nominal
      base peak, even though the ion abundance of m/z 174 may be up to 120
      percent that of m/z 95.

12.    CORRECTIVE ACTION

12.1  If the BFB technical acceptance criteria are not met,  retune the GC/MS
      system.  It may also be necessary to clean the ion source, clean the
      quadrupole rods,  or take other corrective actions to achieve the
      technical acceptance criteria.

12.2  BFB technical acceptance criteria ?HALJ« be met before any standards,
      samples or required blanks are analyzed.  Any samples (including LCS
      and FES), or required blanks analyzed when tuning technical acceptance
      criteria have not been met will require reanalysis at no additional
      cost.

13.    [This paragraph has been intentionally left blank and has been reserved
      for the use of SHO.j
                                     VOA D-19                          10/92

-------
PART C - CALIBIATI08 OF THE GC/MS SYSTEM

            L CALIBRATION
14.1  Summary - Prior to the analysis of samples and required blanks and
      after BFB technical acceptance criteria have been met, each GC/MS
      system shall be calibrated at a minimum of five concentrations to
      determine instrument sensitivity and the linearity of GC/MS response
      for the purgeable target and surrogate compounds.

14 . 2  Frequency

      14.2,1  Each GC/MS system shall be calibrated upon award  of the
              contract, whenever the Contractor takes corrective action which
              may change or affect the initial calibration criteria  (i.e.,
              ion source cleaning or repair, column replacement, etc.), or  if
              the continuing calibration acceptance criteria have not been
              met.

      14.2.2  If time remains in the 12 hour time period after  meeting the
              'technical acceptance criteria for the initial calibration,
              samples may be analyzed.  It is not necessary to  analyze a
              continuing calibration standard, if the initial calibration
              standard that is the same concentration as the continuing
              calibration standard meets the continuing calibration  technical
              acceptance criteria.  A method blank is required.  Quantify all
              sample and quality control sample results and quality  control
              criteria results, such as internal standard area  response
              change and retention time shift, against the initial
              calibration standard that is the same concentration as the
              continuing calibration standard.

14 . 2   Procedure

      14.3.1  Set-up the purge and trap GC/MS system per the requirements of
              Section III, Part A.

      14 . 3 . 2  All samples , required blanks , and standard/spiking solutions
              shall be allowed to warm to ambient temperature (approximately
              1 hour) before analysis.

      14,3.3  Tune the GC/MS system to meet the BFB technical acceptance
              criteria in Section 11.

      14.3.4  Prepare a spiking solution containing the internal standards
              using the procedure described in Section 7.4.3.

      14.3.5  Prepare five aqueous calibration standards containing all the
              purgeable target compounds and the surrogate using the
              procedure described in Section 7.5.   Add 10 uL of the internal
              standard solution to each aqueous standard.   Analyze each
              calibration standard,  according to Section 17.   If a compound
              saturates at the highest standard concentration (Section
              7.5.1), and the GC/MS system is calibrated to achieve  a

                                     VGA D-20                          10/92

-------
               detection sensitivity of no  less  than  1,0 ug/L,  the Contractor
               shall  document  it  in the SOG Narrative and attach a
               quantitation  report  and RIG.   In  this  instance,  the Contractor
               shall  calculate the  results  based on a four-point initial
               calibration for the  specific compound  that saturates.
               Secondary ion quantitation is  only allowed when  there are
               sample  interferences with the  primary  quantitation ion.  If
               secondary ion quantitation is  used, calculate a  relative
               response  factor using the area response  from the most Intense
               secondary ion which  is  free  of sample  interferences and
               document  the  reasons for the use  of the  secondary ion in the
               SDG Narrative,

14.4  Calculations

      NOTE:   Unless otherwise  stated,  the  area response is  that of the
      primary quantitation ion.

      Calculating the relative response factor of the xylenes  requires
      special attention.  On capillary columns,  the m-  and  p-xylene  isomers
      coelute.   Therefore, when calculating the  relative  response  factor  in
      the equation below, use  the area response  (Ax)  and  concentration (Cx)
      of the peak from o-xylene.

      14.4.1  Calculate relative response factors (RRF) for each purgeable
              target compound and  the  surrogate using Equation 0.1.   See
              Table D-4 to associate purgeable target compounds with the
              proper internal  standard.  See Table D-5 for primary
              quantitation ions to be used for each purgeable target,
              surrogate, and internal standard compounds.

              EQ. D.I           A,      Cls
                        8&F  -  _  x  _
              Where :

              AX  - Area response (EICP) for the compound to be measured.

              A£S - Area response (EICP) for the internal standard.

              cis ~ Concentration of the internal standard.

              Cx  — Concentration of the compound to be measured.

      14.4.2   Equation 0.2 is the general formula for standard deviation (SD)
              for a statistically small set of values.
                                 n-1
                                    VGA  D-21                          10/92

-------
         SD  -  Standard deviation for  a set of values,
         xi  -  Value.

         x  —  Mean value.
         n  -  Number  of values.

14.4.3   Calculate the percent relative standard deviation (%  RSD)  of
         RRF values for each purgeable target and  surrogate compound
         over  the  initial  calibration range using  Equation D.3 in
         conjunction  with  Equation D.2.


         SQ- B.3   %RSD -  SPmr   x   100
                             x

         Where:

         %RSD  - Percent relative standard  deviation.

         SDny  - Standard deviation of initial calibration response
               factors (per compound).

         From  EQ.  0.2:

                  -  Relative response  factors from initial  calibration
                   standard (per  compound).
        x - RRF - Mean of initial calibration response
                  factors (per compound) .

14.4.4  Equation D.4  is the general formula for the mean of a set of
        values .

        EQ. D.4
                      n
                x -
                       n

        X£ - Value.

        x  - Mean value.*
        n  * Number of values.

14.4.5  Calculate the mean of the relative retention times  (RRT)  for
        each purgeable target and surrogate compound over the  initial
        calibration range using Equation D.4 and Equation 0.5.

                  EQ. 0.5                  RTC
                                   RRT -  	
                                           RTls

        RTC - Retention time  for the purgeable target and surrogate
        compound.

                               VGA 0-22                          10/92

-------
              RT£S- Retention time for the internal standard.


              From EQ D.4:

              X£ - RRTj. - Relative retention times for the purgeable  target
                         or surrogate compound for each initial calibration
                         standard.
              x - RRT «- Mean relative retention time (per compound).

              n - Number of values.

      14.4.6  Calculate the area response (Y) mean for each internal standard
              over the initial calibration range using Equation D.4.

              Where:

              xi ~  Yj. - Area responses for the internal standard in each
                       of the calibration standards.


              x - Y - Area response mean.

              n — Number of values.

      14.4.7  Calculate the mean of the absolute retention times (RT) for
              each internal standard over the initial calibration range using
              Equation D.4.

              Where:

              x^ - RTj_ - Retention times for the internal standard  in each
                         of the calibration standards.
              x - RT - Mean absolute retention time.

              n - Number of values.

14.5  Technical Acceptance Criteria For Initial Calibration

      14.S.I  All initial calibration standards shall be analyzed at  the
              concentration levels described in Section 14.3, and at  the
              frequency described in Section 14.2 on a GC/MS system meeting
              the BFB technical acceptance criteria.

      14.5.2  The relative response factor (RRF) at each calibration
              concentration for each purgeable target and surrogate compound
              that has a required minimum response factor value shall be
              greater than or equal to the compound's minimum acceptable
              response factor listed in Table D-3.
                                     VOA D-23                          10/92

-------
      14,5.3   The  %RSD  for each target or surrogate  compound listed in Table
               D-3  shall be less than or equal  to that value  listed.

      14.5.4   Up to  two compounds may fail the criteria listed in paragraphs
               14.5.2 and 14.5.3 and still meet the minimum response factor
               and  %RSD  requirements.   However,  these compounds shall have a
               minimum RRF greater than or equal to 0.010,  and the %RSD shall
               be less than or  equal to 40.0%.

      14.5.5   The  relative retention time (RRT)  at each calibration level
               shall  be  within  ±0,06 RRT units  of mean relative retention time
               (RRT)  over all the calibration levels  for each purgeable target
               compound  and the surrogate.

      14.5.6   The  area  response (Y)  for each internal standard compound in
               each calibration standard shall  be within the_  inclusive range
               of ±40.0  percent of the mean area response (Y)  of the  internal
               standard  in all  of the  calibration standards.

      14.5.7   The  retention time (RT)  shift for  each internal  standard at
               each calibration level  shall  be  less than or equal  to  ±0.33
               minutes (20.0 seconds)  from the mean retention time  (ITT)  over
               all  calibration  levels  for each  internal  standard.

14.6  Corrective Action

      14.6.1   If the  initial calibration technical acceptance  criteria are
               not  met,  inspect the  system for problems.  It  may be necessary
               to clean  the  ion source,  change  the column, service  the purge
               and  trap  device  or take  other corrective  actions  to  achieve the
               technical  acceptance  criteria.
      14,6.2  Initial calibration technical acceptance criteria ffBAJA be met
              before any samples or required blanks are analyzed.  Any
              samples (including LCS and PSS) or required blanks analyzed
              when initial calibration technical acceptance criteria have not
              been met will require reanalysis at no additional cost.

15.   CONTINUING CALIBRATION

15.1  Summary -  Prior to the analysis of samples and required blanks and
      after BFB  and initial calibration acceptance criteria have been met,
      each GC/MS system shall be routinely checked by analyzing a continuing
      calibration standard containing all the purgeable target and surrogate
      compounds  to ensure that the Instrument continues to meet the
      instrument sensitivity and linearity requirements of the method.

15 . 2  Frequency

      15.2.1  Each GC/HS used for analysis shall be calibrated once per each
              twelve (12) hour  time period of operation.  The twelve hour
              time period begins with the injection of BFB.
                                     VGA D-24                          10/92

-------
       15.2.2  If tine remains in Che 12 hour time period after meeting the
               technical acceptance criteria for the initial calibration,
               samples may be analyzed.  It is not necessary to analyze a
               continuing calibration standard,  if the initial calibration
               standard that is the same concentration as the continuing
               calibration standard meets the continuing calibration technical
               acceptance criteria.  A method blank is required.  Quantify all
               sample results against the initial calibration standard that is
               the saae concentration as the continuing calibration standard
               (5 ug/L for non-ketones, 25 ug/L for ketones).

15.3  Procedure

      15.3.1   Set up the purge and trap GO/MS system per the  requirements of
               Section III,  Part A.

      15.3.2   All samples,  required blanks,  and standard/spiking solutions
               shall  be allowed to  warm to ambient temperature (approximately
               1  hour)  before analysis.

   •  15.3.3   Tune the GC/MS system to meet  the BFB  technical acceptance
               criteria in Section  11.

      15.3.4   Prepare  a working continuing calibration standard solution
               containing all the purgeable target and  surrogate compounds
               using  the procedure  listed in  Section  7.4.2.  The concentration
               for the  non-ketones  and  the  surrogate  compound  will be 5 ug/L.
               The concentration of  the  ketones  will  be  25 ug/L.

      15.3.5   Prepare  the aqueous continuing calibration solution by adding
               25  uL  of the working  calibration  standard to reagent water as
               described in Paragraph 7.5.

      15.3.6   Add 10 uL of internal standard spiking solution (prepared as
               described in Paragraph 7.4.3)  to  the 25 mL syringe or
               volumetric  flask  containing  the continuing calibration
               standard.  Analyze the continuing calibration standard,
               according  to Section  17.

15.4   Calculations

      15.4.1   Calculate a relative  response  factor (RRF) for each target and
               surrogate compound according to Section 14.4.1.

      15.4.2   Calculate the  percent difference between the continuing
               calibration relative  response factor and the most recent
               initial calibration mean  relative response factor for each
               purgeable target and surrogate compound using Equation D.6.
                                                   - RRF
                 EQ D.6   % DifferenceRRF  -    	——	  x 100
                                     VOA D-25                          10/92

-------
              Where:

              % Difference^ - Percent difference between relative
                                response  factors.

              RRF - Relative response  factor from current continuing
                    calibration standard.
                   — Mean relative response factor from the most recent
                     initial calibration.

15.5  Technical Acceptance Criteria For Continuing Calibration

      15.5.1  The concentration of the volatile organic target and surrogate
              compounds in the continuing calibration standard shall be 5.0
              ug/L for non-ketones and 25.0 ug/L for ke tones.  The continuing
              calibration standard shall be analyzed at the frequency
              described in Section 15.2 on a GC/MS system meeting the BFB and
              the initial calibration technical acceptance criteria.

      15.5.2  The relative response factor for each purgeable target and
              surrogate compound that has a required minimum response factor
              value shall be greater than or equal to the compound's minimum
              acceptable response factor listed in Table D-5.

      15.5.3  The relative response factor percent difference for each
              purgeable target and surrogate compound listed in Table D-5
              shall be less than or equal to that value listed.

      15.5.4  Up to two compounds may fail the requirements listed in
              paragraph 15.5.2 and 15.5.3 and still meet the minimum response
              factor criteria and percent difference criteria.  However,
              these compounds shall have a minimum response factor greater
              than or equal to 0.010 and the percent difference shall be
              within the inclusive range of ±40.0%.

15.6  Corrective Action

      15.6.1  If the continuing calibration technical acceptance criteria are
              not met, recalibrate the GC/MS instrument according to Section
              14.  It may be necessary to clean the ion source, change the
              column or take other corrective actions to achieve the
              continuing calibration technical acceptance criteria.
      15.6.2  Continuing calibration technical acceptance criteria ffflAlL be
              met before any samples (including LCS and PES) or required
              blanks are analyzed.  Any samples, or required blanks analyzed
              when continuing calibration technical acceptance criteria have
              not been met will require reanalysis at no additional cost.
                                     VOA D-26                          10/92

-------
                         SECTICCI 17
SAMPLE ANALYSIS AND COMPOUND IDENTIFICATION AND QDANTITATION
                             VOA D-27                          10/92

-------
 16.   SUMMARY

 16.1  This method is designed for analysis of samples that contain  low
      concentrations of the target compounds listed in Exhibit C.   It is
      expected that the samples will come from drinking water and
      well/ground water type sources around Superfund sites.  If, upon
      inspection of a sample, the Contractor suspects that the sample is
      not amenable to this method, contact SMO for instructions.

 16.2  Before samples or required blanks may be analyzed, the purge  and
      trap, and the GC/MS instrument shall meet the BFB (Section 11),
      initial calibration (Section 14) and continuing calibration (Section
      IS) technical acceptance criteria listed.  Also, before samples may
      be analyzed, a method blank shall be analyzed which meets blank
      technical acceptance criteria listed in Section 26.  All samples,
      required blanks, and calibration standards shall be analyzed  under
      the same instrument conditions.  All samples, required blanks, and
      standard/spiking solutions shall be allowed to warm to ambient
      temperature (approximately 1 hour) before analysis.

 17.   PROCSDulZ

 17.1  Set up the purge and trap GC/MS system per the requirements of
      Section III, Part A.

 17.2  Remove the plunger from a 25 mL syringe that has a closed syringe
      valve attached.  Open the sample or standard container which has been
      allowed to come to ambient temperature (approximately 1 hour), and
      carefully decant the sample into the syringe barrel to Just short of
      overflowing. Replace the syringe plunger and compress the sample.
      Invert the syringe, open the syringe valve,  and vent any residual air
      while adjusting the sample volume to 25.0 mL.  This process of taking
      an aliquot destroys the validity of the sample for future analysis,
      unless the excess sample is immediately transferred to a smaller vial
      with zero headspace and stored at 4*C (±2*C).

      HOTS:  A smaller sample volume (5 to 25 mL)  may be analyzed but the
      CROL andall technical acceptance criteria shall be met.  The same
      sample volume shall be used for all standards,  samples, and blanks
      that apply to a single SDG,

 17.3  Once the sample aliquots have been taken from the VGA vial, the pH of
      the water sample shall be determined.   The purpose of the pH
      determination is to ensure that all VOA samples were acidified in the
      field.  Test the pH by placing one or two drops of sample on the pH
      paper (do nog add pH paper to the vial).   Record the pH of each
      sample and report these data in the SDG Narrative,  following the
      Instructions in Exhibit B.  No pH adjustment is to be performed by
      the Contractor.

17,4  Add 10.0 uL of the internal standard spiking solution and 10.0 uL of
      the surrogate standard solution through the valve bore of the
      syringe,  then close the valve.   Invert the syringe three times.
                                         D-28                          10/92

-------
17.5  Attach the valve assembly  on  the  syringe  to  the valve on  the sample
      purger.  Open the valves and  Inject  the sanple Into  the purging
      chamber.

17.6  Close both valves and purge the sample for 11.0  (+0.1) minutes at
      ambient temperature.

17.7  Sample Desorption

      After the 11 minute purge, attach the trap to the  gas chromatograph,
      adjust the purge and trap  system  to  the desorb node, initiate the
      temperature program sequence of the  gas chromatograph and start  data
      acquisition.  Introduce the trapped  material to the  GC column by
      rapidly heating the trap to 180*C while backflushing the  trap with
      inert gas at IS mL/min for 4.0 ±0.1  min.  While the  trapped material
      is being introduced into the gas chromatograph, empty the  sample
      purger and rinse it with reagent water. For  samples  containing large
      amounts of water soluble materials,  suspended solids, high boiling
      compounds or high purgeable levels,  it may be necessary to wash  out
      the sample purger with a detergent solution, rinse it with reagent
      water, and then dry it in a 105*C oven between analyses.

17.8  Trap Reconditioning — After desorbing the sample, recondition the
      trap for a minimum of 7.0 £0.1 min at 180*C by returning the purge
      and trap system to purge mode,

17.9  Gas Chromatography - Hold the column temperature at 10*C for 1.0 to
      5.0 min,  then program at 6C*/min to  160'C and hold until all target
      compounds have eluted.   Note:   Once  an initial hold time has been
      chosen and the GC operating conditions optimized, the same GC
      condition shall be used for the analysis.

18.   TSllIIIiAflOH OF DATA ACOPISITIOH

      When all purgeable target compounds have eluted from the GC,
      terminate the MS data acquisition and store data files on  the data
      system storage device.   Use appropriate data output software to
      display full range mass spectra and  appropriate extracted  ion current
      profiles (EICPs).

19.   DILOTIOHfS

19.1  If the initial analysis of a sample  indicates the sample shall be
      reanalyzed at a dilution,  the dilution shall be made Just prior  to
      GC/MS analysis of the sample.   Until the diluted sample is in a gas
      tight syringe,  all steps in the dilution procedure shall be performed
      without delay.   Secondary ion quantitation is only allowed when  there
      are sample interferences with the primary quantitation ion, not when
      saturation occurs.   If secondary ion quantitation is used, calculate
      a relative response factor using the area response (EICP)  from the
      most intense secondary ion which is  free of sample interferences, and
      document the reasons in the SDG Narrative.
                                     VGA D-29                          10/92

-------
19.2  All dilutions shall keep the response of the target compounds that
      required dilution in the upper half of the initial calibration range.

19.3  Dilutions are made in volumetric flasks or in a 25 mL "Luerlock"
      syringe.

      19.3.1  To dilute  the  sample  in a volumetric flask, use  the  following
              procedure:

              19.3.1.1   Select the volumetric flask that will allow for
                         the necessary dilution (25 mL to 100 mL).

              19.3.1.2   Calculate  the approximate volume of reagent water
                         which will be added to the volumetric flask
                         selected and add slightly less than this quantity
                         of reagent water to the flask.

             .19.3.1.3   Inject the proper sample aliquot from a syringe
                         into the volumetric flask.  Aliquots of less than
                         1 mL are prohibited.  Dilute the flask to the mark
                         with reagent water.  Cap the flask and invert the
                         flask three times.

              19.3.1.4   Fill a 25.0 mL syringe with the diluted sample and
                         analyze according to Section 17.

      19.3.2  fo dilute  the sample  in a 25 mL syringe, use the following
              procedure:

              19.3.2.1   Calculate the volume of the reagent water
                         necessary for the dilution.   The final volume of
                         the diluted sample should be 25 mL.

              19.3.2.2   Close the syringe valve, remove the plunger from
                         the syringe barrel, and pour reagent water into
                         the syringe barrel to Just short of overflowing.

              19.3.2.3   Replace the syringe plunger and compress the
                         water.

              19.3.2.4   Invert the syringe, open the syringe valve, and
                         vent any residual air.  Adjust the water volume to
                         the desired amount.

              19.3.2.5   Adjust the plunger to the 25 mL mark to
                         accommodate the sample aliquot.  Inject the proper
                         aliquot of sample from another syringe through the
                         valve bore of the 25 mL syringe.  Close the valve
                         and invert three times.

              19.3.2.6   Analyze according to Sections 17.4 to 18.
                                     VGA D-30                          10/92

-------
20,   IDENTIFICATION 0? TARGEf COMPOUNDS

20,1  The compounds listed In the Target Compound List (TCL),  Exhibit C,
      shall be identified by an analyst competent In the interpretation of
      mass spectra by comparison of the sample mass spectrum to the mass
      spectrum of a standard of the suspected compound.   Two criteria shall
      be satisfied to verify the identifications:  (1) elution of the
      sample compound at the same GC relative retention time as the
      standard compound, and (2) correspondence of the sample compound and
      standard compound mass spectra.

20.2  For establishing correspondence of the GC relative retention time
      (RET), the sample compound RRT shall be within ±0.06 RRT units of the
      RET of the standard compound in the continuing calibration analysis.
      If co-elution of interfering compounds prohibits accurate assignment
      of the sample compound RET from the extracted ion current profile for
      the primary ion, the RET shall be assigned by using the  total ion
      chromatogr am.

20.3  For comparison of standard and sample compound mass spectra,  mass
      spectra obtained on the Contractor's GC/MS are required.  Once
      obtained,  these standard spectra may be used for identification
      purposes,  only if the Contractor's GC/MS meets the BFB technical
    .  acceptance criteria.  These standard spectra may be obtained from the
      continuing calibration analysis  that was also used to obtain the
      reference relative retention times.

20.4  The guidelines for qualitative verification by comparison of mass
      spectra are as follows:

      20.4.1  All  ions present in the standard mass spectra at a relative
              intensity greater than 25 percent (most abundant ion in the
              spectrum equals 100 percent) should be present in the sample
              spectrum.

      20.4.2  The relative intensities of ions specified in Section 20.4.1
              shall agree within ±20 percent between the standard and
              sample spectra.  (Example:  For an ion with an abundance of
              SO percent in the standard spectra, the corresponding sample
              abundance shall be between 30 and 70 percent).

      20.4.3  Ions greater than 25 percent in the sample spectrum but not
              present in the standard spectrum shall be considered and
              accounted for by the analyst making the comparison.  The
              verification process should FAVOE FALSE POSITIVES.  All
              compounds meeting the identification criteria shall be
              reported with their spectra.

      20.4.4  If a compound cannot be verified by all of the spectral
              identification criteria listed in Sections 20.4.1 - 20.4.3,
              but  in the technical Judgment of the mass spectral
              interpretation specialist, the identification is correct,
              then the Contractor shall report that identification and
              proceed with quantisation.
                                     VOA D-31                          10/92

-------
21.   IDENTIFICATION OF NON-TARGET COMPOUNDS

21.1  A library search shall be executed for non-target sample compounds
      for the purpose of tentative identification.  For this purpose, the
      most recent release of the National Institute of Standards and
      Technology Mass Spectral Library shall be used.

21.2  Up to ten (10) non-internal standard and non-surrogate organic
      compounds of greatest apparent concentration not listed in Exhibit C
      for the purgeable organic fraction shall be tentatively identified
      via a forward search of the NIST Mass Spectral Library. (Compounds
      with a peak area response less than 40 percent of the peak area
      response of the best matched internal standard are not required to be
      searched in this fashion.)  Only after visual comparison of sample
      spectra with the nearest library searches will the mass spectral
      interpretation specialist assign a tentative identification.
      Computer generated library searches shall not use normalization
      routines if those routines would misrepresent the library or unknown
      spectra when compared to each other.

21.3  Guidelines for making tentative identification:

      21.3.1  All ions present in the standard mass spectra at a relative
              intensity greater than 25 percent (most abundant ion in the
              spectrum equals 100 percent) shall be present in the sample
              spectrum.

      21.3.2  The relative intensities of the major ions specified in
              Section 20.4.1 shall agree within +20 percent between the
              standard and sample spectra.  (Example: For an ion with an
              abundance of 50 percent in the standard spectra, the
              corresponding sample ion abundance shall be between 30 and 70
              percent.)

      21.3.3  Molecular ions present in reference spectrum should be
              present in sample spectrum.

      21.3.4  Ions present in the sample spectrum but not in the reference
              spectrum should be reviewed for possible background
              contamination or presence of coeluting compounds.

      21.3.5  Ions present in the reference spectrum but not in the sample
              spectrum should be reviewed for possible subtraction from the
              sample spectrum because of background contamination or
              coeluting compounds.  Data system library reduction programs
              can sometimes create these discrepancies.

      21.3.6  Ions greater than 25 percent in the sample spectrum but not
              present in the standard spectrum shall be considered and
              accounted for by the analyst making the comparison.  The
              verification process should FAVOR FALSE POSITIVES.  All
              compounds meeting the identification criteria shall be
              reported with their spectra.
                                     VOA D-32                          10/92

-------
      21.3.6   If in the technical judgment of the mass  spectral
               Interpretation specialist,  no valid tentative  identification
               can be made,  the compound should be reported as  unknown.   The
               mass spectral specialist should give additional
               classification of the unknown compound, if possible  (e.g.,
               unknown aromatic,  unknown hydrocarbon, unknown chlorinated
               compound) .  If a probable molecular weight can be
               distinguished,  include it.

22.   CALCULATIONS

      NOTE:  Unless otherwise stated the area response is that of the
      extracted ion current profile (SICF) of the primary quantitation ion.

22.1  Target Compounds

      22.1.1  Calculate target compound and surrogate concentrations using
              Equation D.7.


                   EQ. D.7   Concentration in ug/L -   (Ax)(Is)(Df)
                                                     
-------
              0.5 ug/L is  calculated,  report as  "0.5 J."   Report ALL sample
              concentration data  as  UNCORRECTED  for blanks.

      22.1.3  Xylenes  (o-,  a-,  and p-  isomers) are to be  reported as
              xylenes  (total).  Because a-  and p-xylene isomers  coelute on
              capillary columns,  special attention shall  be  given to the
              quantitation of the xylenes.   The  relative  response factor
              (RRF)  is based on the  peak that represents  the single  isoner
              on the GC column using o-xylene on capillary columns.   In
              quantitatlng sample concentrations, use the areas  on both,
              peaks  and the RRF.  The  areas of the two peaks may be  summed
              and the  concentration  determined,  or the concentration
              represented  by each of the two peaks nay be determined
              separately,  and then sunned.

      22.1.4  The stereoIsomers,  trans-1,2-dichloroethene and cls-
              1,2-dichloroethene, are  to be reported separately.

22.2  Non-Target Compounds

      Equation'D.7  is also used for calculating non-target compound
      concentrations.  Total area  counts  (or peak heights) from the total
      ion chromatograms (RIG) are  to be used for both  the  non-target
      compound to be measured (A^) and the  internal  standard (A^s).
      Associate  the nearest internal standard free of  interferences with
      the non-target compound to be measured. A relative  response factor
      (RRF) of 1.0  is to be assumed.   The value  from this  quantitation
      shall be qualified as estimated ("J").  This estimated concentration
      shall be calculated for all  tentatively identified compounds as well
      as those identified as unknowns.  Do  not report  any  non-tar get
      compound whose concentration is less  than 2.0 ug/L  (peak area
      response is less than 40% of the peak area response  of the  nearest
      internal standard).

22.3  Surrogates

      Calculate  the surrogate percent recovery using Equation D.S.

                                             Qd
      EQ. D.S Surrogate Percent Recovery - 	  x  100
                                             Qa

      Where:

      Q
-------
                                 As - AC
              EQ.  D.9  % ARC  - 	*——-  x 100
                                    Ac

              Where:

              % ARC - Percent area response change.

                 As - Area response of the internal standard  (EICP)  in  the
                      sample/blank analysis.

                 AC - Area response of the internal standard  (EICP)  in  the
                      most recent continuing calibration standard.

      22.4.2  Calculate the retention time shift (RTS) between the
              sample/blank analysis and the most recent continuing
              calibration standard analysis for each of the internal
              standards using Equation D.10.

                     EQ.  D.10        RTS - RTS  -  RTC

              ifhere:

              RTS - Retention time shift.

              RTS - Retention time of the internal standard in a
                    sample/blank.

              RTC - Retention time of the internal standard in
                    the most recent continuing calibration standard.

23.    TECHNICAL ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA FOR SAMPLE ANALYSIS

23.1  The sample shall  be analyzed on a GC/HS system meeting the  BFB,
      initial calibration,  continuing calibration,  and blank technical
      acceptance criteria.

23.2  The sample shall  be analyzed within the contract holding times.  The
      sample shall have an LCS associated with  it meeting  the  LCS technical
      acceptance criteria.   The sample shall have a PES associated with it
      meeting the  PES technical acceptance criteria.

23.3  The surrogate compound percent recovery shall be between 80 and 120
      percent inclusive.

23.4  The difference of the area response between  the  sample and  the most
      recent continuing calibration standard analysis  for  each of the
      internal standards shall be within the inclusive range of +40.0
      percent of the continuing calibration standard.

23.5  The retention time shift between the sample  and  the  most recent
      continuing calibration standard analysis  for  each of the internal
      standards shall be within +0.33 minutes  (20.0 seconds).
                                     VGA D-35                          10/92

-------
 23.6  Excluding those  ions  in the  solvent  front,  no  ion may saturate the
       detector.  No  target  compound concentration may  exceed the  upper
       limit of the initial  calibration range unless  a  more  dilute aliquot
       of the sample  is also analyzed according  to the  procedures  in Section
       19.

 23.7  The  Contractor shall  demonstrate that there is no carryover from a
       contaminated sample before data from subsequent  analyses may be
       submitted.  After a sample that contains  a  target compound  at a level
       exceeding the  initial calibration range,  or a  non-target compound at
       a  concentration  greater than 100 ug/L, or saturated ions from a
       compound (excluding the compound peaks in the  solvent  front),  the
       Contractor shall either:

       23.7.1   Analyze  an instrument blank immediately  after the
               contaminated  sample.  If an autosampler  is used, an
               instrument blank shall also be analyzed  using the  same purge
               inlet  that was used  for the contaminated sample.   The
               instrument blanks shall meet the  technical acceptance
               criteria for  blank analysis (Section 26.4), or

       23.7.2   Monitor  the sample analyzed immediately  after the
               contaminated  sample  for all  compounds  that were in  the
               contaminated  sample  and that exceeded  the limits above.  The
               maximum  contamination criteria are  as  follows;  the sample
               shall  not contain a  concentration above  the CRQL for the
               target compounds or  above 2  ug/L  for the non-target compounds
               that exceeded the limits in the contaminated  sample.   If an
               autosampler is used, the next sample analyzed using the same
               purge  inlet that was used for the contaminated sample also
               shall  meet the maximum contamination criteria.

24.   CORRECTIVE ACTION

24.1  If the technical acceptance  criteria for the internal standards and
      surrogate compound are not met, check calculations, internal standard
      solutions and instrument performance.  It may be necessary to bake*
      out the system to remove the water from the purge and trap transfer
      lines of the trap, to recalibrate the instrument, or take other
      corrective action procedures to meet the  technical acceptance
      criteria.

24.2  If the Contractor needs to analyze more than one  (1)  sample dilution
      other than the  original analysis to have  all the  target compounds
      within the initial calibration range (excluding the compound peaks in
      the solvent front), contact SHO.  SMO will contact the Region for
      instructions,

24.3  All samples to  be reported shall meet the maximum contamination
      criteria in Section 23.7.  If any sample  fails to meet these
      criteria, each  subsequent analysis shall  be checked for cross
      contamination.   The analytical system is  considered contaminated
      until a sample  has been analyzed that meets the maximum contamination
                                     VOA D-36                          10/92

-------
      criteria or an instrument blank has been analyzed that meets the
      technical acceptance criteria for blanks.

24.4  Sample technical acceptance criteria SHALL be met before data are
      reported.  Samples contaminated from laboratory sources or any
      samples not meeting the sample technical acceptance criteria will
      require reanalysis at no additional cost.

24.5  Sample reruns performed as a result of suspected matrix interference
      beyond the scope of the method will be evaluated on a case-by-case
      basis for payment purposes by SMO.

25.    [This paragraph has been intentionally left blank and has been
      reserved for the use of SMO.1
                                    VGA D-37                          10/92

-------
                     SECTION V
SAMPLE QUALITY CONTROL PROCEDURES AND REQUIREMENTS
                        VGA D-38                          10/92

-------
26.   BLANK ANALYSIS

26.1  Summary

      There are three different types of blanks required by this method.

      26.1.1  Method Blank -  25 mL of  reagent water  spiked with  10.0  ul
              internal  standard and 10.0 ul  surrogate  solution,  and carried
              through the entire  analytical  scheme.  The method  blank is
              analyzed  immediately following the continuing calibration
              standard  and before any  samples are analyzed.  The method
              blank shall be  analyzed  immediately after the initial
              calibration sequence if  samples are analyzed before the 12
              hour  time period expires.  The method  blank  measures reagent
              and system contamination.

      26.1.2  Storage Blank -  Upon receipt of the first samples  from  a
              Sample  Delivery Group, two-40  mL screw cap VGA vials with a
              FIFE-faced silicon  septum are  filled with reagent  water (80
              mL total).   The vials are stored under the same conditions as
              •the samples in  the  Sample Delivery Group.  A 25.0  mL aliquot
              of this reagent water is spiked with a 10.0  uL internal
              standard  and 10.0 uL of  surrogate solution and analyzed  after
              all samples in  the  Sample Delivery Group have been analyzed.
              The storage blank indicates whether contamination  may have
              occurred  during storage  of samples.

      26.1.3  Instrument  Blank -  25 mL of reagent water spiked with 10.0 uL
              of internal and 10.0  uL  of surrogate solution carried through
              the entire  analytical scheme.   Instrument blanks are analyzed
              after a sample/dilution which  contains a target compound at a
              concentration greater than 25  ug/L (ketones  125 ug/L) or a
              non-target  compound at a con"-~^ration greater than 100  ug/L
              or saturated ions from a compound (excluding the compound
              peaks in  the solvent  front).   The results from instrument
              blank analysis  indicate whether there  is contamination from a
              previous  sample.

26.2  Frequency

      26.2.1  The method  blank shall be analyzed after the continuing
              calibration standard  and before any samples or storage blanks
              are analyzed.  The  method blank shall be analyzed after  the
              initial calibration sequence if samples are analyzed before
              the 12 hour time period expires.  A method blank shall be
              analyzed  in each 12-hour time  period in which samples,
              including LCS, FES  and storage blanks  from an SDG are
              analyzed.

      26.2.2  Storage blanks shall be analyzed once per Sample Delivery
              Group, after  all of the samples have been analyzed.

      26.2.3  The Contractor shall demonstrate that there  is no carryover
              from contaminated samples before data from subsequent
                                     VOA D-39                          10/92

-------
               analyses may be used.   Samples may contain target compounds
               at levels exceeding the initial calibration range (25  ug/L
               for non-ketones,  125 ug/L for ketones)  or non-target
               compounds at concentrations  greater than 100 ug/L,  or  ions
               from a compound that saturate the  detector (excluding  the
               compound peaks  in the  solvent front).   An instrument blank
               shall be analyzed immediately after the contaminated sample
               (also in the sane injection  port if an  autosampler is  used)
               or a sample that meets the maximum contamination criteria in
               Section 23.7 shall be  analyzed.  For these purposes, if the
               instrument blank meets the technical acceptance  criteria for
               blank analysis  or the  sample meets the  "HTtim*™ contamination
               criteria,  the system is considered to be uncontaminated.   If
               the instrument  blank or sample does not meet the criteria
               (i.e.,  is contaminated),  the system shall be decontaminated.
               Until an Instrument blank meets  the blank technical
               acceptance criteria or a sample  meets the maximum
               contamination criteria (Section 23.7),  any samples  analyzed
               since the  original contaminated sample  will require
               reanalysis at no  additional  expense.

26.3  Procedure

      Prepare and analyze the  blanks  and calculate results according to
      Sections 17 through 22.

26,4  Technical Acceptance Criteria For Blank Analysis
                                               •
      26.4.1   All blanks shall  be  analyzed on  a GC/MS  system meeting  the
               BFB,  initial  calibration,  and continuing calibration
               technical  acceptance criteria and at the  frequency  described
               in Section 26.2.

      26.4.2   The storage blank shall be analyzed on  a GC/MS system that
               also  meets the  technical  acceptance criteria for  the method
               blank.

      26.4.3   Surrogate  compound recovery  in the blank shall be between 80
               and 120 percent inclusive.

      26.4.4   The difference  of the  area response between the blank and the
               most  recent continuing calibration standard analysis for  each
               of the  internal standards  shall be within the inclusive range
               of +40.0 percent  of  the response in the  continuing
               calibration standard.

      26.4.5   The retention time shift between the blank and the most
               recent  continuing calibration standard analysis for each  of
               the internal  standards shall  be  less than or equal  to ±0.33
               minutes  (20.0 seconds).

      26.4.6   The concentration of the  target  compounds in the blank shall
               be less  than  the  CRQL  for  each target compound.  The
                                     VGA D-40                         10/92

-------
               concentration of non- target  compounds  in  the blank shall be
               less  than 2.0 ug/L.

26.5  Corrective Action

      26.5.1   It is  the  Contractor's  responsibility  to  ensure  that method
               interferences caused by contaainants in solvents , reagents ,
               glassware,  laboratory air  and other sample  storage and
               processing hardware that lead to  discrete artifacts and/or
               elevated baselines in gas  chroaatograns be  eliminated.  If a
               Contractor's  blanks exceed the criteria in  Paragraph 26.4.6,
               the Contractor shall consider the analytical system to be out
               of control.   The  source  of the contamination shall be
               investigated  and  appropriate  corrective measures SHALL be
               taken  and  documented before  further sample  analysis proceeds .

      26.5.2   Any method blank  or instrument blank that fails  to meet the
               technical  acceptance criteria shall be  reanalyzed at no
               additional  cost.  Further, all samples  processed within the
               same 12 -hour  time period with a method  blank or  instrument
              blank  that  does not meet the  blank technical acceptance
               criteria will  require reanalysis  at no  additional cost.
              Note:  Storage blank data  shall be retained by the Contractor
               and be made available for  inspection during the  on-site
               laboratory  evaluation.

27.   LABORATORY CONTROL
27 . 1  Summary
      The LCS is an internal laboratory quality control sample designed to
      assess (on an SDG -by -SDG basis)  the capability of the contractor to
      perform the analytical method listed in this Exhibit.
27.2  Frequency
      The LCS shall be prepared,  analyzed,  and reported once per Sample
      Delivery Group.   The LCS shall be prepared and analyzed concurrently
      with the samples in the SDG using the same instrumentation as the
      samples in the SDG.
27.3  Procedure
      27.3.1  Prepare the LCS using the procedure described in Section 17.
              Spike 25 mL of reagent water with 10.0 uL of LCS spiking
              solution (see Paragraph 7.4.5), 10.0 uL of internal standard,
              and 10.0 uL of surrogate solution.

      27.3.2  Analyze the LCS as described in Sections 17 to 22.
                                     VGA D-41                         10/92

-------
27.4  Calculations

      27.4.1  Calculate  individual compound recoveries of the LCS using
              Equation D.8, substituting LCS percent recovery for surrogate
              percent recovery.

      27.4.2  See Section 22 for equations necessary for other
              calculations.

27.5  Technical Acceptance Criteria For Laboratory Control Sample Analysis

      27.5.1  The LCS shall be analyzed on a GC/MS system .meeting the BFB,
              initial calibration, continuing calibration, and blank
              technical  acceptance criteria at the frequency described in
              Section 27.2.

      27.5.2  The LCS shall be prepared as described in Paragraph 27.3.

      27.5.3  The LCS shall be prepared and analyzed with a method blank
              that meets the blank technical acceptance criteria.

      27.5.4  'Surrogate  compound recovery in the LCS shall be between 80
              and 120 percent inclusive.

      27.5.5  The area response change between the LCS and the most recent
              continuing calibration standard analysis for each of the
              internal standards shall be within the inclusive range of
              ±40.0 percent.

      27.5.6  The retention time shift between the LCS and the most recent
              continuing calibration standard analysis for each of the
              internal standards shall be within ±0.33 minutes (20.0
              seconds).

      27.5.7  The percent recovery for each of the compounds in the LCS
              shall be within the recovery limits listed in Table D-6.

                              TABLE D-6

                                                     Percent
            Compound                              Recovery Limits

            Vinyl chloride60-140
            1,2-Dichloroethane                         60-140
            Carbon tetrachloride                        60-140
            1,2-Dichloropropane                         60-140
            Trichloroethene                             60-140
            1,1,2-Trichloroethane                       60-140
            Benzene                                     60-140
            cis-l,3-Dichloropropene                    60-140
            Bromofora                                  60-140
            Tetrachloroethene                           60-140
            1,2-Dibromoethane                           60-140
            1,4-Dichlorobenzene                         60-140
                                     VGA D-42                          10/92

-------
      NOTE:  The recovery Halts for any of the compounds  listed above  may
      be expanded at any tine during the period of performance if  SMO
      determines that the limits are too restrictive.

27.6  Corrective Action

      27.6.1   If the  LCS  technical acceptance criteria for the internal
               standards and surrogate  are  not net, check calculations,
               internal standard and surrogate solutions,  and instrument
               performance.   It  may be  necessary to recalibrate the
               instrument  or take other corrective action procedures to  meet
               the internal  standard and surrogate criteria.

      27.6.2   The laboratory may not submit data from an SDG until the  LCS
               technical acceptance criteria are met.   LCS contamination
               from  laboratory sources  or any  LCS not  meeting the criteria
               will  require  reanalysis  of the  LCS at no additional  cost.

      27.6.3   Further, all  samples in  the  SDG prepared and analyzed with an
              .LCS that does not meet the LCS  technical acceptance  criteria
              will  also require reanalysis at no additional  cost.   Any  LCS
               failing to meet these technical acceptance  criteria  shall be
               reanalyzed at no  additional  cost.

28.   PERFORMANCE EVALUATIONSAMPLE (FES)

28.1  Summary

      The FES is an external laboratory quality control sample prepared and
      designed to assess  (on an SDG-by-SDG basis)  the  capability of the
      Contractor to perform the analytical method-listed in this Exhibit.

28.2  Frequency

      The Contractor shall analyze  and report the  PSS  once per SDG, if
      available.  The FES  shall be  prepared and analyzed concurrently with
      the samples in the  SDG using  the same instrumentation as the samples
      in the SDG.

28.3  Procedure

      28.3.1  The FES will  be received either as an ampulated extract or  as
              a full volume sample.  If received as an ampulated extract,
              the Contractor will  receive  instructions  concerning  the
              dilution procedure to bring  the extract  to full volume prior
              to preparation and analysis  of  the FES.

      28.3.2  Prepare the FES for  analysis using the procedure described  in
              Section 17.    Add  10.0 uL of  internal standard  and 10.0 uL of
              surrogate solution to the aqueous FES.    Analyze  the  FES as
              described in  Sections 17 to  22.
                                     VGA D-43                          10/92

-------
28.4  Calculations

      See Section 22 for equations necessary for calculations.

28.5  Technical Acceptance Criteria for the PES

      28.5.1   The PES  shall be  analyzed on a GC/MS  system meeting the BFB,
               initial  calibration, continuing  calibration,  and blanks
               technical acceptance criteria at a frequency described in
               Section  28.2.

      28.5.2   The PES  shall be  prepared according to  the  procedure in
               Section  28.3.

      28.5.3   The surrogate compound percent recovery in  the PIS  shall be
               between  80 and  120 percent  Inclusive.

      28.5.4   The difference  of the area  response between the  PES and the
               most recent continuing calibration standard analysis for each
               of the Internal standards shall  be within the inclusive range
               of ±40.0 percent.

      28.5.5   The retention tiae shift between the  PES and the most recent
               continuing calibration standard  analysis for  each of the
               Internal standards shall be within ±0.33 minutes (20.0
               seconds).

28.6  Corrective Action

      28.6.1   If the PES technical acceptance  criteria for  the internal
               standards and the surrogate are  not net, check calculations,
               standard solutions and Instrument performance.   It  may be
               necessary to recalibrate the  instrument or  take  other
               corrective action procedures  to  meet  r.he internal standard
               criteria.  Any  PES failing  to meet these technical  acceptance
               criteria shall  be reanalyzed  at  no additional.   If
               insufficient PES  spiking extract remains or if insufficient
               full volume PIS remains, document this  in the SDG Narrative
               by stating that the PES could not be  reanalyzed  because
               insufficient volume remains.

      28.6.2   In addition to  complying with the PES technical  acceptance
               criteria, the Contractor will be responsible  for correctly
               identifying and quantifying the  compounds Included  in the
               PES.  SMO will  notify the Contractor of unacceptable
               performance.

               Note:  Unacceptable performance  for identification  and
               quantitation of compounds is defined as a score  less  than 75
               percent.

      28.6.3   The PES  technical acceptance criteria SHALL be met before
               sample data are reported.  Also,  the Contractor  shall
               demonstrate acceptable performance for compound
               identification  and quantitation.   If the Contractor fails to
                                     VGA D-44                         10/92

-------
meet  the  PES  technical acceptance criteria or achieves a
score of  less  than 75 percent, SMO nay take, but is not
limited to  the following actions:  reduction of the number of
samples,  suspension of sample shipment, a site visit, a full
data audit, and/or requiring the laboratory to analyze a
remedial  PES,  and/or a contract action such as a Cure Notice.
Also, if  the Contractor achieves a score of less than 75%,
SMO may reject  some or all of the sample data associated with
the failed PIS  in an SDG, return the rejected data to the
Contractor, and not pay for the sample analysis.
                      VOA D-45                          10/92

-------
                                  TABLE D-3
           TECHNICAL ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA FOR INITIAL AND CONTINUING
                  CALIBRATION FOR VOLATILE ORGANIC COMPOUNDS
Volatile
Coinoound
Benzene
Bromochlorome thane
Bromodichlorone thane
Bromoform
B r omo me thane
Carbon tetrachloride
Chlorobenzene
Chloroform
Dibroraochlorome thane
1 , 2 -Dibronoe thane
1,2- D Ichlorobenz ene
1 , 3-DIchlorobenzene
1,4- D Ichlorobenzene
1 , 1 -DIchloroe thane
1 , 2-Dlchloroethane
1 , 1- DIchloroe thane
x is - 1 , 3 - D tchloiropr opene
trans - 1 , 3 -Dichloropropene
Ethylbenzene
Scyrene
1,1,2,2 -Tetrachloroe thane
Tetrachloroethene
Toluene
1,1, 1 -Trichloroe thane
1,1,2- Trichloroe thane
Trichloroe thene
Vinyl chloride
Xylenes (total)
4- Bromof luorobenzene
Minimum
RRF
0.500
0.05
0.200
0.05
0.100
0.100
0.500
0.200
0.100
O.iO"
0.400
0.600
0.500
0.200
0.100
0.100
0.200
0.100
0.100
0.300
0.100
0.200
0.400
0.100
0.100
0.300
0.100
0.300
0.200
Maximum
%RSD
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
30.0
Maximum
%Diff
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
+30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
±30.0
+30.0
±30,0
±30.0
±30.0
The following compounds have no maximum %RSD or aaxinun f Difference
criteria, but shall meet a minima ERF criterion of 0.010:
Carbon disulfide
Choroethane
Chloromethane
cis-l,2-Dichloroethene
trans-1,2-Dichloroethene
1,2-Dichloropropane
Methylene Chloride
Note:  At the present tine, the minimum RRF or %RSD criteria for Acetone, 2-
Butanone, 1,2-Dibromo-3-chloropropane, 2-Hexanone and 4-Methyl-2-pentanone
has not been set.
                                     VGA D-46
                                     10/92

-------
                                    TABLE D-4
            VOLATILE TARGET COMPOUNDS AND SURROGATE WITH CORRESPONDING
                       INTERNAL STANDARDS FOR QUANTITATION
1 4-DIFLUORQBENZSNE
 CHLOROBENZENE-d5
Acetone
Bromochloromethane
Bromomethane
2-Butanone
Carbon disulflde
Chloroethane
Chlorofom
Chlorone thane
1,1-Dichloroethane
1,2-Dichloroethane
1,1-Dichloroethene
cts-1,2-Dichloroethene
trans-1,2-Dichloroethene
Methylene chloride
Vinyl chloride
4-Bromofluorobenzene
Benzene
Bromodtchloromethane
Carbon tetrachloride
Chlorobenzene
DIbroBochloromethane
1,2-Dibromoethane
1,2-DIchloropropane
cia-1,3-Dichloropropene
trans-1,3-Dichloropropene
Ethylbenzene
2-Hexanone
4 - Me thy1-2-pentanone
Styrene
1,1,2,2-Tetrachloroethane
Te trachloroe thene
Toluene
1,1,1-Trichloroethane
1,1,2-Trichloroethane
Trichloroethene
Xylenes (total)
 .4-DTCHIjOROBENZENE-d4
Bromofora
1,2-Dibromo-3•chloropropane
1,2-DIchlorobenzene
1,3-Dichlorobenzene
1,4-Dichlorobenzene
                                       VGA D-47
                            10/92

-------
                                TABLE D-5
              PRIMARY QUANTITATION IONS (M/Z) AND SECONDARY
                   IONS FOR VOLATILE ORGANIC COMPOUNDS
Volatile
Target
Compounds
Acetone
Benzene
Bromochlorome thane
Br omodi chl or ome thane
Br onto fora
Bromome thane
2-Butanone
Carbon disulfide
Carbon tetrachloride
Chlorobenzene
Chloroe thane
Chloroform
Chlorome thane
Dibroraochlorome thane
l,2-Dibro»o-3-chloropropane
1 , 2 - D ibroaoe thane
1 , 2 - Dichlorobehzene
1 , 3-Dichlorobenzene
1 , 4 -Dichlorobenzene
1 , 1-Dichloroe thane
1 , 2-Dichloroe thane
1 , 1 -Dichloroethene
cis-1 , 2-Dichloroethene
trans -1 , 2 -Dichloroethene
1 , 2 -Dichloropropane
cla-l,3-Dlchloropropene
trans - 1 , 3 - Dichloropropene
Ethylbenzene
2-Hexanone
Methylene chloride
4-Methyl-2-pentanone
Styrene
1,1,2, 2 -I etrachloroe thane
Tetrachloroethene
Toluene
1,1,1 -Trlchloroe thane
1 , 1 , 2 -Trlchloroe thane
Tr ichloroe thene
Vinyl chloride
Xylenes (total)
SURROGATE COMPOUND AND INTERNAL
4 - Br omo f luor obenz ene
Chlorobenzene - d5
1,4- Dichlorobenzene -d4
1,4-Dlfluorobenzene
Prinary
Quant i tat I on
Ion
43
78
128
83
173
94
43
76
117
112
64
83
50
129
75
107
146
146
146
63
62
96
96
96
63
75
75
91
43
84
43
104
83
166
91
97
97
95
62
106
STANDARDS :
174
117
152
114
Secondary
Ions
58
_
49 , 130
85,127
175,254
96
72*
78
119
77,114
66
85
52
127
155,157
109 , 188
111,148
111,148
111,148
65,83
98
61,63
61,98
61,98
112
77
77
106
58,57,100
86,49
58,100
78
131,85
168,129
92
99,61
83,85,99,132,134
130,132
64
91

95,176
82,119
115,150
63,88
Quantisation of this analyte is based on m/z 43 but m/z 72
shall be present in the spectrum.
                                  VOA D-48                          10/92

-------
                                 EXHIBIT D
METHOD FOR THE ANALYSIS OF LOW CONCENTRATION WATER FOE SEMIVOLATILE ORGANIC
                                 COMPOUNDS
                                    SV  D-l                            10/92

-------
                               Table  of Contents
                                                                      Page
SECTION I:

SECTION II:
SECTION III;
SECTION IV:
SECTION V:
Introduction	SV D- 3
Part A - Sample/Sample Extract Storage and
           Holding Times  	SV D-4
Part B * Equipment and Standards	SV D-5

Instrument Quality Control Procedures
  and Requirements
Part A - Instrument Operating Conditions 	SV D-13
Part B - Tuning the Mass Spectrometer	SV D-14
Part C - Calibration of the GC/MS System	SV D-16

Sample Preparation, Analysis, and Compound
"- Identification and Quantitation 	SV D-23

Sample Quality Control Procedures and
  Requirements	SV D-33
                                     SV D-2
                                                        10/92

-------
                                   SECTION I
                                 INTtODUCTION
The analytical method that follows is designed to analyze samples containing
low concentrations of the semivolatile compounds listed on the Target
Compound List (TCL) in Exhibit C.  The majority of the samples are expected
to be from drinking water and well/ground water sources around Superfund
sites.  The method is based upon the semivolatile method contained in the CLP
Statement Of Work, "Organic Analysis, Multi-Media, Multi-Concentration by
GC/MS and 6C/EC Techniques", except that a single extraction at a pH 2.0 is
used.  Incorporated in the method are specific requirements to minimize
contamination of the samples from laboratory sources.

Problems have been associated with the following compounds covered by this
method:

o   Dichlorobenzidine  and 4-chloroaniline  may be  subject  to oxidative  losses
    during  solvent  concentration.

o   Hexachlorocyclopentadiene  is  subject to  thermal decomposition  in the  inlet
    of the  gas chromatograph,  chemical  reactions  in acetone solution,  and
    photochemical decomposition.
o   N-nitrosodiphenylamine decomposes in the  gas  chromatographic inlet forming
    diphenylamine and, consequently, nay be  detected  as diphenylamine.
o   Due to  the lower quant i tat ion limits required by  this method,  extra
    caution shall be exercised when identifying compounds.
                                     SV D-3                            10/92

-------
                                  SECTION II


PART A - SAMPLE/SAMPLE EXTRACT STORAGE AND HOLDING TIMES

1.    PROCEDCRZS FOR SAMPLE STORAGE

      The samples shall be protected from light and refrigerated at 4*C
      (±2*C) from the time of receipt until 60 days after delivery of a
      complete reconciled data package to the Region.  After 60 days the
      samples may be disposed of in a manner that complies with all
      applicable regulations.

      Samples shall be stored in an atmosphere demonstrated to be free of all
      potential contaminants.

      Samples, sample extracts, and standards shall be stored separately.

2.    PROCEDURE FOR, SAHFTJt 1ffiTR/i
-------
PART B - EQUIPMENT AND STANDARDS

4,    SUMMARY Of MgTHOP

4.1   A one liter aliquot of sample is acidified to pH 2.0 and extracted with
      methylene chloride using a continuous liquid- liquid extractor.  The
      methylene chloride extract is dried and concentrated to a volume of 1,0
      mL.  The extract is injected onto a gas chromatograph (GC) capillary
      column.  The gas chromatograph is temperature programmed to separate
      the semi volatile compounds,  which are then detected with a mass
      spectrometer (MS) .

4.2   Target and surrogate compounds are identified in the samples by
      analyzing standards under the same conditions used for samples and
      comparing resultant mass spectra and GC retention times.  Internal
      standards are added to all samples and standards .   A response factor is
      established for each target and surrogate compound during the initial
      and continuing calibrations by comparing the MS response for the
      primary Ion produced by the compound extracted ion current profile
      (EICP) to the MS response for the primary ion produced by an internal
      standard;  Each identified target and surrogate compound in a sample is
      quantified by comparing the responses for the target compound and the
      internal standard, while taking into account the response factor from
      the most recent calibration, the sample volume, and any sample
      dilutions .

4.3   Son- target compounds are identified by comparing the resultant mass
      spectra from the non- target compounds to mass spectra contained in the
      National Institute of Standards and Technology Mass Spectral Library.
      Non- target compounds are quantified by comparing the MS response from
      the reconstructed ion chromatogram (RIC) for the non- target compound
      peaks to the MS response produced by the nearest internal standard.  A
      response factor of 1 is assumed.
5.
      Contaminants in solvents,  reagents,  glassware and other sample
      processing hardware,  may cause method interferences such as discrete
      artifacts and/or elevated baselines in the reconstructed ion current
      (RIC) profiles (TICPs) .   All of these materials shall be routinely
      demonstrated to be free  from interferences under the conditions of the
      analysis by running laboratory method blanks.  Matrix interferences may
      be caused by contaminants that are coextracted from the sample.  The
      extent of matrix interferences will vary considerably from source to
      source .

      APPARATUS AND MATERIALS

      Brand names, suppliers and part numbers are for illustrative purposes
      only.  No endorsement is implied.   Equivalent performance may be
      achieved using apparatus and materials other than those specified here,
      but demonstration of equivalent performance meeting the requirements of
      the method is the responsibility of the Contractor.
                                     SV D-5                            10/92

-------
 6.1   Gas Chromatograph/Mass Spectrometer

      6.1.1    Gas Chromatograph -  The gas  chromatograph (GC)  system shall be
               capable of temperature programming and have  a flow controller
               that maintains  a constant column flow rate throughout the
               temperature program.   The system shall be suitable for
               splitless injection  and have all required accessories including
               syringes, analytical columns,  and gases.   All GC  carrier gas
               lines shall be  constructed from stainless steel or copper
               tubing.   Non-polytetrafluoroethylene  (PTFE)  thread sealants, or
               flow controllers with rubber components are  not to be used.

               Gas ChromaCography Column -  A 30 a x  0.25 mm ID (or 0.32 am)
               bonded-phase sillcone caated fused silica capillary column (J&W
               Scientific Dfi-5  or equivalent).   A film thickness  of  0.25 to
               1.0 urn may be used.

      6.1.2    Mass  Spectrometer - The mass spectrometer shall be capable of
               scanning from 35 to 500 amu  every 1 second or less, utilizing
               70  volts (nominal) electron  energy in the electron impact
               -ionization mode  and producing a  mass  spectrum which meets all
               the tuning acceptance criteria when 50  ng of
               decafluorotriphenylphosphine (DFTPP)  is injected through the
               gas chromatograph inlet.  To ensure sufficient  precision of
               mass  spectral data, the MS scan  rate  shall allow acquisition of
               at  least five spectra while .a sample  compound elutes  from the
               GC.   The GC/MS system shall  be in a room  whose  atmosphere is
               demonstrated to  be free of all potential  contaminants which
               will  interfere with the analysis.  The  instrument  shall  be
               vented outside the facility  or to a trapping  system which
               prevents the release  of contaminants  into  the instrument room.

      6.1.3    Data  System - A  computer system  shall be  interfaced to the mass
               spectrometer  that allows  the continuous acquisition and  storage
               on  machine  readable media of all  mass spectra obtained
               throughout  the duration of the chromatographic  program.   The
               computer shall have software that allows  searching any GC/MS
               data  file for ions of a specified mass and plotting such ion
               abundances versus time  or scan number.  This  type  of plot is
               defined  as  an Extracted Ion  Current Profile  (EICP).  Software
               shall also be available that allows integrating the abundance
               in  any EICP between specified time or scan number  limits.
               Also, for the non-target  compounds, software  shall be available
               that  allows comparing sample spectra  against reference library
               spectra.  The most recent release of  the National  Institute  of
               Standards and Technology  Mass Spectral Library  shall be  used as
               the reference library.

6.2   Magnetic Tape Storage Device  - The magnetic tape storage device shall
      be capable of recording  data  and suitable for long-term, off-line
      storage.

6.3   Glassware:  A set of glassware sufficient to meet  contract requirements
      shall be reserved for exclusive use in this contract.

                                     SV D-6                            10/92

-------
       6,3,1   Continuous liquid-liquid extractors - Equipped with Teflon or
               glass connecting joints and stopcocks requiring no lubrication
               (Hershberg-Wolf Extractor-Ace Glass Company, Vineland, NJ, P/N
               6841-10 or equivalent.)

       6.3.2   Drying column - 19 mm ID chromatographic column with coarse
               frit. (Substitution of a small pad of Pyrex pre-extracted glass
               wool for the frit will prevent cross contamination of sample
               extracts.)

       6,3.3   Concentrator tube - Kuderna-Danish,  10 mL,  graduated (Kontes,
               Vineland,  NJ, K-570050-1025 or equivalent).

       6.3.4   Evaporation flask - Kuderna-Danish,  500 mL (Kontes K-570001 -
               0500 or equivalent).   Attach to concentrator tube with springs.

       6.3.5   Snyder column - Kuderna-Danish,  Three-ball  macro (Kontes
               K-50300-0121 or equivalent).

       6.3.6   Snyder column - Kuderna-Danish,  Two-ball micro  (Kontes K-
               569001-0219 or equivalent).

       6,3.7   Vials -  Amber glass,  2 mL capacity with Teflon-lined screw-cap.

       6.3.8   Syringes -  0.2 mL,  0.5 mL,  and 5 mL volumes.

6.4    Gases - Helium, Nitrogen, ultra pure grade.

6.5    Gas-line tubing  - stainless steel, or copper tubing.

6.6    Silicon carbide boiling chips  - approximately 10/40 mesh.  Heat to
       400*C for 30 minutes or Soxhlet extract with methylene chloride.

6.7   Water bath - Heated, with concentric ring cover, capable of temperature
       control.  To prevent the release of solvent fumes into the laboratory,
       the bath shall be used in a hood.

6.8   Balance - Analytical, capable of accurately weighing ±0.0001 g.  The
      balances shall be calibrated with class S weights once per each 12-hour
      workshift.  The balances shall also be annually checked by a certified
       technician.

6.9   Nitrogen evaporation device equipped with a water bath that can be
      maintained at 30*C  to 35*C.  To prevent the release of solvent fumes
       into  the laboratory, the nitrogen evaporation device shall be used in a
      hood.  The N-Svap by Organomation Associates,  Inc. South Berlin, MA (or
      equivalent)  is suitable.

6.10  Micro-syringes - 10 uL and larger, 0.006 inch ID needle.

6.11  pH meter - Calibrate according to manufacturer's instructions.  pH
      meter shall be calibrated before each use.
                                     SV D-7                           10/92

-------
 7.    REAGENTS

 7.1   Reagent water  - Reagent water  is defined as water  in which no
      semivolatile target compound is observed at or above the CRQL  listed  in
      Exhibit C for  that compound and in which no non-target compound  is
      observed at or above 10 ug/L.

      7.1.1   Reagent  water  may be generated by  passing  tap  water  through a
              carbon filter  bed containing about 453 g  (1 Ib)  of activated
              carbon (Calgon Corp.,  Filtrasorb-300  or equivalent).

      7.1.2   Reagent  water  may be generated using  a water purification
              system (Millipore Super-Q or equivalent).

 7.2   Solvents - Acetone, methanol, methylene chloride.   Pesticide quality or
      equivalent.

 7.3   Sodium sulfate -  (ACS)  Granular, anhydrous (J.T.  Baker anhydrous
      powder, catalog #73898, or equivalent).  Purify by heating at 400*C for
      four hours in a shallow tray,  cool in a desiccator, and store in a
      glass bottle.

 7.4   Sulfuric acid solution (1:1)  -  slowly add 50 mL of concentrated H2S04
      (Sp. Gr. 1.84)  to 50 mL of reagent water.

 8.    STANDARDS

8.1   The Contractor shall provide  all standard solutions to  be used with
      this contract.   These standards may be used only after  they have been
      certified.   The Contractor shall be able to verify that the standards
      are certified.  Manufacturer's  certificates of analysis shall be
      retained by the Contractor and presented upon request.

8.2   Stock Standard Solutions

      Stock standard solutions may  be purchased or prepared using the
      following  procedure.

      8.2.1   Accurately weigh about 0.0100 g of pure material.  Dissolve the
              material in methylene chloride or another suitable solvent and
              dilute to volume in a 10 mL volumetric flask.  Larger volumes
              may be used at the convenience of the analyst.

      8.2.2   When compound purity is assayed to be 97 percent or greater,
              the weight may be used without correction to calculate the
              concentration of the stock solution.  If the compound purity is
              assayed to be less than 97 percent, the weight shall be
              corrected when calculating the concentration of the stock
              solution.

      8.2.3   Fresh stock standards shall be prepared once every twelve
              months, or sooner, if standards have degraded or concentrated.
              Stock standards shall be checked for signs of degradation or
                                     SV D-8                           10/92

-------
              concentration just prior to preparing secondary dilution and
              working standards from then.

8.3   Secondary Dilution Standards

      8.3,1   Using stock standards, prepare secondary dilution standards in
              methylene chloride that contain the compounds of interest
              either singly or mixed together.

      8.3.2   Fresh secondary dilution standards shall be prepared once every
              twelve months, or sooner, if standards have degraded or
              concentrated.  Secondary dilution standards shall be checked
              for signs of degradation or concentration just prior to
              preparing working standards from them.

8.4   Working Standards

      8.4.1   Tuning Solution - Decafluorotriphenylphosphine (DFTPP)

              Prepare a 50 ng/uL solution of DFTPP in methylene chloride.
              Ihe DFTPP solution shall be prepared fresh once every twelve
              months, or sooner, if the solution has degraded or
              concentrated.

      8.4.2   Initial and Continuing Calibration'Solutions

              8.4.2.1    Five  initial calibration standard solutions are
                         required for all target and surrogate compounds.
                         Standard concentrations of 5,  10,  20,  SO,  and 80
                         ng/uL are required for  five of the surrogates and
                         all but eight of the target compounds.   Nine
                         compounds:   2,4-dinitropheno1,  2,4,5-
                         trichlorophenol,  2-nitroaniline,  3-nitroaniline, 4-
                         nltroanillne,  4-nitrophenol, 4,6-dinitro-2-
                         methylphenol and pentachlorophenol,  2,4,6
                         tribromophenol (surrogate),  require calibration at
                         20,  50, 80,  100, and 120 ng/uL.

              8.4.2.2    To prepare a calibration standard solution,  add an
                         appropriate volume of secondary dilution standard to
                         methylene chloride in a volumetrie flask.   Dilute to
                         volume with methylene chloride.

              8.4.2.3    Add 10.0 uL of internal standard spiking solution
                         (Paragraph 8.6.1)  to 1.0 mL of each calibration
                         standard for a concentration of 20 ng/uL for each
                         internal standard.

              8.4.2.4    The 20 ng/uL initial calibration solution  (80 ng/uL
                         for the nine compounds  listed  in 8.4.2.1)  is the
                         continuing calibration  solution.
                                     SV D-9                            10/92

-------
              8.4.2.5    The five initial calibration solutions shall be
                         prepared fresh before use.  The continuing
                         calibration standard solution shall be prepared
                         weekly, or sooner, if the solution has degraded or
                         concentrated.

8.5   Surrogate Standard Spiking Solution

      8.5.1   Prepare a  surrogate standard spiking solution in methanol that
              contains,  2,4,6-tribromophenol (an acid surrogate compound), at
              a concentration of 120 ug/mL.  The other acid surrogate
              conpounds:  phenol-d5 and 2-fluorophenol, and the base/neutral
              conpounds:  nitrobenzene-d$, terphenyl-d]^, and 2-
              fluorobiphenyl are at a concentration of 40 ug/mL.

      8.5.2   The surrogate standard spiking solution shall be prepared every
              twelve months, or sooner, if the solution has degraded or
              concentrated.

8.6   Internal Standard Spiking Solution

      8.6.1   Prepare an internal standard spiking solution in methylene
              chloride or another suitable solvent that contains 1,4
              dichlorobenzene-04., naphthalene-dg,  acenaphthene-d^g.
              phenanthrene-d^o, chrysene-di2. and perylene-d^2 «c 2000 ng/uL.
              It may be necessary to use 5 to 10 percent benzene or toluene
              in this solution and a few minutes of ultrasonic mixing in
              order to dissolve all the constituents.

      8.6.2   The internal standard spiking solution shall be prepared every
              six months, or sooner, if the solution has degraded or
              concentrated.

8.7   Laboratory Control Sample (LCS) Spiking Solution

      8.7.1   Prepare a laboratory control sample spiking solution that
              contains each of the compounds at the concentrations listed
              below in methanol.
                                                    Concentration
              Compounds

              Phenol
              2-Chlorophenol
              4-Chloroaniline
              2,4,6-Trichlorophenol
              bis(2-Chloroethyl)ether
              N-Nitroso-di-n-propylamine
              Hexachloroethane
              Isophorone
              1,2,4-Trichlorobenzene
              Naphthalene
              2,4-Dinitrotoluene
              Diethylphthalate
40.0
40.0
40.0
40.0
20.0
20.0
20.0
20.0
20.
20.
20.
  .0
  .0
  .0
20.0
                                     SV D-10
             10/92

-------
              N-Nitrosodiphenylanine                      20.0
              Hexachlorobenzene                           20.0
              Benzo(a)pyrene                              20,0


      8.7.2   The laboratory control sample solution shall be prepared every
              twelve months, or sooner, if the solution has degraded or
              concentrated.

8.8   Storage of Standard Solutions

      8.8.1   Store the stock and secondary standard solutions at -10*C to
              -20*C in Teflon-lined screw-cap amber bottles.

      8.8.2   Store the working standard solutions at 4*C (±2*C) in Teflon-
              lined screw-cap amber bottles.

      8.8.3   Protect all standards from light.

      8.8.4   Samples, sample extracts, and standards shall be stored
              separately.
                                    SV D-ll                           10/92

-------
                      SECTION  III
INSTRUMENT QUALITY CONTROL PROCEDURES AND REQUIREMENTS
                         SV D-12                           10/92

-------
PART A - INSTRUMENT OPERATING CONDITIONS

Gas Chromatograph

      The following are the recommended gas chromatographic analytical
conditions.

Carrier Gas:                        Helium
Linear Velocity:                    25-30 en/sec
Injector Temperature:               250-300*C
Injector:                           Grob-type, splitless
Initial Temperature:                40'C
Initial Hold Time:                  4.0 ±0.1 min
Ramp Rate:                          10'C/min
Final Temperature:                  290*C
Final Hold Time:                    10 min or until all compounds of interest
                                    have eluted.

Optimize GC conditions for compound separation and sensitivity.  Once
optimized, the same GC conditions shall be used for the analysis of all
standards, samples, blanks, performance evaluation samples, and laboratory
control samples.

Mass Spectrometer

      The following are the required mass spectrometer conditions:

Transfer Line Temperature:          250-300*C
Source Temperature:                 According to manufacturer's
                                    specifications.
Electron Energy:                    70 volts (nominal)
lonization Mode:                    El
Mass Range:                         35 to 500 ami
Scan Time:                          At least 5 scans per peak, not to exceed
                                    1 second per scan.
                                     SV D-13                           10/92

-------
 PART  B  -  TUNING THE MASS  SPECTROMETER

 9.    SUMMARY

      It  is necessary  Co  establish  that a given GC/MS meets  the  standard mass
      spectral abundance  criteria prior to  initiating any on-going  data
      collection. This is accomplished through the analysis  of
      decafluorotriphenylphosphine  (DFTPP).

 10.   FREQUENCY

      Each GC/MS systea used shall be hardware tuned once per twelve  (12)
      hour time period of operation.  Also, whenever the Contractor takes
      corrective action which may char36 or affect the tuning criteria  for
      DFTPP (e.g., ion source cleaning or repair, coluan replacement, etc.),
      the tune shall be verified irrespective of the twelve-hour tuning
      requirement.  The twelve (12) hour time period for GC/MS systea tuning
      and standards calibration (initial or continuing calibration criteria)
      begins at the moment of injection of the DFTPP analysis that the
      Contractor submits as documentation of a compliant tune.  The tine
      period ends after twelve (12) hours have elapsed.   In order to meet
      tuning requirements, samples, PES,  LCS, blanks, and standards shall be
      injected within twelve hours of the DFTPP injection.

11.   PROCEDURE

11.1  Inject 50 ng of DFTPP into the GC/MS system.   All instrument conditions
      shall be identical to those listed in Section III,  Part A,  except that
      a different temperature program may be used.

11.2  DFTPP may be analyzed separately or as part of the calibration
      standard,

12.   fjCHHICAL ACCyyyAHCZ C&IT1SIA FOR DFTFP ANALYSIS

12.1  The GC/MS systea shall be tuned at the frequency described in Section
      10.

12.2  The abundance criteria listed in Table D-7 shall be met for a 50 ng
      injection of DFTPP.   The mass spectrum of DFTPP shall be acquir.ed in
      the following manner.   Three scans  (the peak apex scan and the scans
      immediately preceding and following the apex)  are  acquired and
      averaged.   Background subtraction is required,  and shall be
      accomplished using a single scan prior to the  elution of DFTPP.   Note:
      All subsequent standards samples,  including LCS,  PES,  and blanks,  shall
      use identical mass spectrometer instrument conditions.
                                     SV D-14                           10/92

-------
                                   Table D-7

               DFTPP KEY IONS AND  ION ABUNDANCE CRITERIA
   Mass          Ion Abundance Criteria

    51       30.0-80.0 percent of mass 198
    68       Less than 2.0 percent of mass 69
    69       Present
    70       Less than 2.0 percent of mass 69
   127       25.0 - 75.0 percent of mass 198
   197       Less than 1.0 percent of mass 198
   198       Base peak, 100 percent relative abundance (see note)
   199       5.0 - 9.0 percent of mass 198
   275       10.0 - 30.0 percent of mass 198
   365       Greater than 0.75 percent of mass 198
   441       Present but less than mass 443
   442       40.0 - 110.0 percent of mass 198
   443       15.0 - 24.0 percent of mass 442

Note:   All ion abundance SHALL be normalized to m/z 198,  the nominal base
       peak, even though the ion abundances of m/z 442 may be up to 110
       percent that of m/z 198.
12.3  The criteria above are based on adherence to the acquisition
      specifications identified in paragraph 12.2.  The criteria are based on
      performance characteristics of instruments currently utilized in
      routine support of Program activities.  These specifications, in
      conjunction with relative response factor criteria for 51 target
      compounds fsee Tabli D-8),  ar» designed iz control and monitor
      instrument performance associate^ ttith the requirements of this method.

13.   CORRECTIVE ACTIOH

13.1  If the DFTPP acceptance criteria are not met, retune the GC/MS system.
      It may be necessary to clean the ion source, clean quadrupoles, or take
      other actions to achieve the acceptance criteria.

13.2  DFTPP acceptance criteria SHALL be net before any standards,  samples
      (including LCS and PIS), or required blanks are analyzed.  Any samples
      or required blanks analyzed when tuning criteria have not been met will
      require reanalysis at no additional cost.

14.   [This paragraph has been Intentionally left blank and has been reserved
      for the use of SMO.]
                                     SV D-15         '                  10/92

-------
PART C - CALIBRATION OF THE GC/HS SYSTEM

15.   INITIAL CALIBRATION

IS. 1  Summary - Prior to the analysis of samples and required blanks and
      after tuning criteria have been met, each GC/HS system shall be
      initially calibrated at a minimum of five concentrations to determine
      instrument sensitivity and the linearity of GC/MS response for the
      semivolatile target and surrogate compounds.

15.2  Frequency

      15.2.1  Each GC/MS system shall be  initially calibrated upon award  of
              the contract, whenever the  Contractor  takes corrective action
              which may change or affect  the initial calibration criteria
              (e.g., ion source cleaning  or repair,  column replacement,
              etc.), or if the continuing calibration technical acceptance
              criteria have not been met.

      15.2.2.  If  time still remains in the 12 hour time period after meeting
              '-the technical acceptance criteria for the initial calibration,
              samples aay be analyzed.  It is not necessary to analyze a
              continuing calibration standard within this 12 hour time
              period, if the initial calibration standard that is the same
              concentration as the continuing calibration standard meets  the
              continuing calibration technical acceptance criteria.  Quantify
              all sample and quality control sample results and quality
              control criteria results, such as internal standard area
              response change and retention time shift, against the initial
              calibration standard that is the same concentration as the
              continuing calibration standard.

15.3  Procedure

      15.3.1  Set-up the GC/MS system per the requirements of Section III,
              Part A.

      15.3.2  All standard/spiking solutions and blanks shall be allowed  to
              warm to ambient temperature (approximately 1 hour) before
              preparation or analysis.

      15.3.3  Prepare five calibration standards containing all the
              semivolatile target and surrogate compounds at the
              concentrations described in Paragraph 8.4.2.

      15.3.4  Prepare an internal standard spiking solution using the
              procedure described in Section 3.6.

      15.3.5  Tune the GC/MS system to meet the technical acceptance criteria
              in Section 12 for DFTPP.

      15.3.6  Analyze each calibration standard by injecting 1.6 uL of
              standard.  If a compound saturates when the 80 ng/uL standard
              is injected (120 ng/uL for  the nine compounds listed in

                                     SV D-16                          10/92

-------
              Paragraph 8.4.2), and Che GO/MS system is calibrated to achieve
              a detection sensitivity of no less than the CRQL for each
              compound, the Contractor shall document it in the SDG
              Narrative, and attach a quantitation report and RIC.   In this
              instance, the Contractor shall calculate the results based  on  a
              four-point initial calibration for the specific compound that
              saturates.  Secondary ion quantitation is only allowed when
              there are sample interferences with the primary quantitation
              ion.  If secondary ion quantitation is used, calculate a
              relative response factor using the area response from  the most
              intense secondary ion which is free of interferences,  and
              document the reasons for the use of the secondary ion  in the
              SDG Narrative.

IS. 4  Calculations

      NOTE:   Unless  otherwise  stated the  area  response  is  that  of the primary
      quantitation ion.

      15.4.1  Calculate relative response factors (RRF) for each semivolatile
              target and surrogate compounds using Equation D.ll.  See Table
              0-9 to associate semtvolatile target and surrogates compounds
              with the proper internal standard.  See Table D-10 for primary
              quantitation ions to be used for each semivolatile target
              compound, surrogate,  and internal standard.

              EQ. D.ll        A*    Cls
                       RRF -  1— x jr—
                              Ais   °x

              Where:

              AX  - Area of the priaary quantitation ion response (SICP)  for
                    the compound to be measured.

                  - Area of the primary quantitation ion response (EICP)  for
                    the internal standard.

                  - Concentration of the internal standard.

              GX  — Concentration of the compound to be measured.

      IS.4.2  Equation D.12 is the general formula for standard deviation
              (SD) for a statistically small set of values.

              EQ. D.12
                      SD -
                             n
                             S
                                   n-1
                          M
              Where:

              SD - Standard deviation for set of values.
              x« — Value.
                                     SV D-17                           10/92

-------
         x - Mean value.

         n - Number of values.

15.4.3   Calculate the percent relative standard deviation (%RSD) of RRF
         values for each semivolatile target and surrogate compound over
         the initial calibration range using Equation D.13 in
         conjunction with Equation D.12.

         EQ.  D.13          SD&tr
                   %RSD -  —37  x 100
                             x ,

         Where:

         %RSD - Percent relative  standard deviation.

         SDgBF - Standard deviation of initial calibration response
                factors (per compound).

         Froa EQ.  D.12

         X£ - RRF — Relative response  factors front  initial calibration
                    standard (per compound).
        x - RRF - Mean value of  initial  calibration  response  factors
                  (per compound) .

15.4.4  Equation D.14 is the general  formula  for  the mean  of  a  set of
        values .
                              n
        EQ. D.14        x -
                                n

        x^ •• Value.


        x - Mean value.

        n - Number of values.

15.4.5  Calculate the mean of the relative retention times  (RRT)  for
        each semivolatile target and surrogate compound over  the
        initial calibration range using Equation D.14 and Equation
        D.15.

                  EQ. D.15                 RTC
                                   RRT -  -
        RTC - Retention time for the semivolatile target and surrogate
               compound.

                               SV D-18                           10/92

-------
               RT£S- Retention time for the internal standard.
                   Fron EQ .  D . 14 :

                  - RRTi - Relative retention tines for the semivolatile
                           target or surrogate compound for each initial
                           calibration standard.
               x - RRT - Mean relative retention tine.

      IS.4.6   Calculate the area response (Y)  mean for each internal standard
               compound over the initial calibration range using Equation
               D.14.

               Where:

               X£ - Y  - Area responses of the primary quantitation ion (EICP)
                        for the  internal standard for each initial calibration
                        standard.
              x — Y — Area response mean.

      15.4.7  Calculate  the mean of the absolute retention  times  (If)  for
              each internal standard over the  initial calibration range  using
              Equation D.14.

              Where:

              Jt£ - RT -  Retention time for the internal standard  for each
                         initial calibration standard.
              x - RT - Mean retention  time.

              n - Number of values.

IS.5  Technical Acceptance Criteria For Initial Calibration

      15.5.1  All initial calibration  standards shall be analyzed at the
              concentration levels described in paragraph 8.4.2 and at the
              frequency described in Section 15.2 on a GC/MS system meeting
              the DFTPP technical acceptance criteria.

      15.5.2  The relative response factor (RRF) at each calibration
              concentration for each semivolatile target and surrogate
              compound shall be greater than or equal to the compound's
              minimum acceptable relative response factor listed in Table D-
              8.

      15.5.3  The %RSD over the initial calibration range for relative
              response factor for each semivolatile and surrogate compound


                                     SV D-19                           10/92

-------
               that has a  required %RSD shall be less than or equal  to  the
               %RSD listed in Table D-8.

      IS. 5. 4   Up  to  four  compounds may fail the criteria listed  in  paragraph
               15.5.2 and  15.5.3 and still meet the minimum RRF and  %RSD
               requirements.  However, these four compounds shall have  a
               minimum ERF greater than 0.010 and %RSD less than or  equal  to
               40.0%.

      15.5.5   fhe relative retention  time (8RT) for each of the semi volatile
               target and  surrogates compounds at each calibration level shall
               be  within ±0.06  relative retention time units of the  mean
               relative retention tine (RRT) for each compound.

      15.5.6   The area response (Y) for each internal standard compound in
               each calibration standard shall be within the inclusive  range
               of  -50 percent to +100  percent of the mean area response (Y)  of
               the internal standard in all of the calibration standards .

      15.5.7   The retention tine (RT) shift for each of the internal
              'standards at each calibration level shall be within ±0. 33   _
               minutes (20.0 seconds)  compared to the mean retention time (RT)
               over the initial calibration range for each internal  standard.

15.6  Corrective Action

      15.6.1   If  the technical acceptance criteria for initial calibration
               are not met,  inspect the system for problems.  It may be
               necessary to clean the  ion source, change the column, or take
               other  corrective actions to achieve the acceptance criteria.

      15.6.2   Initial calibration technical acceptance criteria SHALL  be met
               before any  samples (including the LCS and FES) or required
               blanks  are  analyzed.  Any samples or required blanks  analyzed
               when initial calibration criteria have not been met will
               require reanalysis at no additional cost.

16.
16 . 1  Summary
      Prior to the analysis of samples and required blanks and after tuning
      criteria and initial calibration criteria have been met, each GC/MS
      system shall be routinely checked by analyzing a continuing calibration
      standard to ensure that the instrument continues to meet the instrument
      sensitivity and linearity requirements of the method.  The continuing
      calibration standard contains all the semivolatile target compounds ,
      surrogates, and internal standards.
16.2  Frequency
      16.2.1  Each GC/MS used for analysis shall be calibrated once every
              twelve  (12) hour time period of operation.  The 12 -hour time
              period  begins with the  injection of DFTPP.

                                     SV D-20                          10/92

-------
      16.2.2  If time still remains in the 12 hour time period after meeting
              the technical acceptance criteria for the initial calibration,
              samples may be analyzed.  It is not necessary to analyze a
              continuing calibration standard within this 12 hour time
              period, if the initial calibration standard that is the same
              concentration as the continuing calibration standard meets the
              continuing calibration technical acceptance criteria.  Quantify
              all sample results against the 20 ng/uL (80 ng/uL for the nine
              compounds listed in Section 8.4.2.1) calibration standard.

16.3  Procedure

      16.3.1  Set up GC/MS system per the requirements of Section III, Part
              A.

      16.3.2  Prepare a continuing calibration standard solution containing
              all the semivolatile target and surrogate compounds using the
              procedure listed in Section 8.4.2.

      16.3.3  All standard/spiking solutions and blanks shall be allowed to
              warm to ambient temperature (approximately 1 hour) before
              preparation or analysis.

      16.3.4  Tune the GC/MS system to meet the DFTPP technical acceptance
              criteria in Section 12.

      16.3.5  Start the analysis of the continuing calibration standard by
              injecting 1.0 uL of standard.

16.4  Calculations

      16.4.1  Calculate a relative response factor (RRF) for each
              semivolatile target and surrogate compound using Equation D.ll.

      16.4.2  Calculate the percent difference between the mean relative
              response factor from the most recent initial calibration and
              the continuing calibration relative response factor for each
              semivolatile target and surrogate compound using Equation D.17.
                                                - RRFC
              EQ D.17  % Difference RUT -	   x 100


              Where:
                   - Average relative response factor from the most
                     recent initial calibration.

              RRFC - Relative response factor from continuing calibration
                     standard.
                                     SV D-21                          10/92

-------
16.5  Technical Acceptance Criteria For Continuing Calibration

      16.5.1   The continuing calibration standard  shall  be  analyzed at the 20
               ng/uL (80 ng/uL for the  nine  compounds  listed in  8.4.2.1)
               concentration level at  the frequency described in Section 16.2
               on  a GC/MS system meeting the DFTPP  tuning and the initial
               calibration technical acceptance  criteria.

      16.5.2   The relative response factor  for  each semivolatile target  and
               surrogate compound shall be greater  than or equal to  the
               compound's minimum acceptable relative  response factor listed
               in  Table  D-8.

      16.5.3   The relative  response factor  percent difference for each
               semivolatile  and surrogate compound  that has  a percent
               difference criteria shall be  within  the inclusive range listed
               in  Table  D-8.

      16.5.4   Up  to  four compounds may fail the requirements listed in
               paragraph 16.5.2 and 16.5.3 and still meet the minimum response
              'factor and percent  difference criteria.  However,  these
               compounds shall  have a minimum response  factor greater than  or
               equal  to  0.010 and  the percent difference  shall be within  the
               inclusive range  of  ±40%.

16.6  Corrective Action

      16.6.1   If  the continuing calibration technical  acceptance criteria  are
              not met,  recalibrate the GC/MS instrument  according to  Section
               15.  It may be necessary to clean the ion  source,  change the
               column or take other corrective actions  to  achieve the
               acceptance criteria.

      16.6.2   Continuing calibration technical acceptance criteria  SHALL be
               met before any samples (including the LCS  and PES)  or required
               blanks are analyzed.  Any samples or required blanks  analyzed
               vhen continuing  calibration criteria have  not been met will
               require reanalysis  at no additional  cost.
                                     SV D-22                           10/92

-------
                                SECTION IV
SAMPLE PREPARATION,  ANALYSIS,  AND COMPOUND IDENTIFICATION AND QUANTITATION
                                   SV D-23                           10/92

-------
17.   SUMMARY
      This method is designed for analysis of samples that contain low
      concentrations of the semivolatile compounds listed in Exhibit C.  The
      majority of the samples are expected to come froa drinking water
      sources and well/ground water around Superfund sites.  If, upon
      inspection of a sample , the Contractor suspects that the sample is not
      amenable to this method, contact SMO for instructions.
18.   PROCEDURE

18 . 1  Extraction
      Continuous liquid- liquid extraction is required for the extraction of
      the samples.

      18.1.1  Add aethylene chloride  to  the bottom of the extractor  and fill
              it  to a depth of at  least  1 inch above the bottom  side arm.

      18.1.2  Using a 1 liter graduated  cylinder, measure out a  1.0  liter
              "sample aliquot.  Transfer  the 1 liter sample aliquot to  the
              continuous extractor.   Pipet 1.0 nL of surrogate standard
              spiking solution into the  sample and mix well.  Check  the pH of
              the sample with a pH meter and adjust the pH to 2.0 with 1:1
      18.1.3  Add sufficient methylene chloride to the distilling flask  to
              ensure proper solvent cycling during operation.  Extract for  18
              hours.  Allow to cool, then detach the distilling flask and
              label.

      18.1.4  If the sample was received in a 1 liter, container, rinse the
              empty container with 60 nL of methylene chloride after taking
              the sample aliquot.  Add the rinsate to the continuous
              extractor.

18.2  Concentrating the Extracts

      18.2.1  Assemble a Kuderna- Danish (K-D) concentrator by attaching  a 10
              mL concentrator tube to a 500 mL evaporative flask.  Other
              concentration devices or techniques may be used in place of the
              K-D, if equivalency is demonstrated for all the semivolatile
              target compounds listed in Exhibit C.

      18.2.2  Transfer the extract by pouring the extract through a drying
              column containing about 10 cm of anhydrous granular sodium
              sulfate, and collect the extract in a K-D concentrator.  Rinse
              the distilling flask and column with 20 to 30 mL of methylene
              chloride to complete the quantitative transfer.

      18.2.3  Add one or two clean boiling chips and attach a three -ball
              Snyder column to the evaporative flask.  Pre-wet the Snyder
              column by adding about 1 mL methylene chloride to the top  of
              the column.  Place the K-D apparatus on a hot water bath (60°C


                                     SV D-24                           10/92

-------
         to 80*C)  so  that  the concentrator tube is partially  immersed in
         the hot water, and  the entire lower rounded surface  of  the
         flask is  bathed with hot vapor.  Adjust the vertical position
         of the apparatus  and the water temperature as required  to
         complete  the concentration  in 10 to 15 minutes.  At  the proper
         rate of distillation, the balls of the column will actively
         chatter but  the chambers will not flood with condensed  solvent.
         When the  apparent volume of liquid reaches 1 mL, remove the  K-D
         apparatus from the water bath and allow it to drain  and cool
         for at least 10 minutes.  Remove the Snyder column and rinse
         the flask and its lower joint into the concentrator  tube with 1
         to 2 mL of methylene chloride.  A 5 mL syringe is recommended
         for this  operation.

18.2.4   Two different types of concentration techniques are  permitted
         to obtain the final 1.0 mL  volume:  micro Snyder column and
         nitrogen  evaporation techniques.

         18.2.4.1   Micro Snyder Column Technique

                   Add another one or two clean boiling chips to the
                   concentrator tube and attach a two-ball micro Snyder
                   column. Pre-wet the Snyder column by adding about
                   0.5 mL of methylene chloride to the top of the
                   column.  Place the K-D apparatus in a hot water bath
                   (60*C to 80*C) so that the concentrator tube is
                   partially immersed In the hot water.   Adjust the
                   vertical position of the apparatus and the water
                   temperature as required to complete the
                   concentration in 5 to 10 minutes.   At the proper
                   rate of distillation the balls of the column will
                   actively chatter but the chambers will not flood
                   with condensed solvent.  When the apparent volume of
                   liquid reaches about 0.5 mL, remove the K-D
                   apparatus from the water bath and allow it to drain
                   for at least 10 minutes while cooling.  Do not let
                   the extract go to dryness.   Remove the Snyder column
                   and rinse its flask and its lower Joint into the
                   concentrator tube with 0.2 mL of methylene chloride.
                   Adjust the final volume to 1.0 mL with methylene
                   chloride.  Transfer the extract to a Teflon-sealed
                   screw-cap bottle, label the bottle and store at 4*C
                   (±2"C).

         18.2.4.2   Nitrogen Evaporation Technique (taken from ASTM
                   Method D3086)

                   Place the concentrator tube with an open micro
                   Snyder column attached in a warm water bath (30*C to
                   35*C) and evaporate the solvent volume to just below
                   1 mL by blowing a gentle stream of clean,  dry
                   nitrogen (filtered through a column of activated
                   carbon) above the extract.   Caution:  Gas lines from
                   the gas source to the evaporation apparatus shall be


                               SV D-25                           10/92

-------
                          stainless  steel,  copper,  or Teflon tubing.   The
                          Internal wall  of  the  concentrator tube  shall be
                          rinsed down several times with methylene chloride
                          during the operation  and  the  final volume brought to
                          1.0  nL with methylene chloride.   During evaporation,
                          the  tube solvent  level shall  be kept below  the  water
                          level  of the bath.  The extract shall never be
                          allowed to become dry.  Transfer  the extract to a
                          Teflon-sealed  screw-cap bottle, label the bottle and
                          store  at 4'C <±2'C).

18.3  Instrumental Analysis

      18.3.1   Set up  the GC/MS  system per  the  requirements of Section III,
               Part A.   Before samples or required  blanks can be  analyzed, the
               Instrument shall  meet the DFTPP, Initial calibration,  and
               continuing calibration technical acceptance  criteria.   All
               samples,  required blanks,  extracts,  and  standard/spiking
               solutions shall be allowed to warm to ambient temperature
               (approximately  1  hour)  before preparation/analysis.  All sample
              ^extracts  and required blanks shall be analyzed under the same
               instrumental conditions as the calibration standards,

      18.3.2   Add 10.0  uL of  the Internal  standard spiking solution  (2000
               ng/uL)  to the 1.0 mL  extract.  For sample dilutions, add an
               appropriate amount of the  internal standard  spiking  solution to
               maintain  a 20 ng/uL concentration of the internal  standards in
               the  diluted extract.

      18.3.3   Inject  1.0 uL of  sample extract  into the GC/MS, and  start  data
               acquisition.

      18.3.4   When all  semivolatile target compounds have  eluted from  the GC,
               terminate the MS  data acquisition and store  data files on  the
               data system storage device.  Use appropriate  data  output
               software  to display full range mass  spectra  and IICFs.

19.   DILOTIOHS

19.1  When a sample extract is analyzed  that has  a  semivolatile  target
      compound concentration greater than the upper limit of the  initial
      calibration range or in which ions from a compound saturate the
      detector (excluding the compound peaks in the solvent front), the
      extract shall be diluted and reanalyzed.  Secondary  ion quantItation is
      only allowed- when there are sample interferences  with the primary
      quantitation ion,  not when saturation occurs.  If secondary ion
      quantltatlon is  used, calculate a  relative  response factor  using the
      area response (EICF) from the most intense  secondary  ion which is free
      of sample interferences, and document the reasons for the use of the
      secondary ion in the SDG Narrative.
                                     SV D-26                           10/92

-------
19,2  Dilute the sample using the following procedure:

      19.2.1  Calculate  the sample  dilution necessary to keep  the
              seniivolatile target compounds that  required  dilution within the
              upper half of the  initial calibration  range  and  so that  no
              compound has ions  which  saturate  the detector  (excluding the
              compound peaks  in  the solvent front).   Note:   Do not dilute
              sample solely to get  2,4,6  tribromophenol value  within the
              initial calibration range.

      19.2,2  Dilute the sample  extract with methylene chloride in a
              volumetric flask,

      19.2.3  Analyze the sample dilution per Section 18.3,  including  the
              addition of internal  standards to maintain a 20  ng/uL
              concentration of the  internal standards (see 18.3.2).

20.   IDENTIFICATION OF TARGET COMPOUNDS

20.1  The compounds listed in the Target Compound List (TCL), Exhibit C,
      shall be", identified by  an analyst competent in the interpretation of
      mass spectra by comparison of the sample mass spectrum to the mass
      spectrum of a standard  of the suspected  compound.   Two  criteria shall
      be satisfied to verify  the  identifications:   (1) elution of the sample
      compound at the same GC relative  retention time as the  standard
      compound,  and (2)  correspondence  of the  sample  compound and standard
      compound mass spectra.

20,2  For establishing correspondence of the GC relative retention time
      (RRT),  the sample compound RRT shall be  within  ±0.06  RRT units of the
      RRT of the standard compound.  For reference,  the standard shall be run
      on the sane shift as the sample.   If coelution  of interfering compounds
      prohibits accurate assignment of  the sample compound RRT from the
      extracted ion current profile for the primary ion,  the  RRT shall be
      assigned by using the total ion chromatogram.

20.3  For comparison of standard and sample compound  mass spectra,  mass
      spectra obtained on the Contractor's GC/MS are  required.  These standard
      spectra may be used for identification purposes, only if the
      Contractor's GC/MS meets the DFTPP daily tuning technical acceptance
      criteria.   These standard spectra may be obtained from  the analysis
      used to obtain reference relative retention times.

20.4  The guidelines for qualitative verification by  comparison of mass
      spectra are as follows:

      20.4.1  All  ions present in the  standard mass  spectra at a relative
              intensity  greater  than 25 percent (most abundant ion in  the
              spectrum equals 100 percent) shall be  present  in the sample
              spectrum.

      20.4,2  The  relative intensities of the major  ions specified in  Section
              20.4.1 shall agree within +20 percent  between the standard and
              sample spectra.  (Example:  For an ion  with an abundance  of 50


                                     SV D-27                            10/92

-------
               percent in the standard  spectra, the corresponding  sample ion
               abundance shall be between 30 and 70 percent.)

      20.4.3   Ions  greater than 25  percent in  the sample spectrum but  not
               present in the standard  spectrun shall be considered and
               accounted for by the  analyst making the comparison.  The
               verification process  should FAVOR FALSE POSITIVES.  All
               compounds meeting the identification criteria shall be reported
               with  their spectra.

      20.4.4   If a  compound cannot  be  verified by all of the criteria  in
               Sections 20.4.1 - 20.4.3,  but in the technical judgment  of the
               mass  spectral interpretation specialist, the identification is
               correct,  then the Contractor shall report that identification
               and proceed with quantitation.

21.   IDEHTiyiCATIOH OP NON-TARGET COMPOUNDS

21.1  A library search shall be executed for non-target compounds for the
      purpose of tentative identification.  The most recent release  of the
      National*. Institute of Standards and Technology Mass  Spectral Library
      shall be used as the reference library.

21.2  Up to 20 non-surrogate/non-internal standard organic  compounds  of
      greatest apparent concentration not listed in Exhibit C  for the
      senivolatiles  shall be tentatively identified via a  forward search of
      the National Institute of Standards and Technology Mass  Spectral
      Library.  (Compounds with a peak area response less  than 50 percent of
      the area response for the nearest internal standard  and  compounds which
      elute before the first semivolatile target compound  elutes are  not
      required to be searched In this fashion.)  Only after visual comparison
      of sample spectra with the nearest library searches will the mass
      spectral Interpretation specialist assign a tentative Identification.
      Computer generated library search shall not use normalization  routines
      if those routines would misrepresent the library or  unknown spectra
      when compared to each other.

21.3  Guidelines for making tentative identification

      21.3.1   Relative  intensities of major ions in the reference spectrum
               (ions greater  than 25 percent of the most abundant  ion)  should
               be present  in the sample spectrum.

      21.3.2   The relative Intensities of the major ions should agree within
               ±20 percent.   (Example: For an ion with an abundance of  50
               percent  in  the  standard spectra, the corresponding  sample  ion
               abundance should be between 30 and 70 percent.

      21.3.3   Molecular ions present in  reference spectrum should be present
               in sample spectrum.

      21.3.4   Ions present in  the sample spectrum but not in the  reference
               spectrum should be reviewed for possible background
               contamination or presence of coeluting compounds.


                                     SV 0-28                            10/92

-------
      21.3.5   Ions present  in  the reference  spectrum but not  in  the  sample
               spectrum should  be reviewed for possible  subtraction from the
               sample spectrum  because of background contamination or
               coeluting compounds.  Data system library reduction programs
               can sometimes create these discrepancies.

      21.3.6   If in the technical judgment of the mass  interpretation
               spectral specialist, no valid  tentative identification can be
               made, the compound should be reported as unknown.   The mass
               spectral specialist should give additional classification of
               the unknown compound, if possible (e.g., unknown phthalate,
               unknown hydrocarbon, unknown acid type, unknown chlorinated
               compound). If a  probable molecular weight can be distinguished,
               include it.

22.   CALCULATIONS

      NOTE:  Unless  otherwise stated,  the  area response  is  from the extracted
      ion current profile  (EICP)  of the primary quantitation ion.

22.1  Target Compounds

      22.1.1   Calculate target compound concentrations using Equation D.18.

               EQ. D.18                            (Ax)(Is)(Vt)(Df)
                         Concentration in ug/L —
                                                 (Als)(BRF)(V0)

              Where:

              AX  - Area response (EICP) for the compound to be measured.
                    The primary quantitation ions for the target compounds,
                    internal standards, and surrogates  are listed in
                    Table D-10.

              A£S - Area response (EICP) for the internal standard.   The
                    target compounds are listed with their associated
                    internal standard in Table D-9.

              13  - Amount of internal standard injected in nanograms (ng),

              RRF - The RRF from the most recent continuing calibration as
                    determined in Section IS.4.1.

              V0  - Volume of water extracted in nilliliters (mL) .

              Vj  - Volume of extract injected in microliters (uL) .

              Vt  - Volume of final extract in microliters (uL).

              Df  - Dilution Factor.  The dilution factor for analysis of
                   water  samples  for  semivolatiles by this method is  defined
                   as  follows:
                                    SV D-29                           10/92

-------
               uL most cone.  extract used to pake dilution + uL clean solvent
               uL most cone,  extract used to make dilution

               If no dilution is performed,  Df - 1.0.

      22.1.2   When target compounds are below contract required quantitation
               limits (CRQL),  but the spectra meet the identification
               criteria,  report the concentration with a "J."  For example,  if
               the CRQL is 5  ug/L and a concentration of 3.0 ug/L is
               calculated,  report as "3.0 J."  Report: ALL ?-*^gple concentration
               data as UNCORRECTED for blanks.

22.2  Non-Target Compounds

      Equation 0.18 is used for calculating  the concentrations of the non-
      target compounds.  Total area counts (or peak heights) from the
      reconstructed ion chromatograms  (RIC)  are to be used for both the non-
      target compound to be measured  (Ajj) and the internal standard (A^s).
      Associate the nearest internal standard free of interferences with  the
      non-target compound to be measured.  A relative response factor (RRF)
    •  of one (1) is to be assumed.  The value from this quantitation shall be
     'qualified as estimated ("J").  This estimated concentration shall be
      calculated for all tentatively identified compounds as well as those
      identified as unknowns.

22.3  Surrogates

      Calculate the surrogate percent recovery using Equation D.19.

                                               Qd
      EQ. D.19   Surrogate Percent Recovery -  s—  x  100
                                               xa

      Where:

      Qd — Quantity determined by analysis.

      Qa - Quantity added to sample/blank.

22.4  Internal Standards

      22.4.1  Calculate the percent area response change  (% ARC) for the
              sample/blank analysis compared to the most  recent continuing
              calibration standard analysis  for each of the  internal standard
              compounds using  Equation D.20.

                                 As - AC
             EQ. D.20  % ARC -  —A      x 100
                                    *c

              Where:

              % ARC —  Percent  area response  change.
                                     SV D-30                           10/92

-------
               As    - Area response of Che internal standard in
                       the sample/blank analysis.

               A<;    — Area response of the Internal standard in the most
                       recent continuing calibration standard.

       22.4.2   Calculate the retention tine shift (RTS) between the
               sample/blank analysis and the most recent continuing
               calibration standard analysis for each of the internal
               standards using Equation D.21.

               EQ. D.21  RTS - RTS - RTC

               Where:

               RTS - Retention time shift.

               RT3 - Retention time of the  internal standard in a
                     sample/blank.

               "RTC - Retention time of the  internal standard in the
                     most recent continuing calibration standard.

23.   TECHNICAL ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA, ?OR SAlgLg MfALTSIg

23.1  The sample  shall be analyzed on a GC/MS system meeting the DFTPP,
      initial  calibration, and continuing calibration technical acceptance
      criteria.

23.2  The sample  shall be extracted and analyzed within the contract holding
      times.

23.3  The sample  shall have an associated method blank meeting the blank
      technical acceptance criteria,  me sample shall have a Laboratory
      Control Sample associated with it meeting the LCS technical acceptance
      criteria.  The sample shall  also have a PES associated with it meeting
      the FES technical acceptance criteria.

23,4  The percent recovery for each of the surrogates in the sample shall be
      within the acceptance windows listed in Table D-ll.

23.5  The difference of the area response change for each of the internal
      standards for the sample shall be within the inclusive range of -50
      percent and +100 percent of  the response of the internal standards in
      the most recent continuing calibration analysis.

23.6  The retention tiae shift for each of the Internal standards shall be
      within ±0.33 minutes (20.0 seconds) between the sample and the most
      recent continuing calibration standard analysis.

23,7  Excluding those ions in the  solvent front, no ion nay saturate the
      detector.  No target compound concentration may exceed the upper limit
                                     SV D-31                           10/92

-------
      of the Initial calibration range unless a more dilute aliquot of the
      sample extract is also analyzed according to the procedures in Section
      19,

                         Table D-ll

      CONTRACT REQUIRED SURROGATE SPIKE RECOVERY LIMITS
        Surrogate Compound      % Recovery

         Nitrobenzene-ds          40-112
         2-Fluorobipheny1         42-110
         Terpheny1-d]^            24-140
         Fhenol-d5                17-113
         2-Fluoropheno1           16-110
         2,4,6-Tribromophenol     18-126
24.   CORRECTIVE ACTIOH

24.1  If the saaple technical acceptance criteria for the surrogates and
      internal standards are not set,  check calculations, surrogate and
      internal standard solutions,  and instrument performance.   It stay be
      necessary to recalibrate the  instrument or take other corrective action
      procedures to meet the surrogate and internal standard technical
      acceptance criteria.

24.2  If the Contractor needs to analyze more than one (1) sample dilution
      other than the original analysis to have all the target compounds
      within the initial calibration range and to have no ions saturating the
      detector (excluding the peaks in the solvent front), contact SMO.  SMO
      will contact the Region for instructions.

24.3  Sample analysis technical acceptance criteria SHALL be met before data
      are reported.  Samples contaminated from laboratory sources, or
      associated with a contaminated method blank or any samples analyzed not
      meeting the technical acceptance criteria will require reextraction
      and/or reanalysis at no additional cost.

24.4  Sample reruns performed as a  result of suspected matrix interferences
      beyond the scope of the method will be reviewed on a case-by-case basis
      for payment purposes by SMO.

25.   (This paragraph has been intentionally left blank and has been reserved
      for the use of SMO.]
                                     SV D-32                           10/92

-------
                    SECTION V
SAMPLE QUALITY CONTROL PROCEDURES AND REQUIREMENTS
                       SV D-33                          10/92

-------
 26.    BLANK ANALYSIS

 26.1   Summary  - A method blank  Is 1.0 liter of reagent water carried  through
       the entire analytical  scheme.

 26.2   Frequency

       26.2,1   A method blank shall  be extracted at least once:

               o  every 20 samples, AND

               o  whenever samples are extracted.

       26.2,2   Each  method blank shall be analyzed on each GC/MS  used  to
               analyze  the samples prepared with the method blank.

 26.3   Procedure for Method Blank Preparation

       26.3.1   Prepare  the method blank at the frequency  listed in Section
               26.2.  Measure out 1.0  liter of reagent water for  each  method
              .blank aliquot.  Extract and concentrate the  method blank at  the
              'same  time as the  samples associated with the blank according to
               Sections 18.1.1 and 18.2.

      26,3.2  Analyze  the method blank and calculate  the results according to
               Sections 18-22.

26.4  Technical Acceptance Criteria For Blank Analysis

      26.4.1  All blanks shall  be analyzed at the frequency described in
              Section  26.2 on a GC/MS system meeting  the DFTPP,  initial
              calibration, and  continuing calibration technical  acceptance
              criteria.

      26.4.2  The percent recovery for each of the  surrogates in the blank
              shall be within the acceptance windows  listed in Table  D-ll.

      26.4.3  The area response change for each of  the internal  standards  for
              the blank shall be within  the inclusive range of -50 percent
              and 4-100 percent  compared  to the internal standards in  the most
              recent continuing calibration analysis.

      26.4.4  The retention  time shift for each of  the internal  standards
              shall be within ±0.33 minutes (20.0 seconds) between the blank
              and the most recent continuing calibration analysis.

      26.4,5  The concentration of the target compounds in the blanks shall
              be less  than or equal to the CRQL for each target  compound.
              The concentration of non-target compounds in the blanks shall
              not exceed 10 ug/L.

26,5  Corrective Action

      26.5.1  If a Contractor's blanks do  not meet  the technical acceptance
              criteria, the Contractor shall consider the  analytical  system


                                    SV D-34                           10/92

-------
               to be out of control.   It  Is  the Contractor's  responsibility to
               ensure  that method  interferences caused by  contaminants  in
               solvents, reagents, glassware, and sample storage  and
               processing hardware that lead to discrete artifacts  and/or
               elevated baselines  in gas  chromatograms be  eliminated.   If
               contamination  is a  problem, the source of the  contamination
               shall be investigated and  appropriate corrective measures  SHALL
               be taken and documented before further sample  analysis
               proceeds.

      26,5.2   Any method blank that fails to meet the technical  acceptance
               criteria shall be reextracted and reanalyzed at no additional
               cost.   Further, all samples processed with  a method  blank  that
               is out  of control (i.e., contaminated) will require
               reextraction and reanalysis at no additional cost.

27.   LABORATORY CONTROL SAMPLES (LCS^

27.1  Summary

     ' The LCS is an internal laboratory quality control  sample designed to
      assess (on an SDG-by-SDG basis)  the capability of  the  contractor to
      perform the analytical method listed in  this  Exhibit,

27.2  Frequency

      The LCS shall be prepared,  extracted,  analyzed, and  reported once per
      Sample Delivery Group.   The  LCS  shall  be  extracted and analyzed
      concurrently with the samples in the SDG  using the same instrumentation
      as the samples in the SDG.

27.3  Procedure

      27.3.1  Measure  a 1.0  liter aliquot of reagent water in a 1  liter
              graduated cylinder  and  transfer the water to a continuous
              extractor.  Pipet 1.0 mL of the LCS spiking solution  (Paragraph
              8.7.1) and 1.0 mL of the surrogate standard spiking  solution
              into the water and mix well.  Extract and concentrate the
              sample according to Sections  18.1 and 18.2.

      27.3.2  Analyze  the LCS per Sections  18-21.

27.4  Calculations

      27.4.1  Calculate individual compound recoveries of the LCS  using
              Equation D.19, substituting LCS percent recovery for surrogate
              percent  recovery.

      27.4.2  See Section 22 for  equations  necessary for  other calculations.
                                     SV D-35                           10/92

-------
27.5  Technical Acceptance Cricecia For Laboratory Control Sample Analysis

      27.5.1  The LCS shall be analyzed at the frequency described in Section
              27.2 on a GC/MS system meeting the DFTPP, initial calibration,
              and continuing calibration technical acceptance criteria.

      27.5.2  The LCS shall be prepared as described In Paragraph 27.3.

      27.5.3  The LCS shall be prepared and analyzed with a method blank that
              set the blank technical acceptance criteria.

      27.5.4  The percent recovery for each of the surrogates in the LCS
              shall be within the acceptance windows listed in Table D-ll.

      27.5.6  The area response change for each internal standard for the LCS
              shall be within the inclusive range of -50 percent and +100
              percent compared to the internal standard in the most recent
              continuing calibration analysis.

      27.5.7  The retention time shift for each of the internal standards
              within ±0.33 minutes (20.0 seconds) between the LCS and the
              continuing calibration standard analysis.

      27.5.8  The percent recovery for each of the compounds in the LCS shall
              be within the recovery limits listed in Table D-12.

                                    Table D-12

                 LABORATORY CONTROL SAMPLE PERCENT RECOVERY LIMITS
                COMPOUND                           % RECOVERY
                Phenol                             44 - 120
                2-Chlorophenol                     58 - 110
                4-Chloroaniline                    35 - 98
                2,4,6-Trlchlorophenol              65 - 110
                bls(2-Chloroethyl)ether            64 - 110
                N-Nltroso-di-n-propylamlne         34 - 102
                Hexachloroethane                   32 - 77
                Isophorone                         49 - 110
                1,2,4-Trichlorobenzene             44-96
                Naphthalene                        56 - 160
                2,4-Dlnitrotoluene                 61 - 140
                Diethylphthalate                   76 - 104
                N-Nitrosodiphenylamine             35 - 120
                Hexachlorobenzene                  30 - 95
                Benzo(a)pyrene                     55 - 92

     NOTE:  The recovery limits for any of the compounds  in the LCS may be
     expanded at any time during the period of performance if SMO determines
     that the limits are too restrictive.
                                    SV D-36                           10/92

-------
 27.6  Corrective Action

      27.6.1   If the LCS technical acceptance criteria for the surrogates and
               internal standards are not net, check calculations,  surrogate
               and internal standard solutions,  and instrument performance.
               It may be necessary to recalibrate the instrument or take other
               corrective action procedures to meet the surrogate and internal
               standard criteria.

      27.6.2   The laboratory may not submit data from an SDG until the LCS
               technical acceptance criteria are met.   LCS contamination from
               laboratory sources or any LCS not meeting the criteria will
               require reanalysis and reextraction of the LCS at no additional
               cost.

      27.6.3   Further,  all samples in the SDG prepared and analyzed with an
               LCS that does not meet the LCS technical acceptance  criteria
               will also require reanalysis at no additional cost.   Any LCS
               failing to meet these technical acceptance criteria  shall be
               reanalyzed and reextracted at no  additional cost.

 28.   PERFORMANCE EVALUATION SAMPLE  (PES)

 28.1  Summary

      The FES  is an external laboratory quality control sample prepared and
      designed to assess  (on an SDG-by-SDG basis) the capability of the
      Contractor to perform the analytical method listed in this Exhibit.

 28.2  Frequency

      The Contractor shall extract, analyze, and report the results of the PE
      sample once per SDG, if available.  The FES shall be extracted and
      analyzed concurrently with the samples in the SDG using the same
      instrumentation as the samples in the SDG.

 28.3  Procedure

      28.3.1   The  FES will be  received either as  an ampulated extract or  as  a
               full volume sample.   If received  as an ampulated extract,  the
               Contractor will  receive instructions  concerning the  dilution
               procedure  to bring  the extract  to  full volume prior  to
               preparation and  analysis of the FES.

      28.3.2   Extract and concentrate the PES using the procedure  described
               in Section 18.   Add 1.0 mL of surrogate  solution to  1  liter of
               reagent water spiked with  the FES  solution.  Analyze  the  PES as
               described  in Sections 18 to 21.

28.4  Calculations

      See Section 22 for equations necessary for calculations.
                                     SV D-37                           10/92

-------
28.5  Technical Acceptance Criteria for the FES

      28.5,1  The PES shall be analyzed on a GC/HS system meeting  the  DFTPP
              tuning, initial calibration, and continuing calibration
              technical acceptance criteria at the frequency described in
              Section 28.2.

      28.5.2  The PES shall be extracted and concentrated according  to
              Section 28.3.

      28.5.3  The PES shall be prepared and analyzed with a method blank  that
              met the blank technical acceptance criteria.

      28.5.4  The percent recovery for each of the surrogates in the PES
              shall be within the acceptance windows listed in Table D-ll.

      28.5.5  The area response change between the PES and the most recent
              continuing calibration standard  analysis for each of the
              internal standards shall be within the inclusive range of -SO
              percent and +100 percent.

      28.5.6  The retention time shift between the PES and the most recent
              continuing calibration standard  analysis for each of the
              internal standards shall be within +0.33 minutes (20.0
              seconds).

28.6  Corrective Action

      28.6.1  If the PES technical acceptance  criteria for the internal
              standards and the surrogate are  not met, check calculations,
              standard solutions and instrument performance.  It may be
              necessary to recalibrate the instrument or take* other
              corrective action procedures to  meet the internal standard
              criteria.  Any PES failing to meet these technical acceptance
              criteria shall be reextracted and reanalyzed at no additional
              cost.  If insufficient PES spiking extract remains or if
              insufficient full volume PES remains, document this  in the  SDG
              Narrative by stating that the PES could not be reextracted  and
              reanalyzed because insufficient  volume remained.

      28.6.2  In addition to complying with the PES technical acceptance
              criteria, the Contractor will be responsible for correctly
              identifying and quantitating the compounds Included  in the  PES.
              SMO will notify the Contractor of unacceptable performance.

              Note:  Unacceptable performance  for identification and
              quantitation of compounds is defined as a score less than 75
              percent.

      28.6.3  The PES technical acceptance criteria SHALL be met before
              sample data are reported.  Also, the Contractor shall
              demonstrate acceptable performance for compound identification
              and quantitation.  If the Contractor fails to meet the PES
              technical acceptance criteria or achieves a score of less than


                                     SV D-38                            10/92

-------
75 percent, SMQ may take, but is not limited to the following
actions:  reduction of the number of samples, suspension of
sample shipment, a site visit, a full data audit, and/or
requiring the laboratory to analyze a remedial PES, and/or a
contract action such as a Cure Notice.   Also, if the Contractor
achieves a score of less than 75%, SMO may reject some or all
of the sample data associated with the failed PES in an SDG,
return the rejected data to the Contractor, and not pay for the
sample analysis.
                         D-39                           10/92

-------
                                  TABLE D-8
                ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA FOE INITIAL AND CONTINUING
                CALIBRATION TOR SEMIVOLATILE ORGANIC COMPOUNDS
Semi volatile
Compounds
Phenol
bis(2-Chloroethyl)ether
2 - Chloropheno 1
2-Methylphenol
4-Methylphenol
N-Nitroso-di-n-propylaaine
Hexachloroe thane
Nitrobenzene
Isophorone
2-Nltrophenol
2 , 4 - D line thy Ipheno 1
b Is ( 2 - Chloroe thoxy ) me thane
2,4- D Ichloropheno 1
1 , 2 , 4-Trichlorobenzene
Naphthalene
4 - Chloro - 3 -me thy Iphenol
2 -Methylnaphthalene
2,4, 6 -Trichlorophenol
2,4,5 -Trichlorophenol
2 - Chloronaphthalene
Acenaphthylene
Acenaphthene
Dibenzofuran
2 , 4- Dinitro toluene
2 , 6 -Dinitrotoluene
4 - Chloropheny 1 - pheny le ther
Fluorene
4 - Bromopheny 1 - pheny le ther
Hexachlorobenzene
Pentachloropheno 1
Phenanthrene
Anthracene
Fluoranthene
Pyrene
Benzo ( a ) anthracene
Chrysene
Benzo (b ) f luor anthene
Benzo (k) f luoranchene
Benzo(a)pyrene
Indeno (1,2,3- cd)pyrene
D tbenzo ( a , h) anthracene
Benzo(g,h, i)perylene
Minimum
RRF
0.800
0.700
0.700
0.700
0.600
0.500
0.300
0.200
0.400
0.100
0.200
0.300
0.200
0.200
0.700
0.200
0.400
0.200
0.200
0.800
1.300
0.800
0.800
0.200
0.200
0.400
0.900
0.100
0.100
0.050
0.700
0.700
0.600
0.600
0.800
0.700
0.700
0.700
0.700
0.500
0.400
0.500
Maximum
%RSD
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
30.0
30.0
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
30.0
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
Maximum
%Diff
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
+25.0
±25.0
-1-25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±30.0
+30.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25,0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
4-25.0
±30.0
±25.0
±25.0
4-25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
±25.0
(continued)


                                     SV D-40                           10/92

-------
                                   TABLE 0-8
                 ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA FOR INITIAL AND CONTINUING
                 CALIBRATION FOR SEMIVOLATILE  ORGANIC COMPOUNDS
 Semivolatile
 Compounds
Minimus
  RRF
Maximum
 %RSD
Maximum
 %Diff
 Phenol-dj
 2-Fluoropheno1
 Terpheny1-d^4
 2-Fluorobiphenyl
 0.800
 0.600
 0.500
 0.700
20.5
20.5
20.5
20.5
  ±25.0
  ±25.0
  ±25.0
  ±25.0
The  following compounds have no maximum %RSD or maximum %D criteria, buc
shall meet a minimum RRF criterion of 0.010:
2,2'-oxybis <1-Chloropropane)
4-Chloroaniline
Hexachlorobutadiene
Hexachlorocyclopentadiene
2-Hitroanillne
DimethyIphthalate
3-Nitroanilin*
2,4-Dinitrophenol
4-Nltrophenol
Diethylphthalace
   4-Nitroanillne
   4,6-Dinitro-2-methyIpheno1
   N-Nitrosodiphenylamine
   Di-n-butylphthalate
   Butylbenzylphthalate
   3,3'-Dichlorobenzidine
   bis(2-Ethylhexy1)phthalate
   Di-n-octyIphthalate
   2,4,6-Tribromophenol
   Ni trobenz ene-d
                                    SV D-41
                               10/92

-------
                                                                                        TABLE 0-9

                                                                           SeMIVOUTtlf INTERNAL  STANDARDS UITH
                                                                  CORRESPONDINC TARGET  ANALYTfS ASSIGNED FOR QUANTITATIQN
                                                               Actrwphtheftt-dlO
                                                         Pfttnanthrtnt-dio
       Witnol
       bl§(2-Chloro«thyU«th«r
       2-Chloropfwnol
       2-Ntthylphtnol
       bi§(2-Chloroliopropyl)ithtr
       4-Ntthyiph*nol
       H-Mltroto-di-n-propytMiliw
       2-Fluoroph«nol (iurr)
       Mitnol-dS (iurr)
Hitrobcnitn*
laophoron*
2,4-OlMthylphtnol
bi«C2-Chtoro«t)ioxy)MtliMw
2,4-Ofchloroph«nol
4-Chlor
-------
                                  Table D-10

              Primary Quantitation Ions (ra/z) and Secondary Ions
                      for Semivolatile Organic Compounds
Parameter
Primarv Ion
Secondarv Ion(s)
Phenol
bis(2-Chloroethyl)ether
2-Chlorophenol
1,3-Dichlorobenzene
1,4-Dichlorobenzene
1,2-Dichlorobenzene
2-Methylphenol
2,2'-oxybis(l-Chloropropane)
4-He thyIpheno1_
N-nitroso-di-n-propylamine
Hexachloroethane
Nitrobenzene
Isophorone
2-Nicrophenol
2,4-Dimethylphenol
bis(-2-Chloroethoxy)methane
2,4-Dichlorophenol
1,2,4-Trichlorobenzene
Naphthalene
4-Chloroaniline
Hexachlorobutadiene
4-Chloro-3-methyIpheno1
2-Methylnaphthalene
Hexachlorocyclopentadiene
2,4,6-Trichlorophenol
2,4,5-Trichlorophenol
2-ChloronaphChalene
2-Nitroaniline
Dimethyl phthalate
AcenaphChylene
3-Nitroaniline
Acenaphthene
2,4-Dinitrophenol
4-Nitrophenol
Dibenzofuran
2,4-Dinitrotoluene
2,6-Dinitrotoluene
      94
     93
     128
     146
     146
     146
     108
      45
     108
      70
     117
      77
      82
     139
     107
      93
     162
     180
     128
     127
     225
     107
     142
     237
     196
     196
     162
      65
     163
     152
     138
     153
     184
     109
     168
     165
     165
        65, 66
       63, 95
        64, 130
       148, 113
       148, 113
       148, 113
         107
        77, 79
         107
    42,  101, 130
       201, 199
        123, 65
        95, 138
        65, 109
       121, 122
        95, 123
        164, 98
       182, 145
       129, 127
         129
       223, 227
       144, 142
         141
       235, 272
       198, 200
       198, 200
       164, 127
        92, 138
       194, 164
       151, 153
       108, 92
       152, 154
        63, 154
       139, 65
         139
        63, 182
        89, 121
                                     SV D-43
                               10/92

-------
                             Table D-10 (continued)

 Parameter                                Primary Ion        Secondary lon(s)

 Dlethylphthalate                            149                     177, 150
 4-Chlorophenyl-phenylether                  204                     206, 141
 Fluorene                                    166                     165, 167
 4-Nitroaniline                               138                      92, 108
 4,6-Dinitro-2-a»thylphenol                  198                     182, 77
 N-NItrosodiphenylamine                       169                     168, 167
 4-Bromophenyl-phenylether                   248                     250, 141
 Hexachlorobenzene                            284                     142, 249
 Pentachlorophenol                            266                     264, 268
 Phenanthrene                                 178                     179, 176
 Anthracene                                   178                     179, 176
 Di-n-butylphthalate                          149                     150, 104
 Fluoranthene                                 202                     101, 100
 Pyrene                                       202                     101, 100
 Butylbenzylphthalate                         149                      91, 206
 3,3'-Dlchlorobenzldine                       252                      254, 126
 Benzo(a)anthracene                           228                      229, 226
 bis(2-Ethylhexyl)phthalate                   149                      167, 279
 Chrysene                                     228                      226,  229
 Di-n-octyl phthaiate                         149
 Benzo(b)fluoranthene                         252                      253,  125
 Benzo(k)fluoranthene                         252                      253,  125
 Benzo(a)pyrene                               252                      253,  125
 Indeno(l,2,3-cd)pyrene                       276                      138,  227
 Dibenz(a,h)anthracene                        278                      139,  279
 Benzo(g,h,i)perylene                         276                      138,  277

 Surrogates
 Phenol-d5                                    99                      42,  71
 2-Fluorophenol                               112                      64
 2,4,6-Tribronophenol                         330                      332,  141
 Nitrobenzene d5                              82                     128,  54
 2-Fluorobiphenyl                             172                      171
 Terphenyl                                    244                      122,  212

 Internal Standards
 1.4-Dlchlorobenzene-d4                       152                      115
 Naphthalene-dg                               136                      68
Acenapthene-d^Q                              lfi^                      162,  160
 Phenanthrene-dj^o                             188                      94,  80
 Chrysene-di2                                 240                      120,  236
 Perylene-d12                                 264                      260,  265
                                     SV D-44                           10/92

-------
                       EXHIBIT D
METHOD FOR THE ANALYSIS 0? LOW CONCENTRATION WATER FOR
                PESTICIDES AND AROCLORS
                         PEST D-l                          10/92

-------
                              Table of Contents
                                                                   Page
SECTION I:

SECTION II:
SECTION III:
SECTION IV:
SECTION V:
SECTION VI:
Introduction	 PEST D- 3
Part A - Sample Storage and Holding
           Tines 	PEST D-4
Part B - Equipment and Standards	PEST D- 5

Instrument Quality Control Procedures
  and Requirements
Part A - Instrument Operating Conditions 	PEST D-15
Part B - Calibration of the GC/ECD System	PEST D-16

Sample Preparation, Extraction and
  Cleanup 	'.	PEST D-28

Sample Analysis and Compound
  Identification and Quantitation	, PEST D-36

Sample Quality Control Procedures
  and Requirements	PEST D-45
                                     PEST D-2
                                                         10/92

-------
                                   SECTION I
                                 IHTEODOCTIOH
The analytical method that follows is designed to analyze water in order to
determine the presence and concentration of the chlorinated pesticides and
Aroclors found in the Target Compound List (Exhibit C).   The majority of the
samples are expected to be from drinking water and well/ground water sources
around Superfund sites.  The method can be used for determining analyte
concentrations as low as ten parts per trillion.  The method is based on EPA
Method 608.  Quality control requirements are incorporated in the method in
order to maximize GC/ECD sensitivity and column resolution and to minimize
contamination of the samples from laboratory sources.

Resolution difficulties have been associated with the following pairs of
compounds using this method:

o   On a DB-608 or equivalent column, DDE and dieldrin; Methoxychlor  and
    Endrin ketone; and  Endosulfan  I and gamma-Chlordane.

o   On a DB-1701  or  equivalent  column, Endosulfan I and gamma-Chlordane; and
    Methoxychlor  and Endosulfan sulfate.
                                     PEST D-3                          10/92

-------
                                  SECTION II


PART A - SAMPLE STORAGE AND HOLDING TIMES.

1.     PROCEDURES FOR    ?L  STORAGE
      The samples  shall be protected from light and refrigerated at 4*0
      (±2*C)  from  the time of receipt until 60 days after delivery of a
      complete reconciled sample data package to the Region.   After 60 days
      the samples  may be disposed of in a manner that complies with all
      applicable regulations.

      The samples  shall be stored in an atmosphere  demonstrated to be free of
      all potential  contaminants and in a refrigerator used only for storage
      of samples received under this contract.

      Samples,  sample extracts,  and standards shall be stored separately.

      PROCEDURE POR   APL          STORAGE
      Sample extracts shall be  protected from light  and  stored at 4*0  (±2*C)
      until 365 days after delivery  of  a complete  data package to the  Region.

      Sample extracts shall be  stored in an atmosphere demonstrated  to be
      free of all potential contaminants.

      Samples, sample extracts, and  standards shall  be stored separately.

      CONTRACT REQUIRED HOLDING TIMES

      The extraction of all samples  shall be  started within 5 days of  the
      Validated Time of Sample  Receipt  (VTSR) .

      Analysis of samples shall be completed  within  40 days following  the
      start of extraction.
                                    PEST D-4                          10/92

-------
PART B - EQUIPMENT AND STANDARDS

4.    SUMMARY Of METHOD

4.1   A one liter aliquot of sample is spiked with the surrogate solution and
      extracted with aethylene chloride by using a continuous liquid* liquid
      extractor.  The aethylene chloride extract is dried and concentrated,
      exchanged to hexane, cleaned up to remove Interferences, and adjusted
      to a final volume of 2.0 mL.

4.2   The hexane extract is injected onto two wide-bore capillary columns in
      a gas chromatograph (GC) .   The gas chromatograph is temperature
      programmed to separate the pesticides and Aroclors which are then
      detected with an electron capture detector (ECD) .  Calibration and run
      sequence specifications of the GC/ECD method apply independently to
      both GC columns.

4.3   A single component pesticide is identified if a peak is detected within
      its appropriate retention tine window on each of two GC columns.
      Quantitative analysis of pesticides/Aroclors shall be accomplished by
      the external standard method.  Single component analytes and the
      surrogates shall be analyzed at three concentrations during the initial
      calibration.

4.4   Toxaphene and Aroclors are identified primarily by pattern recognition,
      but retention times of three to five major peaks shall also be taken
      into consideration.  Single-point calibrations for multicomponent
      analytes are sufficient for quantitation by this method.  Standards for
      identified Aroclors and Toxaphene shall be run within 72 hours of the
      sample analysis in which they were observed.  These standards are used
      to verify Identification only; quantitation is based on the standards
      analyzed during initial calibration.
5.1   Method interferences may be caused by contaminants in solvents,
      reagents, glassware, and sample processing hardware.  These
      contaminants lead to discrete artifacts or to elevated baselines in gas
      chromatograms .   These materials shall be routinely demonstrated to be
      free from interferences under the sample preparation and analysis
      conditions by analyzing instrument blanks and method blanks.
      Interferences caused by phthalate esters can pose a major problem in
      pesticide analysis.  Because common flexible plastics contain varying
      amounts of phthalates which are easily extracted during laboratory
      operations, cross -contamination of glassware frequently occurs when
      plastics are handled.  Interferences from phthalates can best be
      minimized by avoiding the use of such plastics in the laboratory.

5.2   Matrix interferences may be caused by contaminants that are co-
      extracted from the sample.  The extent of matrix interferences will
      vary considerably from source to source, depending upon the nature of
      the site being sampled.  The cleanup procedures in Section 13 shall be
      used to remove such interferences in order to achieve the Contract
      Required Quantitation Limits (CRQL) .

                                     PEST D-5                          10/92

-------
6.    APPARAOTS AND MATERIALS

      Brand names,  suppliers, and part numbers are for Illustrative purposes
      only.  No endorsement Is Implied.  Equivalent performance may be
      achieved using apparatus and materials other than those specified here,
      but demonstration of equivalent performance meeting the requirements of
      the method is the responsibility of the Contractor.

6.1   Gas Chromatograph/Eleetron Capture Detector (GC/ECD)

      6.1.1   Gas Chromatograph

              6.1.1.1    The gas chromatograph (GC) system shall regulate
                         temperature in order to give a reproducible
                         temperature program and have a flow controller that
                         maintains a constant column flow rate throughout the
                         temperature program.  The system shall be suitable
                         for splitless injection and have all required
                         accessories Including syringes,  analytical columns,
                         and gases.

              6.1.1.2    Gas chromatographs that are available from some
                         manufacturers may have difficulty in meeting certain
                         method QC requirements because of Endrin and DDT
                         breakdown in the injector.  This problem can be
                         minimized by operating the injector at 200-205*C,
                         using a Pytex (not quartz) methyl silicone
                         deactivated injector liner,  and deactivating any
                         metal parts in the Injector with dichlorodimethyl
                         silane.   In some cases,  using a 0.25-inch packed
                         column Injector converted for use with 0.53 mm
                         capillary columns works better than a Grob-type
                         injector.   If a Gr-u-type inlector is used, a 4 mm
                         liner may be required to meet breakdown criteria.

      6.1.2   Gas Chromatograph Columns

              6.1.2.1    Two wide-bore (0.53 mm ID) fused silica GC columns
                         are required.   A separate detector is required for
                         each column.  The specified analytical columns are a
                         DB-1701,  30 m x 0.53 mm ID,  1.0  urn film thickness,
                         J&W Scientific,  Folsom,  CA,  and a DB-608,  30 m x
                         0,53 mm ID. 0.5 to 1.0 urn film thickness from J&W
                         Scientific.  Equivalent columns  may be employed if
                         they meet the requirements in Section III.

              6.1.2.2    Columns are mounted In 0.25-inch injector ports by
                         using glass adapters available from a variety of
                         commercial  sources (J&W Scientific,  Supelco, Inc.,
                         Hewlett-Packard, Varian,  Inc.,  Perkin Elmer, or
                         equivalent).  The two columns may be mounted into a
                         single injection port with a tee adapter,  (Supelco,
                         Inc., Bellefonte,  PA,  Catalog No.  2-3660,  or
                         equivalent).  Use of this adapter allows

                                     PEST D-6                         10/92

-------
                         simultaneous injection onto both columns.
                         Laboratories should follow the manufacturer's
                         recommendation on mounting 0,53 am capillaries into
                         injection ports.

      6,1.3   The carrier  gas  for routine applications is helium.
              Laboratories nay choose to use hydrogen as a carrier  gas, but
              they  shall clearly identify its use  in the SDG Narrative and on
              all divider  pages preceding raw chrooatographic data  in
              submissions.  Laboratories that choose to use hydrogen are
              advised to exercise caution in its use.  Use of a hydrogen  leak
              detector is  highly recommended if hydrogen is used as a carrier
             • gas.  All GC carrier gas 7ines shall be constructed from
              stainless steel  or copper tubing.  Non-polytetrafluoroethylene
              (PTFE) thread sealants, or flow controllers with rubber
              components are not to be used.

      6.1.4   Electron Capture  Detector - The makeup gas shall be P-5, P-10
              (argon/methane)  or nitrogen according to the instrument
              .specification.  The GC/ECD system shall be in a room in which
              the atmosphere has been demonstrated to be free of all
              contaminants which may interfere with the analysis.  The
              instrument shall  be vented to outside the facility or to a
              trapping system which prevents the release of contaminants  into
              the instrument room.

      6.1.5   Data System  - A data system shall be interfaced to the GC/SCD.
              The data system shall allow the continuous acquisition of data
              throughout the duration of the chromatographic program and
              shall permit, at  the minimum, the output of time vs. intensity
              (peak height or peak area) data.  Also, the data system shall
              be able to rescale chromatographic data in order to report
              chromatograms meeting the requirements listed within this
              method.

6.2   Glassware  - A set of glassware sufficient to meet  contract  requirements
      shall be reserved for exclusive use  in this contract.

      6.2.1   Continuous liquid-liquid extractors equipped with Teflon or
              glass connecting  lines for use with methylene chloride
              (Hershberg-¥olf  Extractor, Ace Glass Company, Vineland, NJ,  P/N
              6841-10, or  equivalent).

      6.2.2   Concentrator tube - Kuderna-Danish, 10 mL, graduated  (Kontes,
              Vineland, NJ K-570050-1025, or equivalent).

      6.2.3   Evaporative  flask - Kuderna-Danish, 500 mL (Kontes K-570001 -
              0500, or equivalent).  Attach to concentrator tube with
              springs.

      6.2.4   Snyder column - Kuderna-Danish, three-ball macro (Kontes
              K-50300-0121, or  equivalent).
                                     PEST D-7                          10/92

-------
      6.2.5   Drying column,  chromatographic column approximately 400 mm  long
              x  19 mm  ID, with coarse  frit.  (Substitution of a small pad of
              disposable Pyrex glass wool  for  the frit will help prevent
              cross-contamination  of sample extracts.)

      6.2.6   Fipet, Volumetric 1.00 mL or 2.00 mL (optional).

      6.2.7   Microsyringe, 1.0 uL and larger, 0.006 inch ID needle.

      6.2.8   Syringe, 1.00 oL or  2.00 mL  (optional).

      6.2.9   Flask, Volumetric 10.00  mL.

      6.2.10  Flask, Volumetric 1.00 mL or 2.00 mL (optional).

      6.2.11  Snyder column, micro two or  three ball with a 19 mm ground
              glass Joint.

      6.2.12  Glass vials, minimum of  20 mL, with screw cap and Teflon or
              .aluminum foil liner.

      6.2.13  Vials, 10 mL, with screw cap and Teflon liner (optional).

      6.2.14  Vials and caps,  1 or 2 mL for GC auto sampler.

      6.2.15  Bottle or test tube, 50  mL with Teflon-lined screw cap for
              sulfur removal.

      6.2.16  Centrifuge tubes,  calibrated, 12 mL, for sulfur removal.

      6.2.17  Micropipet, 250 uL,  with disposable tips.

6.3   pH Paper,  wide  range.

6.4   Boiling chips.

      6.4.1   Silicon carbide boiling  chips, approximately 10 to 40 mesh.
              Heat the chips to 400"C  for  30 minutes or solvent rinse before
              use.

      6.4.2   Teflon boiling chips (optional).  Solvent rinse the chips
              before use.

6.5   Water bath, heated, with concentric ring cover,  capable of temperature
      control.  NOTE:   To prevent the release of solvent fumes into the
      laboratory, the water bath shall be used in a hood.

6.6   Balance.  Analytical,  capable of accurately weighing ±0.0001 g.   The
      balances shall  be calibrated with class S weights once per each 12-hour
      workshift.   The balances shall  also be annually checked by a certified
      technician.

6.7   Nitrogen evaporation  device equipped with a heated bath that can be
      maintained at 30  to 35*C (N-Evap by Organomation Associates,  Inc.,

                                     PEST D-8                          10/92

-------
       South Berlin,  MA,  or equivalent) .   To prevent  the  release of solvent
       fumes into the laboratory,  the  nitrogen evaporation device shall be
       used in a hood.

 6.8    Florisil Cleanup  Equipment

       6.8.1   Florisil bonded silica.  1-g cartridges with stainless steel or
               Teflon frits, Catalog Ho.  694-313 (Analytichem,  24201 Frampton
               Ave.,  Harbor City,  CA,  or equivalent).

       6.8.2   Vacuum system for eluting multiple cleanup cartridges.  Vac
               Elute  Manifold,  Analytichen International  (J.T.  Baker, or
               Supelco)  or equivalent.

       6.8.3   Vacuum trap made from a 500 mL sidearm flask fitted with a one-
               hole stopper and glass  tubing.

       6.8.4   Vacuum pressure  gauge.

       6.8.5   
-------
7,8   Eeagent water.  Reagent water Is defined as a water in which no target
      analyte is observed at the CRQL for that compound.

      7.8.1   Reagent water may be generated by  passing tap water  through a
              carbon filter bed containing  about 453  g  (1  lb.) of  activated
              carbon (Calgon Corp., Filtrasorb-300, or  equivalent).

      7.8.2   Reagent water may be generated using a  water purification
              system (Millipore Super-Q or  equivalent).

7.9   Ten percent acetone in hexane (v/v).   Prepare by adding 10.0 ml* of
      acetone to 90.0 mL of hexane.   NOTE:   Prepare this mixture accurately
      or the results from the Florisil cartridge cleanup will be adversely
      affected.   Water in the acetone will  also adversely affect Florisil
      performance.

8.     STANDARDS

8.1   The Contractor shall provide all standards to be used with this
      contract.   These  standards may be used only after  they have  been
      certified.  The Contractor shall be  able to verify that the  standards
      are certified.  Manufacturer's  certificates of analysis shall be
      retained by the Contractor and presented upon request.

8.2   Stock standard solutions  (1.00  ug/uL)  - Stock standard solutions may be
      purchased  as  certified solutions  or prepared from  pure standard
      materials.

      8.2.1   Prepare stock standard solutions by accurately weighing about
              0.0100 g of pure material.  Dissolve the material in toluene,
              dilute to volume in a 10 mL volumetric flask with toluene or
              acetone.  Larger volumes may be used at the convenience of the
              analyst.

      8.2.2   When compound purity is assayed to be 97 percent or greater,
              the weight may be used without correction to calculate the
              concentration of the stock solution.  If the compound purity is
              assayed to be less than 97 percent, the weight shall be
              corrected when calculating the concentration of the stock
              solution.

      8.2.3   Fresh stock standards shall be prepared once every twelve
              months, or sooner, if standards have degraded or concentrated.
              Stock standards shall be checked for signs of degradation or
              concentration just prior to preparing working standards from
              them.

8.3   Working Standards

      8.3.1   Surrogate Standard Spiking Solution

              The surrogates, tetrachloro-m-xylene and decachlorobiphenyl,
              are added to all standards,  samples,  and blanks.  Prepare a
              surrogate spiking solution of 0.20 ug/mL of each of the two

                                     PEST D-10                         10/92

-------
         compounds In acetone.   The solution should be checked
         frequently for stability.   The solution shall be replaced after
         six months or at an earlier time,  if the solution has degraded
         or concentrated.

8.3.2    Resolution Check Mixture

         The Resolution Check Mixture is composed of the  pesticides and
         surrogates at the concentrations listed below in hexane  or iso-
         octane.   The mixture shall be prepared every six months  or
         sooner,  if the solution has degraded or concentrated.

                    Compounds          Concentration (ng/a^f)

                    gamma-Chlordane               10.0
                    Endosulfan I                  10.0
                    p,p'-DDI                      20.0
                    Dieldrin                      20,0
                    Endosulfan sulfate            20.0
                    Endrin ketone                 20.0
                    Methoxychlor                100.0
                    Tetrachloro-m-xylene          20.0
                    Decachlorobiphenyl            20.0

8.3.3    Performance Evaluation Mixture

         The  Performance  Evaluation  Mixture  is prepared in hexane or
         iso-octane  as  listed below.  The PEM shall be prepared weekly
         or more often, if the solution has  degraded or concentrated.

                   Compounds          Concentration (nz/mL^

                   gamma-BHC                     10.0
                   alpha-BHC                     10.0
                   4,4'-DDT                    100.0
                   beta-BHC                      10.0
                   Endrin                        50.0
                   Methoxychlor                250.0
                   Tetrachloro-m-xylene         20.0
                   Decachlorobiphenyl           20.0

8.3.4    Single Component Pesticides

         The  Individual Standard Mixture solutions shall be prepared in
         either hexane or iso-octane.  The concentrations of the
         pesticides  in the low point standard mixtures are given below.
         The midpoint concentration  shall be 4 times the low point
         concentration for each analyte, including  the surrogates.  The
         high concentration shall be at least 16  times the low point
         concentration for each analyte, including  the surrogates, but a
         higher concentration may be chosen  by the  Contractor.  The high
         point concentration defines the upper end  of the concentration
         range for which  the calibration is  valid.  The solution shall
                               PEST D-ll                         10/92

-------
              be prepared every  6 months or  sooner,  if  the  solution has
              degraded  or concentrated.
    Individual
	Standard Mix A

alpha-BHC
Heptachlor
gamma-BHC
Endosulfan I
Dieldrin
Endrin
p,p'-DDD
p.p'-DDT
Methoxychlor
Te trachloro - m- xy lene
Decachlorobiphenyl
  Low Point
Concentration
  (ng/mL)
                 Individual
               Standard Mix
             B
     .0
     .0
     .0
     .0
 5.
 5,
 5,
 5.
10.0
10.0
10.0
10.0
50.0
 5.0
10.0
beta-BHC
delta-BHC
Aldrin
Heptachlor epoxide
alpha-Chlordane
gamma-Chlordane
p,p'-DDE
Endosulfan sulfate
Endrin aldehyde
Indrin ketone
Endosulfan II
Tetrachloro-«-xylene
Decachlorobiphenyl
  Low Point
Concentration
    (ng/mL)
     5
     5
     5
     5
     5
     5
    10.0
    10.0
    10.0
    10.0
    10.0
     5.0
    10.0
      8.3.5   Multicomponent Standards
              Toxaphene and Aroclor standards shall be prepared  individually
              except for Aroclor 1260 and Aroclor 1016 which may be combined
              in one standard mixture.  The calibration standards  for  the
              Arodors shall be prepared at concentrations of 100  ng/mL,
              except for Aroclor 1221 which shall be prepared at 200 ng/mL.
              Toxaphene shall be prepared at 500 ng/mL.  All multicoraponent
              standards shall contain the surrogates at 20.0 ng/mL.  The
              Aroclor and Toxaphene solutions shall be prepared  in hexane or
              Iso-octane.  Each solution shall be prepared every 6 months, or
              sooner, if the solution has degraded or concentrated.

      8.3.6   Florisil Cartridge Check Solution

              Prepare a 0.10 ug/mL solution of 2,4,5-trichlorophenol in
              acetone.  The solution shall be prepared every 6 months, or
              sooner, if the solution has degraded or concentrated.

      8.3.7   Laboratory Control Sample (LCS) Spiking Solution

              Prepare a laboratory control sample (LCS) spiking  solution that
              contains each of the analytes at the concentrations  listed
              below in methanol or acetone.  The LCS solution shall be
              prepared every six months or sooner, if the solution has
              degraded or concentrated.
               Compounds

               gamma-BHC
               Heptachlor epoxide
               Dieldrin
                   Concentration
                             0.10
                             0.10
                             0.20
                                     PEST D-12
                                                  10/92

-------
              4,4'-DDE                            0.20
              Endrln                              0,20
              Endosulfan sulfate                  0.20
              gamma-Chlordane                     0.10

8.4   Storage of Standards

      8.4.1   Store the stock and secondary standard solutions at -10*C to
              -20*C in Teflon-lined screw-cap amber bottles.

      8.4.2   Store the working standard solutions at 4*C (±2*C) in Teflon-
              lined screw-cap amber bottles.  The working standards shall be
              checked frequently for signs of degradation or evaporation.

      8.4.3   Protect all standards from light.

      8.4.4   Samples, sample extracts, and standards shall be stored
              separately.
                                    PEST D-13                         10/92

-------
                      SECTION III
INSTRUMENT QUALITY CONTROL PRQCIOTRIS AND REQUIREMENTS
                         PEST D-14                         10/92

-------
PART A - INSTRUMENT OPERATING CONDITIONS

9.    GASGHROMATOGRAPH/ ELECTRON CAPTURE DETECTOR

      The following are the gas chromatographic analytical conditions.  The
conditions are recommended unless otherwise noted,


      Carrier Gas:                   Helium

      Column Flow:                   5 nL/min
      Make-up Gas:                   Argon/Methane (P-5 or P-10) or N£
                                    (required)

      Injector Temperature:          > 200*C (required)

      Injection Technique:           On-column
      Injection Volume:              1 or 2 ul (see note below)

      Injector:                     Grob-type, splitless

      Initial Temperature:           150*C

      Initial Hold Tim*:             1/2 min
      Temperature Ramp:              5*C to 6*C/mln

      Final Temperature:             275*C
      Final Hold Time:               After Decachlorobiphenyl has eluted
                                    (approximately 10 minutes)

      Optimize GC conditions for analyte separation and sensitivity.   Once
      optimized,  the same GC conditions shall be used for the analysis of all
      standards,  samples, blanks,  performance evaluation samples and
      laboratory control  samples.   NOTE:  Manual Injections shall be 2.0 uL.
      Auto injectors may  use 1.0 uL volumes.   The same injection volume shall
      be used for all standards, blanks, and samples.

      The linearity of the  ECD may be greatly dependent on the flow rate of
      the make-up gas.  Care shall be taken to maintain stable and
      appropriate flow of make-up gas to the detector.

      Cold (ambient temperature) on-column injectors that allow injection
      directly onto a 0.53  mm ID column may be used as long as the acceptance
      criteria for resolution, calibration, and analyte breakdown are met.
                                     PEST D-15                         10/92

-------
PART B - CALIBRATION OF THE GC/ECD SYSTEM

10.   INITIAL CALIBRATION

10.1  Summary

      Prior to sample analysis, each GC/ECD system shall be initially
      calibrated at a minimum of three concentrations for single component
      analytes in order to determine instrument sensitivity and the linearity
      of GC response.  Each multicomponent analyte is analyzed at one
      concentration.  •

10.2  Frequency

      Each GC/ECD system shall be initially calibrated upon award of the
      contract, whenever major instrument maintenance or modification is
      performed (e.g., column replacement or repair,  cleaning or replacement
      of ECD,  etc.), or if the calibration verification technical acceptance
      criteria have not been met.

10.. 3  Procedure

      10.3.1  Set up the GC/ECD system as described  in Section 9.

      10.3.2  Prepare the initial calibration standards using the procedures,
              the analytes, and the concent-rations according to Section 8.

      10.3.3  All standards, samples, and blanks shall be allowed to warm to
              ambient temperature before preparation or analysis.

      10.3.4  Analyze the initial calibration sequence as given below.  NOTE:
              S*"*pa 16 and 17 are v.r-"i as par- «f the e°1ibration
              verification as well (see Section 11).

                         INITIAL CALIBRATION SEQUENCE

                              1.  Resolution Check
                              2.  Performance Evaluation Mixture
                              3.  Aroclor 1016/1260
                              4.  Aroclor 1221
                              5.  Aroclor 1232
                              6.  Aroclor 1242
                              7.  Aroclor 1248
                              8.  Aroclor 1254
                              9.  Toxaphene
                             10.  Low Point Standard A
                             11.  Low Point Standard B
                             12.  Midpoint Standard A
                             13.  Midpoint Standard B
                             14.  High Point Standard A
                             15.  High Point Standard B
                             16.  Instrument Blank
                             17,  Performance Evaluation Mixture
                                     PEST D-16                         10/92

-------
10 . 4  Calculations

      10.4.1  For each single component pesticide and surrogate, a retention
              time (RT) is measured in each of three of the calibration
              standards analyses  (low point, midpoint, high point) during the
              Initial calibration for Individual Standard Mixture A and
              Individual Standard Mixture B.  The RT for the surrogates is
              measured from the Individual Standard Mixture A analyses.  The
              mean RT is calculated as the average of the_three values.
              Calculate a mean absolute retention time (RT) for each single
              component pesticide and surrogate using Equation D.22.
                         _    n
              EQ. D.22.  RT  - S
                              1-1    n
              RT  — Mean absolute retention time of analyte.

              RTj[ - Absolute retention time of analyte.

              n   — Number of measurements (3).

      10.4.2   A retention time window is calculated for each single component
              analyte and surrogate and for the major peaks (3 to 5) of each
              multicoaponent analyte by using Table D.12.  Windows are
              centered around the average absolute retention time for the
              analyte established during the initial calibration.

                                         TABLE D.12


                         RETENTION TIME WINDuws  FOR SINGLE AND MULTICOMPONSNT
                                   ANALYTSS AND  SURROGATES.

                                                 Compound Identification
                           Compound                Window (minutes)

                         alpha-BHC                        ±0.05
                         beta-BHC                         ±0.05
                         gamma-BHC                        ±0.05
                         delta-BHC          .              ±0.05
                         Heptachlor                       ±0.05
                         Aldrin                           ±0.05
                         alpha-Chlordane                  ±0.07
                         gamma-Chiordane                  ±0.07
                         Heptachlor epoxide               ±0.07
                         Dieldrin                         ±0.07
                         Endrln                           ±0.07
                         Endrin aldehyde                  ±0.07
                                     PEST D-17                         10/92

-------
                                   TABLE D.12 (continued)

                   RETENTION TIME WINDOWS FOR SINGLE AND MULTICOMPONENT
                             ANALYTES AND SURROGATES.

                                           Compound Identification
                     Compound                Window (minutes) _

                   Endrin ketone                    ±0.07
                   DDD                              ±0.07
                   DDE                              ±0.07
                   DDT                              ±0.07
                   Endosulfan I                     ±0.07
                   Endosulfan II                    ±0.07
                   Endosulfan sulfate               ±0.07
                   Methoxychlor                     ±0.07
                   Aroclors                         ±0.07
                   Toxaphene                        ±0 . 07
                   Tetrachloro-m-xylene             ±0.05
                   Decachlorob ipheny 1               ±0 . 10

10.4.3  The linearity of the instrument is determined by calculating a
        percent relative standard deviation (%RSD) of the calibration
        factors from a three -point calibration curve for each of the
        single component pesticide and surrogates.  Either peak area or
        peak height may be used to calculate calibration factors used
        in the %RSD equation.  For example, it is permitted to
        calculate linearity for endrin based on peak area and to
        calculate linearity for aldrin based on peak height.  It is not
        permitted within a %RSD calculation for an analyte to use
        calibration factors calculated from both peak area and peak
        height.  For example, it is not permitted to calculate the
        calibration factor for the low point standard for endrin using
        peak height and calculate the midpoint and high point standard
        calibration factors for endrin using peak area.

        10.4.3.1   Calculate the calibration factor for  each single
                   component pesticide and surrogate over the initial
                   calibration range using Equation D.23.

        10.4.3.2   Calculate the mean and the %RSD of the calibration
                   factors for each single component pesticide and
                   surrogate over the initial calibration range using
                   Equation D.24 and Equation D.25.

        EQ. D.23  CF -  Peak Area (or Height) of the Standard
                                  Mass Injected (ng)
                  —    S
        EQ. D.24  CF - i-1
                           n
                               PEST D-18                        10/92

-------
         EQ.  D.25  % RSD -  SDcr
                            CF
        Where SDcr -  /   1-1	       and n-3
                               n-1

        %RSD  - Percent  relative  standard deviation.

             <-> Standard deviation for calibration factors.

              - Calibration factor.
        CF  - Mean calibration factor.

10.4.4  A calibration factor  is calculated  for each peak  in  a  selected
        set of  three  to  five  major peaks  for each multicomponent
        analyte using Equation D.23.

10.4.5  Calculate  the percent breakdown of  DOT, the percent  breakdown
        of Endrin,  and the combined breakdown of DDT and  Endrin in  the
        Performance Evaluation Mixture using Equations D.26, D.27,
        D.28, and  D.29.

EQ. D.26
Amount found (in ng) - Peak area for Peak height)  of compound in PEM
CFjjp -  The calibration factor for the compound determined from  the
        midpoint standard in the most recent initial calibration.
        Note:  If during the initial calibration, linearity was
        determined based on peak area for the compound, then the
        midpoint CF shall be based on peak area.  If during the  initial
        calibration, the linearity for the compound was determined
        based on peak height for the compound, then the midpoint CF
        shall be based on peak height.

EQ. D.27
% Breakdown DDT - Amount found in ng (DDD+DDS)  * 100
                     Amount in ng of DDT injected

EQ. D.28
% Breakdown Endrin —
Amount found in ng (Endrin Aldehyde + Endrin Ketone) * 100
            Amount in ng of Endrin injected

EQ. D.29   Combined % Breakdown - %Breakdown DDT + tfireakdown Endrin

10.4.6  Calculate the percent difference for each pesticide and
        surrogate in the Performance Evaluation Mixture and Individual
        Standard Mixtures A and B using Equation D.26 and Equation
        D.30.

                               PEST D-19                         10/92

-------
               BQ. D.30      %D  -    C^oa - Ccalc
                                  -  X  100
              %D     - Percent Difference
              Cnom   ~ nominal concentration of each analyte
              Ccalc  ~ Calculated concentration of each analyte  from  the
                       analyses of  the standard

      10.4.7  Calculate the resolution between the analytes in the Resolution
              Check Mixture and the midpoint concentrations of Individual
              standard mixtures A and B using Equation D.31.
              EQ. D.31   % Resolution - w  x 100%
              V - Depth of the valley between the two peaks.  The depth of
                  the valley is measured along a vertical line from the level
                  of the apex of the shorter peak to the floor of the valley
                  between the two peaks.
              H - Height of the shorter of the adjacent peaks

10.5  Technical Acceptance  Criteria For Initial  Calibration

      All initial  calibration technical acceptance criteria apply
      independently  to  both GC columns.

      10.5.1  The initial calibration sequence shall be analyzed according to
              the procedure and in the order listed in Section 10.3, at the
              concentrations listed in Section 8, and at the frequency listed
              in Section 10.2.  The GC/ECD operating conditions optimized in
              Section 9 shall be followed.

      10.5.2  The resolution between two adjacent peaks in the Resolution
              Check Mixture shall be greater than or equal to 60.0%.  On the
              DB-1701 GC column, resolution difficulties are most likely
              between Endosulfan I and gamma-Chlordane and between
              Methoxychlor and endosulfan sulfate.  On the DB-608 GC column,
              the poorest resolution will probably be between p,p'-DDE and
              Dieldrin; Methoxychlor and Endrln ketone; and Endosulfan I and
              gamma-Chlordane.

      10.5.3  All single component pesticides and surrogates in both runs of
              the Performance Evaluation Mixture (PEM) shall be 100 percent
              resolved.

      10.5.4  The absolute retention times of each of the single component
              pesticides and surrogates in both runs of the PEM shall be
              within the retention time window determined from the three-
              point initial calibration in Section 10.4.2.

      10.5.5  The percent difference of the calculated amount and the true
              amount for each of the single component and surrogates in both


                                     PEST  D-20                         10/92

-------
         of the PEM runs shall be greater than or equal to -25 percent
         and less than or equal to 25 percent  using Equation D.30.

10.5.6   The percent breakdown of DDT and endrin in each of the PEM runs
         shall be less than or equal to  20.0 percent.   The combined
         breakdown of DDT and endrin shall be  less than or equal to 30.0
         percent.

10.5.7   The %RSD of the calibration factors for each  single component
         target compound shall be less than or equal to 20.0 percent,
         except as noted.   The %RSD of the calibration factors for  the
         two surrogates shall be  less than or  equal to 30.0 percent.   Up
         to  two single component  target  compounds (but not surrogates)
         may exceed the 20.0 percent limit for %RSD, but those compounds
         shall have a %RSD of less  than  or equal to 30.0 percent.

10.5.8   The resolution between any two  adjacent peaks in the midpoint
         concentrations of Individual Standard Mixtures  A and B in  the
         initial  calibration shall  be greater  than or  equal  to 90.0
        percent.

10.5.9  All instrument blanks  shall  meet  the  technical  acceptance
        criteria  in Section 20.3.4.

10.5.10 The identification of  single  component pesticides by  gas
        chromatographic methods  is based primarily on retention time
        data.  The  retention time  of the apex of  a peak can only be
        verified  from an  on-scale  chromatogram.  The  identification of
        multicomponent analytes by gas chromatographic methods is based
        primarily on  recognition of patterns of retention times
        displayed on  a chromatogram.  Therefore,  the following
        requirements  apply  to  all data presented  for single component
        and multicomponent  analytes.

        10.5.10.1  The chromatograms that result from  the analyses of
                   the Resolution Check Mixture, the Performance
                   Evaluation Mixture, and Individual  Standard Mixtures
                   A and B during the initial  calibration sequence
                   shall display the single component  analytes present
                   in each standard at greater than 10 percent of full
                   scale but less than 100 percent of  full scale.

        10.5.10.2  The chromatograms for at least one  of the three
                   analyses each of Individual Standard Mixtures A and
                   B from the initial calibration sequence shall
                   display the single component analytes at greater
                   than 50 percent and less than 100 percent of full
                   scale.

        10.5.10.3  The chromatograms of  the standards  for the
                   multicomponent analytes analyzed during the initial
                   calibration sequence  shall  display  the peaks chosen
                   for identification of each  analyte  at greater than
                   25 percent and less than 100 percent of full scale.

                               PEST D-21                         10/92

-------
              10.5.10.4  For all Resolution Check Mixtures, Performance
                         Evaluation Mixtures, Individual Standard Mixtures,
                         and blanks, the baseline of the chromatogram shall
                         return to below SO percent of full scale before the
                         elution tine of alpha-BHC, and return to below 25
                         percent of full scale after the elution tine of
                         alpha*BHC and before the elution tine of
                         decachlorobiphenyl.

              10.5.10.5  If a chronatogran is replotted electronically to
                         meet requirements, the scaling factor used shall be
                         displayed on the chromatogram.

              10.5.10.6  If the chromatogram of any standard needs to be
                         replotted electronically to meet these requirements,
                         both the initial chromatogram and the replotted
                         chroaatogram shall be submitted in the data package.

10.6  Corrective Action

      10.6.1  If the technical acceptance criteria for the initial
              calibration are not met, inspect the system for problems.  It
              may be necessary to change the column, bake out the detector,
              clean the injection port, or take other corrective actions to
              achieve the acceptance criteria.

      10.6.2  Contamination should be suspected as a cause if the detector
              cannot achieve acceptable linearity using this method.  In the
              case of low level contamination, baking out the detector at
              elevated temperature (350*C)  should be sufficient to achieve
              acceptable performance.  In the case of heavy contamination,
              passing hydrogen through the  detector for 1-2 hours at elevated
              r»<*T>erature may cotTP'*'  the proll.a.   In fhe case of severe
              contamination, the detector may require servicing by the ECD
              manufacturer.  DO NOT OPES THE DETECTOR.   THE ECD CONTAINS
              RADIOCHEMICAL SOURCES.

      10.6.3  If a laboratory decontaminates a detector using elevated
              temperature,  the ECD electronics shall be turned off during the
              bake out procedure.

      10.6.4  After bake out or hydrogen reduction, the detector shall be
              recalibrated using the initial calibration sequence.

      10.6.5  Initial calibration technical acceptance criteria SHALL be met
              before any samples (including the LCS and PES) or required
              blanks are analyzed.  Any samples (including the LCS and FES)
              or required blanks analyzed after the initial calibration
              criteria have not been met will require reanalysis at no
              additional cost.
                                     PEST D-22                         10/92

-------
11.    CALIBRATION VERIFICATION

11.1  Summary

      Three types of analyses are used Co verify Che calibraCion and evaluate
      instrument performance.  The analyses of instrument blanks,  Performance
      Evaluation Mixtures (PEM),  and the mid point concentration of
      Individual Standard Mixtures A and B constitute the continuing
      calibration.   Sample data are not acceptable unless bracketed by
      acceptable analyses of instrument blanks,  PEM, and both Individual
      Standard Mixtures A and B.

11.2  Frequency

      11.2.1  An instrument blank and the Performance Evaluation Mixture
              shall bracket one end of a 12-hour period during which sample
              data are collected, and a second instrument blank and the mid
              point concentration of Individual Standard Mixtures A and B
              shall bracket the other end of the 12-hour period.

      11.2.2  For the 12-hour period immediately following the initial
              calibration sequence, the instrument blank and the PEM that are
              the last two steps in the initial calibration sequence bracket
              the front end of that 12-hour period.  The injection of the
              instrument blank starts the beginning of that 12-hour period
              (see Section 14.3).  Samples may be injected for 12 hours from
              the injection of the instrument blank.  The first three
              injections immediately after that 12-hour period shall be an
              instrument blank, Individual Standard Mixture A, and Individual
              Standard Mixture B.  The instrument blank shall be analyzed
              first, before either standard.  The Individual Standard
              Mixtures may be analyzed in either order (A,B or B,A).

      11.2.3  The analyses of the instrument blank and Individual Standard
              Mixtures A and B immediately following one 12-hour period may
              be used to begin the subsequent 12-hour period, provided that
              they meet the acceptance criteria in Section U.S.  In that
              instance, the subsequent 12-hour period shall be bracketed by
              the acceptable analyses of an instrument blank and a PEM, in
              that order.  Those two analyses may in turn be used to bracket
              the front end of yet another 12-hour period.  This progression
              may continue every 12 hours until such time as any of the
              instrument blanks, PEMs, or Individual Standard Mixtures fails
              to meet the acceptance criteria in Section 11.5.  The 12-hour
              time period begins with the injection of the instrument blank.
              Standards  (PEM or Individual Standard Mixtures), samples and
              required blanks may be injected for 12:00 hours from the time
              of injection of the instrument blank.

      11.2.4  If more than 12 hours have elapsed since the injection of the
              instrument blank that bracketed a previous 12-hour period, an
              acceptable instrument blank and PEM shall be analyzed in order
              to start a new sequence.  This requirement applies even if no
              analyses were performed since that standard(s) was injected.

                                     PEST D-23                        10/92

-------
      11.2.5  After a break  in sample analyses,  the laboratory may only
              resume the analysis of samples using the current initial
              calibration  for quantisation by analyzing an acceptable
              instrument blank and a PEM.

      11.2.6  If the entire  12-hour period is not required for the analyses
              of all samples to be reported and  all data collection  is to be
              stopped,  the incomplete sequence shall be ended with either the
              instrument blank/PEM combination or the instrument
              blank/Individual Standard Mixtures A and B combination,
              whichever was  due to be performed  at the end of 12-hour period.

11.3  Procedure

      11.3.1  Set up the GC/ECD system as described in Section 9.

      11.3.2  Prepare the  PEM standard and the mid point concentration of
              Individual Standard Mixtures A and B as in Section 8,  and the
              instrument blank as in Section 20.3.

      11.3.3  The PEM,  the Individual Standard Mixtures, and the instrument
              blank shall be at ambient temperature at the time of
              preparation and analysis.

      11.3.4  Analyze the PEM, instrument blank, and the mid point
              concentration  of Individual Standard Mixtures A and B  at the
              required  frequencies (Sections 11.2 and 14.3).

11.4  Calculations

      11.4.1  For each  analysis of the Performance Evaluation Mixture used to
              demonstrate continuinr calibra***~n, calculate the percent
              difference between the amount of each analyte (including the
              surrogates)  found in the PEM and the nominal amount, using
              Equations 0.26 and D.30.

      11.4.2  For each  analysis of the Performance Evaluation Mixture used to
              demonstrate continuing calibration, calculate the percent
              breakdown of Endrin and DDT, and the combined breakdown, using
              Equations D.26, D.27, D.28, and D.29.

      11.4.3  For each  analysis of the mid point concentration of Individual
              Standard Mixtures A and B used to demonstrate continuing
              calibration, calculate the percent difference between  the
              amount of each analyte (including  the surrogates) found in the
              standard  mixture and the nominal amount, using Equations D.26
              and D.30.  Do  not attempt to calculate the breakdown of Endrin
              and DDT in the Individual Standard Mixtures, as these  standards
              contain the breakdown products as well as the parent compounds.

11.5  Technical  Acceptance Criteria For Calibration Verification

      All calibration verification technical  acceptance  criteria apply
      independently to both columns.

                                     PEST D-24                        10/92

-------
11.S.I   The PEMs,  Individual Standard Mixtures, and  Instrument blanks
         shall  be analyzed at the required frequency  (Section  11.2),
         using  the procedure in Section 11.3, on a  GC/ECD  system  that
         has met the initial calibration technical  acceptance  criteria.

11,5.2   All single component pesticides and surrogates  in the
         Performance Evaluation Mixtures used to demonstrate continuing
         calibration shall be 100 percent resolved.   The resolution
         between any two  adjacent peaks in the midpoint  concentrations
         of Individual  Standard Mixtures A and B in the  initial
         calibration shall be greater  than or equal to 90.0 percent.

11.5.3   The absolute retention time for each of the  single component
         pesticides and surrogates in  the PEHs and  mid point
         concentration  of the Individual Standard Mixtures  used to
         demonstrate continuing calibration shall be  within the
         retention time windows determined from the three-point initial
         calibration in Section 10.4.2.

11.5.4   The percent difference of the  calculated amount and the  true
         amount  for each  of the single  component pesticides and
         surrogates in  the PEM and midpoint concentration of the
         Individual Standard Mixtures used to demonstrate continuing
         calibration shall be greater than or equal to '25.0 percent and
         less than  or equal to  25.0 percent, using  Equation D.30.

11.5.5   The  percent breakdown  of  DDT and endrin in the PEM shall be
         less than  or equal to  20.0 percent each on both, columns.  The
         combined breakdown of  DDT and endrin shall be less than or
         equal to 30.0  percent  on  both columns.

11.5.6   All  Instrument blanks  shall meet  the technical acceptance
         criteria  in Section 20.3.4.

11.5.7   The  identification of  single component pesticides by gas
         chromatographic  methods  is based primarily on retention time
         data.  The retention time of the apex of a peak can only be
         verified from  an on-scale chromatogram.  The identification of
         multicomponent analytes by gas chromatographic methods is based
         primarily  on recognition  of patterns of retention  times
         displayed  on a chromatogram.  Therefore,  the following
         requirements apply to  all data presented for single component
         and multicomponent  analytes.

         11.5.7.1   The chromatograms that result  from the analyses of
                   the Performance Evaluation Mixture and the
                   Individual Standard Mixtures shall display  the
                   single component analytes present in each standard
                   at greater than 10 percent of full scale but less
                   than 100 percent of full scale.

         11.5.7.2   For any PEM, Individual Standard Mixture, or blank,
                   the baseline of the chromatogram shall return to
                   below 50 percent of full scale  before the elution

                               PEST  D-25                         10/92

-------
                         tine of alpha-BHC, and return to below 25 percent of
                         full scale after the elution time of alpha-BHC and
                         before the elution tine of decachlorobiphenyl.

              11.5.7.3   If a chronatogran is replotted electronically to
                         meet these requirements, the scaling factor used
                         shall be displayed on the chromatograa.

              11.5.7.4   If the chroaatogram of any standard or blank needs
                         to be replotted electronically to meet these
                         requirements, both the initial chronatogram and the
                         replotted chromatograa(s) shall be submitted in the
                         data package.

11.6  Corrective Action.

      11.6.1  If the technical acceptance criteria for the calibration
              verification are not net, inspect the systea for problems and
              take corrective action to achieve the acceptance criteria.

      11.6.2  Major corrective actions such as replacing the GC column or
              baking out the detector will require that a new initial
              calibration be performed and meets the technical acceptance
              criteria.

      11.6.3  Minor corrective actions may not require performing a new
              initial calibration,  provided that a nev analysis of the
              standard (PEM or Individual Mixtures) that originally failed
              the criteria and an associated instrument blank immediately
              after the corrective action do meet all the acceptance
              criteria.

      11.6.4  If a Performance Evaluation Mixture or Individual Standard
              Mixture does not meet the technical acceptance criteria listed
              above, it shall be reinjected Immediately.   If the second
              injection of the PEM or Individual Standard Mixture meets the
              criteria, sample analysis may continue.  If the second
              injection does not meet the criteria, all data collection shall
              be stopped.  Appropriate corrective action shall be taken,  and
              a new initial calibration sequence shall be run before more
              sample data are collected.

      11.6.5  If an instrument blank does not meet the technical acceptance
              criteria listed in Section 20.3.4,  all data collection shall be
              stopped.   Appropriate corrective action shall be taken to clean
              out the system, and an acceptable instrument blank shall be
              analyzed before more sample data are collected.

      11.6.6  Analysts are cautioned that running an instrument blank and a
              Performance Evaluation Mixture or Individual Standard Mixtures
              once every 12 hours are the minimum contract requirements.
              Late eluting peaks may carry over from one  injection to the
              next if highly complex samples are analyzed or if the GC
              conditions are unstable.  Such carryover is unacceptable.

                                    PEST D-26                         10/92

-------
        Therefore,  It may be necessary to run Instrument blanks and
        standards more often to avoid discarding data.

11.6.7  If a successful  instrument blank and PEM cannot be run after an
        interruption in  analysis  (Section 11.2.5), an acceptable
        initial calibration shall be run before sample data may be
        collected.  All  acceptable sample analyses shall be preceded
        and followed by  acceptable standards and instrument blanks, as
        described in Section 11.2.

11.6.8  Calibration verification technical acceptance criteria shall be
        met before  any samples (including the LCS and the PIS) and
        required blanks  are reported.  Any samples, including LCS and
        FES required with a calibration verification which did not meet
        the technical acceptance criteria will require reanalysis at no
        additional  cost.
                               PIST 0-27                         10/92

-------
                 SECTION IV
SAMPLE PREPARATION, EXTRACTION, AND CLEANUP
                    PEST D-28                         10/92

-------
12.   SUMMARY

12.1  This method Is designed for analysis of samples that contain low
      concentrations of the pesticides and Aroclors listed in Exhibit C.  The
      majority of the samples are expected to cone from drinking water
      sources and well/ground water around Superfund sites.  If, upon
      inspection of a sample, the Contractor suspects that the sample is not
      amenable to this method, contact SHO for instructions.

13.   PROCEDURE

13.1  Extraction

      Continuous Liquid-Liquid Extraction is required for the extraction of
      the samples.

      13.1.1  Add methylene chloride  (100 to 250 mL) to the bottom of the
              extractor and fill it to a depth of at least one inch above the
              bottom sidearn.

      13.1.2  'Measure out each 1.0 liter sample aliquot in a separate 1 liter
              graduated cylinder.  Measure and record the pH of the sample
              with wide range pH paper and adjust the pH to between 5 and 9
              with 10 N sodium hydroxide or concentrated sulfuric acid, if
              required.  Samples requiring pH adjustment shall be noted in
              the SDG Narrative.  Transfer the sample aliquot into the
              continuous extractor.  Rinse the cylinder with 30 mL of
              methylene chloride and also transfer to the continuous
              extractor.

      13.1.3  Using a micropipet with disposable tip, add 200 uL of the
              surrogate solution to all samples and method blanks.

      13.1.4  Adjust the level of methylene chloride in the extractor so that
              the bottom sidearm is half filled with solvent.

      13.1.5  If the sample was received in a 1 liter container, rinse the
              empty container with 60 mL of methylene chloride after taking
              the sample aliquot.  Add the rinsate to the continuous
              extractor.

      13.1.6  Add sufficient methylene chloride to the distilling flask to
              ensure proper solvent cycling during operation.  Extract the
              solution for 18 hours.  Allow to cool, then detach the
              distillation flask and label.

13.2  Extract Drying and Concentration

      13.2.1  Assemble a Kuderna-Danish (K-D) concentrator by attaching a 10
              mL concentrator tube to a 500 mL evaporative flask.  Other
              concentration devices or techniques may be used in place of the
              K-D, if equivalency is demonstrated for all the target
              pesticides and Aroclors listed in Exhibit C.
                                     PEST D-29                          10/92

-------
      13.2.2   Pour  the  extract  through  a  drying column containing about 10 cm
               of anhydrous  granular  sodium sulfate and collect  the extract in
               the K-D concentrator.   Rinse the  Erlenmeyer  flask and the
               sodium sulfate with  at least two  additional  20  to 30 mL
               portions  of methylene  chloride  to complete the  quantitative
               transfer.

      13.2.3   Add one or  two clean boiling chips to the evaporative flask and
               attach a  three-ball  Snyder  column. Pre-wet the  Snyder column by
               adding about  1 mL of methylene  chloride to the  top  of the
               column.   Place the K-D apparatus  on a hot water bath (60-80*C)
               so that the concentrator  tube is  partially immersed in the  hot
               water and the entire lower  rounded surface of the flask is
               bathed with hot vapor.  Adjust  the vertical position of the
               apparatus and the water temperature as required to  complete the
               concentration in  15  to 30 minutes.  At the proper rate of
               distillation, the balls of  the  column will actively chatter,
               but the chambers  will  not flood with condensed  solvent.   When
               the apparent  volume  of liquid reaches 3 to 5 mL, remove the K-D
               apparatus.  Allow it to drain and cool for at least 10 minutes.
              iDO NOT ALLOW  THI  EVAPORATOR TO  GO  DRY.

      13.2.4   Proceed with  the  solvent exchange  to hexane.

13.3  Solvent Exchange  To  Hexane

      13.3.1   Momentarily remove the  three-ball Snyder column, add  50 mL  of
               hexane and  a  new boiling chip,  and reattach the Snyder  column.
               Pre-wet the column by  adding  about 1 mL of hexane to  the  top.
               Concentrate the solvent extract as before.   When the  apparent
               volume of liquid  reaches 1 mL,  remove the K-D apparatus and
               allow it to drain and  cool for'at  least 10 minutes.   DO NOT
              ALLOW THE EVAPORATOR TO GO DRY.

      13.3.2  Remove the  Snyder column;  using 1  to 2 mL of hexane,  rinse  the
               flask and its lower  Joint into  the concentrator tube.

      13.3.3  Use the micro Snyder column or  the nitrogen blowdown  technique
               (Section 13.5) to concentrate the hexane extract to 1.0 mL.

13.4  Extract Cleanup

      13.4.1   The two cleanup procedures specified in this method are
               Florisil cartridge and sulfur cleanup.    Florisil cartridge
               cleanup is  required  for all extracts.   Sulfur cleanup shall be
              performed on  all extracts containing sulfur at levels  that
               interfere with GC/ECD  analysis.   Sulfur contamination in  a
              sample analysis is unacceptable.  Method blanks shall be
              subjected to  the  same  cleanup procedures as the samples.
                                     PEST D-30                        10/92

-------
13.4.2  Florlsll Cartridge Procedure

        Florisil cartridge cleanup significantly reduces matrix
        interferences caused by polar compounds^ and is required for all
        extracts.

        13.4.2.1   Cartridge Performance Check.  Every lot number of
                   Florisil cartridges shall be tested by the following
                   procedure before they are used for sample cleanup.
                   Add 0.50 mL of 2,4,5-trichlorophenol solution (0.1
                   ug/mL in acetone)  and O.SO mL of Standard Mixture A,
                   midpoint concentration (Section 8.3.4) to 4 mL of
                   hexane.  Reduce the final volume to 1.0 mL using the
                   extract concentration techniques in Section 13.5.
                   Place the mixture  onto the top of a washed Florisil
                   cartridge,  and elute It with 9 mL of hexane/acetone
                   [(90:10)(V/V)]. Use two additional 1 mL hexane
                   rinses to ensure quantitative transfer of standard
                   from the cartridge.  Reduce the final volume to 1.0
                   mL using micro Snyder column or nitrogen evaporation
                   techniques  (Section 13.5).   Analyze the solution by
                   GC/ECD.  This  solution shall be analyzed on a GC/ECD
                   meeting the initial and calibration verification
                   technical acceptance criteria.   The recovery of each
                   analyte shall  be determined for evaluation and
                   reporting purposes.  The lot of Florisil cartridges
                   is acceptable  if all pesticides and surrogates are
                   recovered at 80 to  120 percent,  If the recovery of
                   trichlorophenol Is  less than 5%,  and no peaks
                   interfering with the target analytes are detected.

        13.4.2.2   Florisil cartridge  cleanup  procedure

                   13.4.2.2.1   Attach the vacuum manifold to a water
                               aspirator or to a vacuum  pump with  a
                               trap installed between the  manifold and
                               the vacuum source.  Adjust  the vacuum
                               pressure in the manifold  to between 5
                               and 10 pounds  of vacuum.

                   13.4.2.2.2   Place  a 1 g Florisil cartridge into the
                               vacuum manifold for each  sample
                               extract.

                   13.4.2.2.3   Prior  to cleanup of samples,  the
                               cartridges shall be washed with
                               hexane/acetone (90:10).   This is
                               accomplished by placing the cartridge
                               in the vacuum  manifold, by pulling  a
                               vacuum,  and by passing at least 5 mL of
                               the hexane/acetone solution through the
                               cartridge.  While the  cartridges are
                               being  washed,  adjust the  vacuum applied
                               to each  cartridge so that the flow  rate

                               PEST D-31                        10/92

-------
              through each cartridge  is approximately
              equal.  DO NOT ALLOW THE CARTRIDGES  TO
              GO DRY AFTER THEY HAVE  BEEN WASHED.

13.4.2.2.4    After the cartridges in the manifold
              are washed, the vacuum  is released,  and
              a rack containing labeled 10 mL
              volumetric flasks is placed inside the
              manifold.  Care shall be taken to
              ensure that the solvent line from each
              cartridge is placed inside of the
              appropriate volumetric flask as the
              manifold top is replaced.

13.4.2.2.5    Transfer the 1 mL extract to the top
              frit of the appropriate Florisll
              cartridge.  Rinse the concentrator tube
              twice with 0.5 mL of hexane/acetone
              (90:10) and transfer each rinse to the
              top frit of the cartridge.

13.4.2.2.6   The pesticides/Aroclors in the extract
             concentrates are then eluted through
              the column with 8.0 mL of
             hexane/acetone (90:10)  and are
             collected into the 10 mL volumetric
             flasks held in the rack inside the
             vacuum manifold.

13.4.2.2.7   Transfer the eluate in each volumetric
             flask to a clean centrifuge tube or 10
             mL vi£1    Use two additional 1 mL
             hexane rinses to ensure quantitative
             transfer of the cartridge eluate.

13.4.2.2.8   Concentrate the extract to 2.0 mL using
             either a micro Snyder column or
             nitrogen evaporation (Section 13.5).
             Measure the final volume with a syringe
             or by transferring the  extract to a
             volumetric flask.

13.4.2.2.9   If crystals of sulfur are evident or if
             the presence of sulfur  is suspected,
             proceed to Section 13.4.3.   Sample
             analyses with interference caused by
             sulfur are not acceptable and the
             extracts shall be cleaned up and
             reanalyzed.

13.4.2.2.10  If the extract is not contaminated with
             sulfur,  transfer the sample to a GC
             vial and label the vial.  The extract
             is ready for GC/ECD analysis.   Proceed

            PEST D-32                        10/92

-------
                                to Section 14.  Store the extracts at
                                4*C in the dark until analyses are
                                completed.
13.4.3  Sulfur Removal
        Sulfur can be removed by one of two methods, according to
        laboratory preference.  Interference which is due to sulfur is
        not acceptable.  If the sulfur concentration is such that
        crystallization occurs in the concentrated extract, centrifuge
        the extract to settle the crystals, and remove the sample
        extract with a disposable pipette, leaving the excess sulfur in
        the centrifuge tube.  Transfer the extract to a clean
        centrifuge tube or clean concentrator tube before proceeding
        with further sulfur cleanup.

        13.4.3.1   If only part of a set of samples requires sulfur
                   cleanup,  then two blanks are required for that set:
                   one that is shaken with mercury or copper,  and one
                   that is not.   If only part of a set of samples
                   requires sulfur cleanup, do not subject the
                   associated method blank to sulfur cleanup,  but
                   prepare a separate sulfur cleanup blank as  described
                   below.   If all  the samples are subjected to sulfur
                   cleanup,  process  the  method blank along with the
                   samples.   In this case,  no additional  sulfur cleanup
                   blank Is  required.

                   Sulfur cleanup  blank.   Add 200 uL of surrogate to
                   1.0 mL of surrogate spiking solution and 9.0 mL of
                   hexane in a clean centrifuge tube or 10 mL  vial.
                   Concentrate the solution to 2.0 mL by using either
                   nitrogen blc:.-r:wn or  a  -.^ ,ro Sny*T column.   The
                   concentrated volume of  the blank shall be the  same
                   as  the final volume of  the samples associated with
                   the blank.   Measure the volume with a  syringe  or by
                   transferring the  solution to a volumetric flask.
                   Proceed with the  sulfur removal using  the same
                   technique (mercury or copper)  as the samples
                   associated with the blank.

        13.4.3.2    Mercury technique

                   Add one  to  three  drops  of mercury to each hexane
                   extract  in  a clean vial.   Tighten the  top on the
                   vial and agitate  the  sample for 30 seconds.   Filter
                   or  centrifuge the extract.   Pipet the  extract  to
                   another vial  and  leave  all solid precipitate  and
                   liquid mercury.   If the mercury appears shiny,
                   proceed to  Section 14 and analyze the  extract.   If
                   the mercury turns black,  repeat sulfur removal as
                   necessary.   CAUTION:  Waste containing mercury
                   should be segregated  and disposed of properly.
                              PEST D-33
10/92

-------
                         KOTE:  Mercury Is a highly toxic metal and
                         therefore, shall be used with great care.  Prior to
                         using mercury, it is recommended that the analyst
                         become acquainted with proper handling and cleanup
                         techniques associated with this metal.
              13.4.3.3   Copper technique

                         Add approximately 2 g of cleaned copper powder to
                         the extract in the centrifuge or concentrator tube.
                         (2 g will fill the tube to about the 0.5 mL mark).
                         Mix the copper and extract for at least 1 minute on
                         a mechanical shaker.  Separate the extract from the
                         copper powder by drawing off the extract with a
                         disposable pipet, and transfer the extract to a
                         clean vial.  The extract transferred to the vial
                         still represents the 2.0 mL final volume.  The
                         separation of the extract from the copper powder is
                         necessary to prevent degradation of the pesticides.
                         If the copper appears bright, proceed to Section 14
                         and analyze the extract.  If the copper changes
                         color, repeat the sulfur removal procedure as
                         necessary.

13.5.  Extract Concentration

      Two different techniques are permitted to concentrate the extract to
      1.0 mL (volume before Florisil cleanup) or 2.0 mL (extract volume
      before instrumental analysis).  They are the micro Snyder column and
      nitrogen evaporation techniques.

      13.5.1  Micro Snyder Column Technique

              Add another one or two clean boiling chips to the concentrator
              tube and attach a two-ball micro Snyder column. Pre-wet the
              Snyder column by adding about 0.5 mL of hexane to the top of •
              the column.  Place the K-D apparatus in a hot water bath (60*C
              to 65*C) so that the  concentrator tube is partially immersed in
              the hot water.  Adjust the vertical position of the apparatus
              and the water temperature as required to complete the
              concentration in 5 to 10 minutes.  At the proper rate of
              distillation the balls of the column will actively chatter but
              the chambers will not flood with condensed solvent. When the
              apparent volume of liquid reaches about 0.5 mL, remove the K-D
              apparatus from the water bath and allow it to drain for at
              least 10 minutes while cooling.  Remove the Snyder column and
              rinse its flask and  lower Joint into the concentrator tube with
              0.2 mL of hexane.  Adjust the  final volume with hexane to 1.0
              mL (Florisil) or 2.0  mL (analysis).

      13.5.2  Nitrogen Evaporation Technique  (taken from ASTM Method D 3086).

              13.5.2.1   Place the  concentrator tube with an open micro
                         Snyder column attached in a warm water bath (30*C to

                                     PEST D-34                        10/92

-------
                   35*C) and evaporate the solvent volume to just below
                   1 or 2 mL by blowing a gentle stream of clean, dry
                   nitrogen filtered through a column of activated
                   carbon above the solvent.  Adjust the final volume
                   with hexane to 1.0 iiL (Florlsil) or 2.0 mL
                   (analysis).

        13.5.2.2   CAUTION:  Gas lines from the gas source to the
                   evaporation apparatus shall be stainless steel,
                   copper, or Teflon tubing.  The internal wall of new
                   tubing shall be rinsed several times with hexane and
                   then dried prior to use.  During evaporation, the
                   tube solvent level shall be kept below the water
                   level of the bath.  DO NOT ALLOW THE EXTIACT TO GO
                   TO DRYNESS.

13.5.3  If the extract has not been put through Florisil yet, proceed
        to Section 13.4 for extract cleanup.  Otherwise, transfer the
        extract to a Teflon-lined screw-cap bottle and label the
        .bottle.  Store at 4"C (±2*G).
                               PEST D-35                         10/92

-------
                         SECTION V
SAMPLE ANALYSIS AND COMPOUND IDENTIFICATION AND QDANTITATION
                            PEST D-36                         10/92

-------
14.
INSTRUMENTAL ANALYSIS
      Before samples or required blanks can be analyzed, Che instrument shall
      meet the initial calibration and calibration verification technical
      acceptance criteria.  All sample extracts, including LCS and PIS,
      required blanks, and calibration standards shall be analyzed under the
      sane instrumental conditions.  All samples (including the LCS and FES),
      required blanks, extracts, and standard/spiking solutions shall be
      allowed to wars to ambient temperature (approximately 1 hour) before
      preparation/analysis.

14.1  Set up the GC/ECD system per the requirements in Section til.  Unless
      ambient temperature on-column injection is used (see Section 9) ,  the
      injector shall be heated to at least 200*C.  The optimized gas
      chromatographic conditions from Section 9 shall be used.

14.2  The injection shall be made on-column by using either automatic or
      manual injection.   If autoinjectors are used,  1.0 uL injection volumes
      may be used.   Manual injections shall use at least 2.0 uL injection
      volumes... The same injection volume shall be used for all standards,
      samples,  and blanks associated with the same initial calibration.   If a
      single injection is used for two GC columns attached to a single
      injection port,  it may be necessary to use an injection volume greater
      than 2 uL.   However,  the same injection volume shall be used for  all
      analyses,

14.3  All acceptable samples shall be analyzed within a valid analysis
      sequence  as given  below.
      Tiae
          Inlection
Material Inlected
      0 hr.
      12  hr.
          1 - 15

          16

          17

          18
          o
          o
          o
          o
          1st injection
            past 12:00 hr.
          2nd and 3rd
            inj ections
             past 12:00 hr.
          o
          o
          o
          o
          o
Firs- 15 steps of the
  Initial Calibration
Instrument Blank at end of
  Initial Calibration
PEN at end of
  Initial Calibration
First Sample

Subsequent Samples

Last sample
Instrument Blank

Individual Standard Mixtures A and B
                                       Sample

                                       Subsequent Samples
                                    PEST D-37
                                                                10/92

-------
Another 12 hr.   o                      Last Sample
                 1st injection          Instrument Blank
                   past 12:00 hr.
                 2nd injection          Performance Evaluation Mixture
                 o                      Sample
                 o
                 o                      Subsequent Samples
                 o
                 o
Another 12 hr.   o                      Last Sample
                 1st injection          Instrument Blank
                   past 12:00 hr.
                 2nd and 3rd            Individual Standard Mixtures A and B
                   injections
                    past 12 hr.
                 o                      Sample
                 o
                 o                      Subsequent Samples
                 o
                 o
                 etc.

      NOTE:  The first 12 hours are counted from injection #16 (the
      Instrument Blank at the end of the initial calibration sequence), not
      from Injection #1.  Samples may be injected until 12:00 hours have
      elapsed.  All subsequent 12-hour periods are timed from the injection
      of the instrument blank that brackets the front end of the samples.
      Because the 12-hour time period is timed from injection of the
      instrument blank until the injection of the last sample, each 12-hour
      period may be separated by the length of one chromatographic run, that
      of the analysis of the last sample.  While the 12-hour period may not
      be exceeded, the laboratory may run instrument blanks and standards
      more frequently, for instance, to accommodate staff working on 8-hour
      shifts.

14.4  Included with the subsequent samples in the analysis sequence are all
      of the required method blanks and sulfur cleanup blanks.  The
      Contractor may decide at what point in the sequence the method blanks
      and sulfur cleanup blanks are to be analyzed.

14.5  Termination of Data Acquisition

      After decachlorobiphenyl has eluted from the GC column, the data
      acquisition may be terminated for that analysis.

15.    DILUTIONS

15.1  The sample or blank shall first be analyzed at the most concentrated
      level (injection taken from the 2.0 mL final extract after the clean-up
      steps).

      15.1.1   If  the response of any single component pesticide  is greater
               than the response of  that  analyte  in the initial calibration
               high point standard,  then  the extract shall be  diluted  to have

                                     PEST D-38                         10/92

-------
               the response  of  that  analyte between  the  initial calibration
               lov point  and high point  standard.

      15.1,2   If the  response  of the  largest peak in a  multicomponent  analyte
               is greater than  the most  intense single component  analyte
               response in the  initial calibration high  point  standard, then
               the response  of  the largest peak in a multicomponent  analyte
               shall be diluted to have  its response between the  responses  of
               the initial calibration midpoint and  high point standard of
               that single component pesticide.

      15.1.3   If a greater  than 10  times dilution is needed (for example,  50
               to 1 dilution),  then  a  10 times more  concentrated dilution (5
               to 1 dilution) also shall be analyzed.

15.2  When diluted,  the chromatographic data for the single component
      pesticide shall be  able to be  reported at greater than 10 percent of
      full scale but less than 100 percent of full scale.

15.3  When diluted,  multicomponent analytes shall be able  to be reported at
      greater than 25 percent of full scale but less than 100  percent of full
      scale.

15.4  If a chromatogram is replotted electronically to  meet these
      requirements,  the scaling factor used shall be displayed on the
      chromatogram.   If the  chromatogram of any sample  needs to be replotted
      electronically to meet these requirements,  both the  initial
      chromatogram and the replotted chromatogram(s) shall be  submitted in
      the data package.

15.5  Dilute the sample using the following procedure:

      15.5.1   Calculate  the extract dilution in order for the single
               component  pesticides  to meet the requirement listed in Section
               15.2.

      15.5.2   Calculate  the extract dilution in order for the multicomponent
               analytes to meet the  requirement listed in 14.3.

      15.5.3   Dilute the  sample extract with hexane in  a volumetric flask.

16.    IDENTIFICATION OF TARGET AMALYTKS

16.1  The laboratory will identify single component  analyte peaks based on
      the retention time  windows established during  the  initial calibration
      sequence.  Single component analytes are  identified  when peaks are
      observed in the RT  window for  the analyte on both GC columns.

16.2  A set of three to five major peaks is selected for each  multicomponent
      analyte.  Retention time windows for each peak are determined from the
      initial calibration analysis.   Identification  of  a multicomponent
      analyte in the sample  is based on pattern recognition in conjunction
                                     PEST D-39                        10/92

-------
       with the  elucion of three  to five  sample  peaks within the retention
       time window of the  corresponding peaks  of the standard on both GC
       columns.  The  number of potential  quantitation peaks  is listed in Table
       D-13.

                                  TABLE D-13

       Multtcomponent Analvte        No.  of Potential Quantitation Peaks
      Aroclor 1016/1260                       5/5
      Aroclor 1221                            3
      Aroclor 1232                            4
      Aroclor 1242                            5
      Aroclor 1248                            5
      Aroclor 1254                            5
      Toxaphene                               4

16.3  A standard of any identified ntulticomponent analyte shall be run within
      72 hours.of its detection in a sample chromatograa within a valid 12
      hour sequence.

16.4  The choice of the peaks used for multicomponent analyte identification
      and the recognition of those peaks may be complicated by the
      environmental alteration of the Toxaphene or Aroclora, and by the
      presence of coeluting analytes, or matrix interferences, or both.
      Because of the alteration of these materials in the environment,
      multicomponent analytes in samples may give patterns similar to, but
      not identical with,  those of the standards.

16.5  Toxaphene and Aroclors require only a single-point calibration.
      Identification requires visual inspection of an on-scale pattern.

17.   QPAHTITATIOH OF AHALYTES

17.1  Quantitation for all analytes and surrogates shall be performed and
      reported on both columns.

17.2  Manual integration of peaks (e.g., measuring peak height with a ruler)
      is only permitted when accurate electronic integration of peaks cannot
      be done.   If manual  integration of peaks is required,  it shall be
      documented in the SDG Narrative.

17.3  The Contractor shall quantitate each single component analyte and
      surrogate based on the calibration factor from the most recent initial
      calibration midpoint standard mixture analyses.  Do not use the
      analyses of the Individual Standard {fixtures used to demonstrate
      continuing calibration for quantitation of samples.

17,4  The Contractor shall quantitate each multicomponent analyte based on
      the calibration factor from the most recent Initial calibration
      standard.
                                     PEST D-40                        10/92

-------
17.5  If more Chan one mulcicomponent analyte is present,  the Contractor
      shall choose separate peaks to quantitate the different multicomponent
      analytes .   A peak common to both analytes present in the sample shall
      not be used to quantitate either analyte.

17.6  Before reporting data to SMO, it is required that the Contractor check
      for flags  generated by the data system that indicate improper
      quantitation of analytes.

17.7  The chromatograms of all samples, standards, and blanks shall be
      reviewed by a qualified pesticide analyst before they are reported.

17.8  Calculations.

      17.8.1  Calculate the concentration of the  single component pesticides
              and  surrogates by using  the following equation:
                  D 32
                        Concentration ug/L -  (Ax>  
-------
      17..8.2  During initial calibration, a set of three  to  five  quantitation
              peaks was chosen for each multicomponent analyte.   Calculate
              the concentration of each of the selected Aroclor or  Toxaphene
              peaks individually using Equation D.32.  Determine  the  mean
              concentration for all of the selected peaks.   The mean  value is
              reported on Form X (Exhibit B) for both GC  columns.

      17.8.3  For the single component pesticides, report the lower of the
              two values quantitated from the two columns of Form I.   For the
              multicomponent analytes, report the lower of the two  mean
              values from the two columns on Form Z.

      17.8.4  The recoveries of the surrogates are calculated according to
              Equation D.33.

            EQ.  D.33                                Qd
                      Surrogate Percent Recovery -  =—  x  100


            Where:

            Qd - Quantity determined by analysis.

            Qa — Quantity added to  sample/blank.

      17.8.5  The percent difference is calculated according to Equation
              D.34.
             EQ. D.3A                ConcH -
                              %D -                  x 100
            Where,

                  — The higher of the two concentrations for the target
                    compound in question.

                  - The lower of the two concentrations for the target
                    compound in question.

              Note that using this equation will result in percent difference
              values that are always positive.  The value will also be
              greater  than a value calculated using the higher concentration
              in the denominator, however, given the likelihood of a positive
              interference raising the concentration determined on one GC
              column,  this is a conservative approach to comparing the two
              concentrations .

18-    TECHNICAL ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA FOE SAMF?^ fPn&Tg1C?

      All requirements listed below apply independently to both GC columns
      and to all instruments used for these analyses .

18.1  Samples shall be analyzed under the GC/ECD operating conditions in
      Section 9.  The instrument shall have met all initial calibration and

                                     PEST D-42                        10/92

-------
      calibration verification technical acceptance criteria.  Sample data
      shall be bracketed at 12-hour intervals (or less) by acceptable
      analyses of instrument blanks, Performance Evaluation Mixtures, and
      Individual Standard Mixtures A and B, as described in Section 11.2.

18.2  The sample shall be extracted and analyzed within the contract holding
      tines.

18.3  The LCS associated with the samples shall aeet the LCS technical
      acceptance criteria.  The PES associated with the samples shall meet
      the PIS technical acceptance criteria.  The method blank extracted with
      the samples shall meet the method blank technical acceptance criteria.
      If a sulfur cleanup blank is associated with the samples, that blank
      shall meet the sulfur cleanup blank technical acceptance criteria.

18.4  The retention time for each of the surrogates shall be within the
      retention time window as calculated in Section 10.

18.5  The percent recovery for the surrogates shall be between 60.0 and 150
      percent,.- Indus ive.

18.6  Ho target  analyte concentrations  may exceed the upper limit of the
      initial calibration (See Section  15.1.1 and 15.1.2)  or else extracts
      shall be diluted and reanalyzed.

18.7  A standard for any identified multicomponent analyte shall be analyzed
      on the same instrument within 72  hours of  its  detection in a sample
      within a valid 12 hour sequence.

18.8  The identification of single component pesticides by gas
      chromatographic methods  is  based  primarily on  retention time data.  The
      retention  time of the apex  of a peak can only  be  verified froa an on-
      scale chromatogram.   The identification of multicomponent analytes by
      gas chromatographic  methods is based primarily on recognition of
      patterns of retention times displayed on a chromatogram.   Therefore,
      the following requirements  apply  to  all data presented for single
      component  and multicomponent analytes.

      18.8.1  When no analytes are identified in a sample, the chromatograms
              from the analyses of the sample extract shall use the same
              scaling factor as was used for the low point standard of the
              initial calibration associated with those analyses.

      18.8.2  Chromatograms shall display single component pesticides
              detected in the sample at less than full scale.

      18.8.3  Chromatograms shall display the largest peak of any
              multicomponent analyte detected in the sample at less than full
              scale.

      18.8.4  If an extract shall be diluted, chromatograms shall display
              single component pesticides between 10 and  100 percent of full
              scale.
                                     PEST D-43                         10/92

-------
      18.8.5   If an extract shall be diluted,  chromatograms  shall  display
               multlcomponent analytes between 25  and 100  percent of full
               scale.

      18.8.6   For any sample or blank, the baseline  of  the chromatograa shall
               return to below 50 percent of full  scale  before  the  elutlon
               time of alpha-BHC, and return to below 25 percent of full scale
               after the elution tine of alpha-BHC and before the elution time
               of decachlorobiphenyl.

      18.8.7   If a chromatogram is replotted electronically  to meet these
               requirements,  the scaling factor used  shall be displayed  on the
               chromatogram.

      18.8.8   If the  chromatogram of any sample needs to  be  replotted
               electronically to meet these requirements,  both  the  initial
               chromatogram and the replotted chromatogram(s) shall be
               submitted in the data package.

19.   CORRECTIVE ACTION

19.1  If the sample technical acceptance criteria are not met,  check
      calculations, surrogate solutions, and instrument performance.  It may
      be necessary to recalibrate the instrument or take other  corrective
      action procedures to meet the technical acceptance criteria,  in which
      case,  the affected samples shall be reanalyzed at no additional cost
      after the corrective action.

19.2  If the Contractor needs to analyze more than the most concentrated
      extract and two (2) sample dilutions to have all the pesticide/Aroclor
      compounds within the calibration range of the instrument, contact SMO.
      SMO will contact the Region for instructions.

19.3  Sample analysis technical acceptance criteria SHALL be met before data
      are reported.  Samples contaminated from laboratory sources  or
      associated with a contaminated method blank or sulfur cleanup blank
      will require reextraction and reanalysis at no additional cost.  Any
      samples analyzed that do not meet the technical acceptance criteria
      will require reextraction and\or reanalysis at no additional cost.

19.4  Sample reextraction/reanalyses performed as a result of suspected
      matrix interferences beyond the scope of the method will  be  reviewed on
      a case-by-case basis for payment purposes by SMO.
                                     PEST D-44                         10/92

-------
                    SECTION VI
SAMPLE QUALITY CONTROL PROCEDURES AND REQUIREMENTS
                       PEST D-45                         10/92

-------
20.   BLANKS

      Summary

      There are two types of blanks required by this method: the method blank
      and the instrument blank.  A separate sulfur cleanup blank may also be
      required if some, but not all of the samples are subjected to sulfur
      cleanup.  Samples that are associated with a sulfur cleanup blank are
      also associated with the method blank with which they were extracted.
      Both the method and sulfur cleanup blanks shall meet the respective
      technical acceptance criteria for the sample analysis technical
      acceptance criteria to be met.

20.1  Method Blanks

      20.1.1  Summary

              A method blank is 1.0 liter of reagent water carried through
              the entire analytical scheme.

      20.1.2  Frequency

              A method blank shall be extracted and analyzed:

                     o   once every 20 samples, AND

                     o   every time samples are extracted.

      20.1.3  Procedure

              20.1.3.1   Measure 1.0 liter of reagent water for each method
                         blank aliquot.  Add 200 uL of the surrogate
                         solution.  Extract and concentrate the method blank
                         according to Section 13.

              20.1.3.2   Analyze the method blank according to Section 14.
                         Calculate the results according to Section 17.

      20.1.4  Technical Acceptance Criteria for Method Blanks

              20.1.4.1   All method blanks shall be prepared and analyzed at
                         the frequency described in Section 20.1.2 using the
                         procedure in Section 20.1.3 on a GC/ECD system
                         meeting the initial calibration and calibration
                         verification technical acceptance criteria.

              20.1.4.2   The concentration in the method blank of the target
                         compounds in Exhibit C shall be less than or equal
                         to the CRQL for each target compound.

              20.1.4.3   The method blank shall meet all sample technical
                         acceptance criteria in Section 18.
                                     PEST D-46                        10/92

-------
      20.1.5  Corrective Action

              20.1.5.1   If a method blank does not meet the technical
                         acceptance criteria, the Contractor shall consider
                         the analytical system to be out of control.  It Is
                         the Contractor's responsibility to ensure that
                         method interferences caused by contaminants in
                         solvents, reagents, glassware, and sample storage
                         and processing hardware that lead to discrete
                         artifacts and/or elevated baselines in gas
                         chromatograms be eliminated.  If contamination is a
                         problem, the source of the contamination shall be
                         investigated and appropriate corrective measures
                         SHALL be taken and documented before further sample
                         analysis proceeds.

              20.1.5.2   Any method blank that fails to meet the technical
                         acceptance criteria shall be reextracted and
                         reanalyzed at no additional cost.   Further, all
                         samples (including LCS and PES) processed with a
                         method blank that does not meet the blank technical
                         acceptance criteria (I.e., contaminated)  will
                         require reextraction and reanalysis at no additional
                         cost.

20.2  Sulfur Cleanup Blank

      20.2.1  Summary

              The sulfur cleanup blank is a modified form of the method
              blank.  The sulfur cleanup blank is hexane spiked with the
              surrogates and passed through the sulfur cleanup procedure
              (Section 13.4.3).

      20.2.2  Frequency

              The sulfur cleanup blank is prepared when only part of a set of
              samples extracted together requires sulfur removal.   A method
              blank is associated with the entire set of samples.   The sulfur
              cleanup blank is associated with the part of the set which
              required sulfur cleanup.  If all the samples associated with a
              given method blank are subjected to sulfur cleanup,  then no
              separate sulfur cleanup blank is required.

      20.2.3  Procedure

              20.2.3.1   Prepare the sulfur cleanup blank per Section
                         13.4.3.1 at the frequency listed in Section 20.2.2.

              20.2.3.2   Analyze the sulfur cleanup blank according to
                         Section 14.  Calculate the results according to
                         Section 17.
                                     PEST 0-47                         10/92

-------
      20.2.4   Technical Acceptance Criteria for Sulfur Cleanup Blanks

               20.2.4.1  All  sulfur cleanup blanks shall be prepared and
                         analyzed  at the  frequency described  in Section
                         20.2.2  using the procedure in Section 20.2.3 on a
                         GC/ECD  system meeting  the Initial calibration and
                         calibration verification technical acceptance
                         criteria.

               20.2.4.2  The  concentration  in the sulfur cleanup blank of the
                         target  compounds in Exhibit C shall be  less  than or
                         equal to  the CRQL  for  each target compound.

               20.2.4.3  The  sulfur cleanup blank shall meet all sample
                         technical  acceptance criteria in Section 18.

      20.2.5   Corrective Action
              20.2.5.1
              20.2.5.2
If a sulfur blank does not meet the technical
acceptance criteria, the Contractor shall consider
the analytical system to be out of control.  It is
the Contractor's responsibility to ensure that
Interferences caused by contaminants in solvents,
reagents, glassware, and sample storage and
processing hardware that lead to discrete artifacts
and/or elevated baselines in gas chromatograms be
eliminated.  If contamination is a problem, the
source of the contamination shall be investigated
and appropriate corrective measures SHALL be taken
and documented before further sample analysis
proceeds.

Any sulfur blank that fails to meet the technical
acceptance criteria shall be reextracted and
reanalyzed at no additional cost.  Further, all
samples (including LCS and FES) processed with a
sulfur blank that does not meet the blank technical
acceptance criteria (i.e., contaminated) will
require reextraction and reanalysis at no additional
cost.
20.3  Instrument Blanks
      20.3.1  Summary
              An instrument blank is a volume of clean solvent containing the
              surrogates that is analyzed to determine the extent of
              contamination in the GC/ECD system.
      20.3.2  Frequency
              The first analysis after a 12-hour analysis sequence (see
              Section 11.2} shall be an instrument blank.  All groups of
              acceptable sample analyses are to be preceded and followed by
                                     PEST D-48
                                             10/92

-------
         acceptable  instrument blanks.   If more than  12 hours have
         elapsed  since  the  Injection of  the  instrument blank  that
         bracketed a previous 12-hour period, an  instrument blank shall
         be  analyzed to initiate a new 12-hour sequence (see Section
         11.2).

20.3.3   Procedure

         20.3.3.1   Prepare the instrument blank by spiking the
                    surrogates into hexane or iso-octane for a
                    concentration of 20.0 ng/mL of Tetrachloro-m-xylene
                    and Decachlorobiphenyl.

         20.3.3.2  Analyze the instrument blank according to Section 14
                   at  the frequency listed in Section 20.3.2.
                   Calculate the results according to Section 17.

20.3.4   Technical Acceptance Criteria for Instrument Blanks

        •20.3.4.1   All instrument blanks shall be prepared and analyzed
                   at the frequency described in Section 20.3.2 using
                   the procedure in Section 20.3.3 on a GC/ECD system
                   meeting the Initial calibration and calibration
                   verification technical acceptance criteria.

         20.3.4.2   The concentration in the instrument blank of each
                   target analyte in Exhibit C shall be less than or
                   equal to the CRQL for that analyte.

         20.3.4.3   The instrument blank shall meet all sample technical
                   acceptance criteria in Section 18.

20.3.5   Corrective Action

         20.3.S.I   If analytes are detected at greater than the CRQL or
                   the surrogate RTs are outside the RT windows, all
                   data collection shall be stopped,  and corrective
                   action shall be taken.   Data for samples which were
                   run between the last acceptable instrument blank and
                   the unacceptable blank are considered suspect.   An
                   acceptable instrument blank shall be run before
                   additional data are collected.  All samples which
                   were run after the last acceptable instrument blank
                   shall be reinjected during a valid run sequence and
                   shall be reported at no  additional cost.

         20.3.5.2  Analysts are cautioned that running an instrument
                   blank once every 12 hours (see Section 11)  is the
                   minimum contract requirement.   Late eluting peaks
                   may carry over from one  injection to the next if
                   highly complex samples  are analyzed or if the GC
                               PEST D-49                        10/92

-------
                          conditions  are unstable.   Such carryover  is
                          unacceptable.  Therefore,  it nay be  necessary to run
                          instrument  blanks more often to avoid  discarding
                          data.

21.   LABORATORY CONTROL  SAMPLES (LCS^

21.1  Summary

      The laboratory control sample  (LCS) is an internal laboratory quality
      control sample designed to assess (on an SDG-by-SDG basis) the
      capability of the contractor to perform the analytical method listed in
      this Exhibit.

21.2  Frequency

      The LCS shall be prepared, extracted, analyzed, and reported once per
      Sample Delivery Group.  The LCS shall be extracted and analyzed
      concurrently with the samples in the SDG using the same instrumentation
      as the samples in the SDG.

21.3  Procedure

      21.3.1  Measure a 1 liter aliquot of reagent water in a 1 liter
              graduated cylinder and transfer the water to a continuous
              extractor.   Pipet 1.0  mL of the LCS spiking solution (Section
              8.3.7) and  200 uL of the surrogate standard spiking solution
              into the water and mix well.  Extract and concentrate the
              sample according  to Section 13.

      21.3.2  Analyze the LCS per Section 14.

21.4  Calculations

      21.4.1  Calculate the results  according to Section 17.

      21.4.2  Calculate individual compound recoveries of the LCS using
              Equation D.33, substituting LCS percent recovery for surrogate
              percent recovery.

21.5  Technical Acceptance Criteria For Laboratory Control  Sample  Analysis

      21.S.I  The LCS shall be  analyzed at the frequency described in  Section
              21.2 on a GC/ECD  system meeting the initial calibration  and
              calibration verification technical acceptance criteria.

      21.5.2  The LCS shall be  prepared as described in Section 21.3.

      21.5.3  The LCS shall meet all sample technical acceptance criteria in
              Section 18.

      21.5.4  The percent recovery for each of the compounds in the LCS shall
              be within the recovery limits listed in Table D-14.
                                     PEST D-50                        10/92

-------
                                     Table D-14

                     LABORATORY CONTROL  SAMPLE RECOVERY LIMITS
                 COMPOUND                           % RECOVERY
               ganma-BHG                             56-123
               Heptachlor  epoxide                    74-150
               Dieldrin                             33-130
               4,4'-DDE                             50-150
               Endrin                                56-121
               Endosulfan  sulfate                    50-100
               gamma-Chlordane                       33-130

               NOTE:  The  recovery limits for any of the compounds  in the  LCS
               nay be expanded at any time during the period of performance  if
               SMO determines that the limits are too restrictive.

21.6  Corrective Action

      21.6.1   If the LCS  technical acceptance criteria for the surrogates or
               the LCS  compound recovery are not met, check calculations,  the
               surrogate and LCS solutions, and instrument performance.  It
               may be necessary to recalibrate the instrument or take other
               corrective  action procedures to meet  the surrogate and LCS
               recovery criteria.

      21.6.2   LCS technical acceptance criteria SHALL be met before  data  are
               reported.   LCS contamination from laboratory sources or any LCS
               analyzed not meeting the technical acceptance criteria will
               require  reextraetion and reanalysis of the LCS at no additional
               cost.

      21.6.3   All samples prepared and analyzed in  an SDG with an LCS that
               does not meet the technical acceptance criteria will also
               require  reextraction and reanalysis at no additional cost.

22.   PERFORMANCE EVALUATIONSAMPLES (PES)

22.1  Summary

      The PES is an external laboratory quality control sample prepared and
      designed to assess (on an SDG-by-SDG basis)  the capability of the
      contractor to perform the analytical method listed in this Exhibit.

22.2  Frequency

      The Contractor shall extract,  analyze,  and report the PES once per SDG,
      if available.  The PES shall be extracted and analyzed concurrently
      with the samples in the SDG using the same instrumentation as the
      samples in the SDG.
                                     PEST D-51                         10/92

-------
22.3  Procedure

      22.3.1   The  FES will be  received either  as  an ampulated extract or as a
               full volume sample.   If  received as an ampulated extract,  the
               Contractor will  receive  instructions concerning the  dilution
               procedure to bring  the extract to full volume prior  to
               preparation and  analysis of  the  FES.

      22.3.2   Add  200 uL of  surrogate  solution to 1 liter of  reagent  water
               spiked with the  FES  solution.  Extract and concentrate  the FES
               using the procedure  described in Section 13.  Analyze the  FES
               as described in  Section  14.

22.4  Calculations

      See Section 17 for all equations necessary for calculations.

22.5  Technical Acceptance Criteria for Performance Evaluation Sample

      22.S.I  The  FES shall be analyzed on a GC/ECD system meeting the
               initial calibration  and  calibration verification technical
               acceptance criteria  at the frequency  described  in Section  22.2.

      22.5.2   The  FES shall be extracted and concentrated according to
               Section 22.3.

      22.5.3  The  FES shall meet all sample technical acceptance criteria in
               Section 18.

22.6  Corrective Action

      22.6.1   If the FES technical acceptance  criteria for the  surrogates are
              not  met, check calculations, standard solutions  and  instrument
              performance.  It may be  necessary to  recalibrate  the instrument
              or take other corrective action  procedures to meet the
               technical acceptance criteria.   Any FES failing  to meet these
               technical acceptance criteria shall be reextracted and
              reanalyzed at no additional  cost.   If insufficient FES  extract
              remains or if an insufficient volume  of the FES  remains,
               document this in the SDG Narrative  by stating that the  FES
               could not be reextracted and reanalyzed because  insufficient
              volume remained.

      22.6.2   In addition to complying with the FES  technical  acceptance
               criteria, the Contractor will be responsible for correctly
               identifying and quantifying  the  compounds included in the
               Performance- Evaluation Sample.   SMO will notify  the  Contractor
               of unacceptable performance.

               Note:  Unacceptable  performance  for identification and
               quantitation of  compounds is defined as a score  less than  75
               percent.
                                     PEST D-52                         10/92

-------
22.6.3  The FES technical acceptance criteria SHALL be met before
        sample data are reported.  Also, the Contractor shall
        demonstrate acceptable performance for compound identification
        and quantitation.  If the Contractor fails to meet the PES
        technical acceptance criteria or achieves a score of less than
        75 percent, SMO may take, but is not limited to the following
        actions:  reduction of the number of samples, suspension of
        sample shipment, a site visit, a full data audit, require the
        laboratory to analyze a remedial PES, and/or contract sanction
        such as a Cure Notice.  Also, if the Contractor achieves a
        score of less than 75%, SMO may reject all of the sample data,
        return the rejected sample data to the Contractor, and not pay
        for sample analyses.
                               PEST D-53                         10/92

-------